gdb/
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
53 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
54 @end ifset
55 Version @value{GDBVN}.
56
57 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
58 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
59 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
60
61 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
62 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
63 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
64 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
65 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
66 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
67
68 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
69 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
70 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
71 @end ifinfo
72
73 @titlepage
74 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
75 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
76 @sp 1
77 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
78 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
81 @end ifset
82 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
83 @page
84 @tex
85 {\parskip=0pt
86 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
87 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89 }
90 @end tex
91
92 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
93 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
94 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
95 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96 @sp 2
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
103 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
104 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
105 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
106 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
107 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
108
109 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
110 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
111 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
112 @page
113 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
114 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
115 software in general. We will miss him.
116 @end titlepage
117 @page
118
119 @ifnottex
120 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
121
122 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
123
124 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
125
126 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
127 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
128 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
129 @end ifset
130 Version @value{GDBVN}.
131
132 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
133
134 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
135 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
136 software in general. We will miss him.
137
138 @menu
139 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
140 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
141
142 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
143 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
144 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
145 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
146 * Stack:: Examining the stack
147 * Source:: Examining source files
148 * Data:: Examining data
149 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
150 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
151 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
152
153 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
154
155 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
156 * Altering:: Altering execution
157 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
158 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
159 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
160 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
161 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
162 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
163 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
164 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
165 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
166 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
167 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
168
169 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
170
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
174 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
175 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
176 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
177 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
178 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
179 @value{GDBN}
180 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
181 how you can copy and share GDB
182 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
183 * Index:: Index
184 @end menu
185
186 @end ifnottex
187
188 @contents
189
190 @node Summary
191 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
192
193 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
194 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
195 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
196
197 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
198 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
199
200 @itemize @bullet
201 @item
202 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
203
204 @item
205 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
206
207 @item
208 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
209
210 @item
211 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
212 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
213 @end itemize
214
215 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
216 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
217 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
218
219 @cindex Modula-2
220 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
221 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
222
223 @cindex Pascal
224 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
225 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
226 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
227 syntax.
228
229 @cindex Fortran
230 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
231 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
232 underscore.
233
234 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
235 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
236
237 @menu
238 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
239 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
240 @end menu
241
242 @node Free Software
243 @unnumberedsec Free Software
244
245 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
246 General Public License
247 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
248 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
249 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
250 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
251 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
252 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
253
254 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
255 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
256 from anyone else.
257
258 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
259
260 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
261 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
262 include with the free software. Many of our most important
263 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
264 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
265 when an important free software package does not come with a free
266 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
267 gaps today.
268
269 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
270 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
271 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
272 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
273 them from the free software world.
274
275 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
276 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
277 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
278 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
279 contract to make it non-free.
280
281 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
282 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
283 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
284 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
285 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
286 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
287 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
288
289 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
290 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
291 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
292 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
293
294 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
295 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
296 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
297 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
298 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
299 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
300 community.
301
302 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
303 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
304 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
305 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
306 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
307 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
308 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
309 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
310 of the manual.
311
312 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
313 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
314 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
315 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
316 manual to replace it.
317
318 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
319 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
320 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
321 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
322 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
323 the free software community.
324
325 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
326 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
327 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
328 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
329 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
330 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
331 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
332 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
333 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
334
335 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
336 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
337 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
338 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
339 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
340 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
341 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
342 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
343
344 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
345 published by other publishers, at
346 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
347
348 @node Contributors
349 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
350
351 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
352 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
353 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
354 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
355 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
356 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
357 blow-by-blow account.
358
359 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
360
361 @quotation
362 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
363 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
364 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
365 @end quotation
366
367 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
368 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
369 releases:
370 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
371 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
372 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
373 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
374 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
375 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
376 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
377 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
378 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
379
380 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
381 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
382
383 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
384 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
385 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
386 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
387 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
388
389 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
390 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
391 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
392
393 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
394 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
395
396 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
397
398 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
399 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
400 support.
401 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
402 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
403 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
404 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
405 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
406 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
407 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
408 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
409 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
410 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
411 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
412 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
413 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
414 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
415 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
416 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
417
418 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
419
420 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
421 libraries.
422
423 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
424 about several machine instruction sets.
425
426 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
427 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
428 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
429 and RDI targets, respectively.
430
431 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
432 command-line editing and command history.
433
434 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
435 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
436
437 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
438 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
439 symbols.
440
441 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
442 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
443
444 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
445
446 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
447 processors.
448
449 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
450
451 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
452
453 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
454
455 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
456 watchpoints.
457
458 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
459
460 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
461
462 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
463 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
464
465 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
466 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
467 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
468 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
469 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
470 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
471 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
472
473 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
474 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
475
476 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
477 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
478 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
479 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
480 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
481 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
482 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
483 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
484 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
485 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
486 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
487 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
488 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
489 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
490 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
491
492 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
493 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
494
495 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
496 Hat.
497
498 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
499 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
500 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
501 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
502 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
503 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
504
505 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
506 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
507 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
508 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
509 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
510 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
511 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
512 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
513 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
514 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
515 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
516 Weigand.
517
518 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
519 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
520 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
521 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
522
523 @node Sample Session
524 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
525
526 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
527 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
528 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
529
530 @iftex
531 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
532 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
533 @end iftex
534
535 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
536 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
537
538 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
539 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
540 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
541 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
542 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
543 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
544 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
545 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
546 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
547
548 @smallexample
549 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
550 $ @b{./m4}
551 @b{define(foo,0000)}
552
553 @b{foo}
554 0000
555 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
556
557 @b{bar}
558 0000
559 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
560
561 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
562 @b{baz}
563 @b{Ctrl-d}
564 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
565 @end smallexample
566
567 @noindent
568 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
569
570 @smallexample
571 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
572 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
573 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
574 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
575 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
576 the conditions.
577 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
578 for details.
579
580 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
581 (@value{GDBP})
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
586 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
587 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
588 that examples fit in this manual.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
592 @end smallexample
593
594 @noindent
595 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
596 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
597 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
598 @code{break} command.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
602 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
607 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
608 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
609
610 @smallexample
611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
612 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
613 @b{define(foo,0000)}
614
615 @b{foo}
616 0000
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
621 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
622 context where it stops.
623
624 @smallexample
625 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
626
627 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
628 at builtin.c:879
629 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
634 the next line of the current function.
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
639 : nil,
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
644 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
645 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
646 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
650 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
651 at input.c:530
652 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
657 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
658 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
659 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
660 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
661 stack frame for each active subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
665 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
666 at input.c:530
667 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
668 at builtin.c:882
669 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
670 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
671 at macro.c:71
672 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
673 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
678 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
679 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
680
681 @smallexample
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
683 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
685 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
686 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
689 : xstrdup(rq);
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
691 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
696 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
697 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
698 (@code{print}) to see their values.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
702 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
704 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
709 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
710 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
714 533 xfree(rquote);
715 534
716 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
717 : xstrdup (lq);
718 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
719 : xstrdup (rq);
720 537
721 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
722 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
723 540 @}
724 541
725 542 void
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
730 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
731
732 @smallexample
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
734 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
736 540 @}
737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
738 $3 = 9
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
740 $4 = 7
741 @end smallexample
742
743 @noindent
744 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
745 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
746 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
747 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
748 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
749 assignments.
750
751 @smallexample
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
753 $5 = 7
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
755 $6 = 9
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
760 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
761 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
762 example that caused trouble initially:
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
766 Continuing.
767
768 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
769
770 baz
771 0000
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
776 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
777 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @b{Ctrl-d}
781 Program exited normally.
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
786 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
787 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
788
789 @smallexample
790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
791 @end smallexample
792
793 @node Invocation
794 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
795
796 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
797 The essentials are:
798 @itemize @bullet
799 @item
800 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
801 @item
802 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
803 @end itemize
804
805 @menu
806 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
807 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
808 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
809 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
810 @end menu
811
812 @node Invoking GDB
813 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
814
815 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
816 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
817
818 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
819 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
820
821 The command-line options described here are designed
822 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
823 options may effectively be unavailable.
824
825 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
826 specifying an executable program:
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
830 @end smallexample
831
832 @noindent
833 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
834 specified:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
838 @end smallexample
839
840 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
841 to debug a running process:
842
843 @smallexample
844 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
845 @end smallexample
846
847 @noindent
848 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
849 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
850
851 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
852 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
853 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
854 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
855 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
856
857 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
858 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
859 option processing.
860 @smallexample
861 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
862 @end smallexample
863 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
864 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
865
866 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
867 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} -silent
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
875 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
876
877 @noindent
878 Type
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -help
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
886 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
887
888 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
889 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
890 @samp{-x} option is used.
891
892
893 @menu
894 * File Options:: Choosing files
895 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
896 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
897 @end menu
898
899 @node File Options
900 @subsection Choosing Files
901
902 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
903 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
904 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
905 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
906 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
907 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
908 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
909 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
910 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
911 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
912 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
913 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
914 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
915
916 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
917 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
918 argument and ignore it.
919
920 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
921 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
922 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
923 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
924 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
925
926 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
927 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
928 @c it.
929
930 @table @code
931 @item -symbols @var{file}
932 @itemx -s @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--symbols}
934 @cindex @code{-s}
935 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
936
937 @item -exec @var{file}
938 @itemx -e @var{file}
939 @cindex @code{--exec}
940 @cindex @code{-e}
941 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
942 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
943
944 @item -se @var{file}
945 @cindex @code{--se}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
947 file.
948
949 @item -core @var{file}
950 @itemx -c @var{file}
951 @cindex @code{--core}
952 @cindex @code{-c}
953 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
954
955 @item -pid @var{number}
956 @itemx -p @var{number}
957 @cindex @code{--pid}
958 @cindex @code{-p}
959 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
960
961 @item -command @var{file}
962 @itemx -x @var{file}
963 @cindex @code{--command}
964 @cindex @code{-x}
965 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
966 Files,, Command files}.
967
968 @item -eval-command @var{command}
969 @itemx -ex @var{command}
970 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
971 @cindex @code{-ex}
972 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
973
974 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
975 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
976
977 @smallexample
978 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
979 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
980 @end smallexample
981
982 @item -directory @var{directory}
983 @itemx -d @var{directory}
984 @cindex @code{--directory}
985 @cindex @code{-d}
986 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
987
988 @item -r
989 @itemx -readnow
990 @cindex @code{--readnow}
991 @cindex @code{-r}
992 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
993 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
994 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
995
996 @end table
997
998 @node Mode Options
999 @subsection Choosing Modes
1000
1001 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1002 batch mode or quiet mode.
1003
1004 @table @code
1005 @item -nx
1006 @itemx -n
1007 @cindex @code{--nx}
1008 @cindex @code{-n}
1009 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1010 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1011 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1012 Files}.
1013
1014 @item -quiet
1015 @itemx -silent
1016 @itemx -q
1017 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1018 @cindex @code{--silent}
1019 @cindex @code{-q}
1020 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1021 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1022
1023 @item -batch
1024 @cindex @code{--batch}
1025 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1026 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1027 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1028 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1029 in the command files.
1030
1031 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1032 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1033 make this more useful, the message
1034
1035 @smallexample
1036 Program exited normally.
1037 @end smallexample
1038
1039 @noindent
1040 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1041 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1042 mode.
1043
1044 @item -batch-silent
1045 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1046 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1047 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1048 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1049 for an interactive session.
1050
1051 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1052 messages, for example.
1053
1054 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1055 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1056
1057 @item -return-child-result
1058 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1059 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1060 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1061
1062 @itemize @bullet
1063 @item
1064 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1065 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1066 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1067 @item
1068 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1069 @item
1070 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1071 the exit code will be -1.
1072 @end itemize
1073
1074 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1075 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1076 interface.
1077
1078 @item -nowindows
1079 @itemx -nw
1080 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1081 @cindex @code{-nw}
1082 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1083 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1084 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1085
1086 @item -windows
1087 @itemx -w
1088 @cindex @code{--windows}
1089 @cindex @code{-w}
1090 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1091 used if possible.
1092
1093 @item -cd @var{directory}
1094 @cindex @code{--cd}
1095 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1096 instead of the current directory.
1097
1098 @item -fullname
1099 @itemx -f
1100 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1101 @cindex @code{-f}
1102 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1103 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1104 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1105 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1106 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1107 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1108 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1109 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1110 frame.
1111
1112 @item -epoch
1113 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1114 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1115 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1116 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1117 separate window.
1118
1119 @item -annotate @var{level}
1120 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1121 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1122 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1123 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1124 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1125 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1126 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1127 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1128 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1129
1130 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1131 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1132
1133 @item --args
1134 @cindex @code{--args}
1135 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1136 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1137 This option stops option processing.
1138
1139 @item -baud @var{bps}
1140 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1141 @cindex @code{--baud}
1142 @cindex @code{-b}
1143 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1144 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -l @var{timeout}
1147 @cindex @code{-l}
1148 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1149 for remote debugging.
1150
1151 @item -tty @var{device}
1152 @itemx -t @var{device}
1153 @cindex @code{--tty}
1154 @cindex @code{-t}
1155 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1156 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1157
1158 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1159 @item -tui
1160 @cindex @code{--tui}
1161 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1162 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1163 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1164 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1165 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1166 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1167 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1168
1169 @c @item -xdb
1170 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1171 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1172 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1173 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1174 @c systems.
1175
1176 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1177 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1178 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1179 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1180 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1181 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1182
1183 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1184 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1185 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1186 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1187 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1188 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1189
1190 @item -write
1191 @cindex @code{--write}
1192 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1193 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1194 (@pxref{Patching}).
1195
1196 @item -statistics
1197 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1199 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1200
1201 @item -version
1202 @cindex @code{--version}
1203 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1204 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 @node Startup
1209 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1210 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1211
1212 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1213
1214 @enumerate
1215 @item
1216 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1217 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1218
1219 @item
1220 @cindex init file
1221 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1222 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1223 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1224 that file.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Processes command line options and operands.
1228
1229 @item
1230 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1231 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1232 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1233 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1234 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1235 @value{GDBN}.
1236
1237 @item
1238 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1239 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1240
1241 @item
1242 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1243 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1244 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1245 @end enumerate
1246
1247 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1248 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1249 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1250 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1251 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1252 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1253
1254 @cindex init file name
1255 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1256 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1257 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1258 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1259 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1260 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1261 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1262 the file to the standard name.
1263
1264
1265 @node Quitting GDB
1266 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1267 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1268 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1269
1270 @table @code
1271 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1272 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1273 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274 @itemx q
1275 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1276 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1277 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1278 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1279 error code.
1280 @end table
1281
1282 @cindex interrupt
1283 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1284 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1285 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1286 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1287 until a time when it is safe.
1288
1289 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1290 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1291 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1292
1293 @node Shell Commands
1294 @section Shell Commands
1295
1296 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1297 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1298 just use the @code{shell} command.
1299
1300 @table @code
1301 @kindex shell
1302 @cindex shell escape
1303 @item shell @var{command string}
1304 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1305 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1306 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1307 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1308 @end table
1309
1310 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1311 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1312 @value{GDBN}:
1313
1314 @table @code
1315 @kindex make
1316 @cindex calling make
1317 @item make @var{make-args}
1318 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1319 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1320 @end table
1321
1322 @node Logging Output
1323 @section Logging Output
1324 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1325 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1326
1327 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1328 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1329
1330 @table @code
1331 @kindex set logging
1332 @item set logging on
1333 Enable logging.
1334 @item set logging off
1335 Disable logging.
1336 @cindex logging file name
1337 @item set logging file @var{file}
1338 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1339 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1340 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1341 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1342 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1343 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1344 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1345 @kindex show logging
1346 @item show logging
1347 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1348 @end table
1349
1350 @node Commands
1351 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1352
1353 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1354 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1355 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1356 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1357 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1358
1359 @menu
1360 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1361 * Completion:: Command completion
1362 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1363 @end menu
1364
1365 @node Command Syntax
1366 @section Command Syntax
1367
1368 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1369 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1370 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1371 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1372 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1373 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1374
1375 @cindex abbreviation
1376 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1377 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1378 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1379 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1380 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1381 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1382 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1383
1384 @cindex repeating commands
1385 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1386 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1387 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1388 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1389 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1390 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1391 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1392
1393 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1394 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1395 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1396
1397 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1398 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1399 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1400 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1401 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1402
1403 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1404 @cindex comment
1405 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1406 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1407 Files,,Command Files}).
1408
1409 @cindex repeating command sequences
1410 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1411 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1412 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1413 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1414 for editing.
1415
1416 @node Completion
1417 @section Command Completion
1418
1419 @cindex completion
1420 @cindex word completion
1421 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1422 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1423 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1424 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1425
1426 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1427 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1428 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1429 enter it). For example, if you type
1430
1431 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1432 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1433 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1434 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1435 @smallexample
1436 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1437 @end smallexample
1438
1439 @noindent
1440 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1441 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1442
1443 @smallexample
1444 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1445 @end smallexample
1446
1447 @noindent
1448 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1449 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1450 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1451 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1452 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1453 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1454
1455 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1456 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1457 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1458 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1459 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1460 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1461 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1462 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1463 example:
1464
1465 @smallexample
1466 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1467 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1468 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1469 make_abs_section make_function_type
1470 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1471 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1472 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1473 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1474 @end smallexample
1475
1476 @noindent
1477 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1478 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1479 command.
1480
1481 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1482 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1483 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1484 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1485 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1486
1487 @cindex quotes in commands
1488 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1489 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1490 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1491 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1492 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1493 @value{GDBN} commands.
1494
1495 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1496 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1497 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1498 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1499 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1500 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1501 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1502 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1503 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1504 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1505 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1506
1507 @smallexample
1508 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1509 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1511 @end smallexample
1512
1513 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1514 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1515 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1516 place:
1517
1518 @smallexample
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1520 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1522 @end smallexample
1523
1524 @noindent
1525 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1526 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1527 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1528
1529 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1530 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1531 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1532 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1533
1534 @cindex completion of structure field names
1535 @cindex structure field name completion
1536 @cindex completion of union field names
1537 @cindex union field name completion
1538 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1539 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1540 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1541 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1542 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1543 left-hand-side:
1544
1545 @smallexample
1546 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1547 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1548 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1549 @end smallexample
1550
1551 @noindent
1552 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1553 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1554 follows:
1555
1556 @smallexample
1557 struct ui_file
1558 @{
1559 int *magic;
1560 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1561 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1562 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1563 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1564 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1565 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1566 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1567 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1568 void *to_data;
1569 @}
1570 @end smallexample
1571
1572
1573 @node Help
1574 @section Getting Help
1575 @cindex online documentation
1576 @kindex help
1577
1578 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1579 using the command @code{help}.
1580
1581 @table @code
1582 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1583 @item help
1584 @itemx h
1585 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1586 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1587
1588 @smallexample
1589 (@value{GDBP}) help
1590 List of classes of commands:
1591
1592 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1593 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1594 data -- Examining data
1595 files -- Specifying and examining files
1596 internals -- Maintenance commands
1597 obscure -- Obscure features
1598 running -- Running the program
1599 stack -- Examining the stack
1600 status -- Status inquiries
1601 support -- Support facilities
1602 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1603 stopping the program
1604 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1605
1606 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1607 commands in that class.
1608 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1609 documentation.
1610 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1611 (@value{GDBP})
1612 @end smallexample
1613 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1614
1615 @item help @var{class}
1616 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1617 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1618 help display for the class @code{status}:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1622 Status inquiries.
1623
1624 List of commands:
1625
1626 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1627 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1628 info -- Generic command for showing things
1629 about the program being debugged
1630 show -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the debugger
1632
1633 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1634 documentation.
1635 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1636 (@value{GDBP})
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @item help @var{command}
1640 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1641 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1642
1643 @kindex apropos
1644 @item apropos @var{args}
1645 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1646 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1647 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1648
1649 @smallexample
1650 apropos reload
1651 @end smallexample
1652
1653 @noindent
1654 results in:
1655
1656 @smallexample
1657 @c @group
1658 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1659 multiple times in one run
1660 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662 @c @end group
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @kindex complete
1666 @item complete @var{args}
1667 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1668 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1669 command you want completed. For example:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 complete i
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 @noindent results in:
1676
1677 @smallexample
1678 @group
1679 if
1680 ignore
1681 info
1682 inspect
1683 @end group
1684 @end smallexample
1685
1686 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1687 @end table
1688
1689 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1690 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1691 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1692 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1693 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1694 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1695
1696 @c @group
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex info
1699 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1700 @item info
1701 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1702 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1703 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1704 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1705 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1706 @w{@code{help info}}.
1707
1708 @kindex set
1709 @item set
1710 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1711 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1712 @code{set prompt $}.
1713
1714 @kindex show
1715 @item show
1716 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1717 @value{GDBN} itself.
1718 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1719 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1720 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1721 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1722
1723 @kindex info set
1724 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1725 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1726 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1727 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1728 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1729 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1730 @end table
1731 @c @end group
1732
1733 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1734 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1735
1736 @table @code
1737 @kindex show version
1738 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1739 @item show version
1740 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1741 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1742 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1743 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1744 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1745 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1746 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1747 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1748 @value{GDBN}.
1749
1750 @kindex show copying
1751 @kindex info copying
1752 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1753 @item show copying
1754 @itemx info copying
1755 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1756
1757 @kindex show warranty
1758 @kindex info warranty
1759 @item show warranty
1760 @itemx info warranty
1761 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1762 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1763
1764 @end table
1765
1766 @node Running
1767 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1768
1769 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1770 debugging information when you compile it.
1771
1772 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1773 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1774 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1775 kill a child process.
1776
1777 @menu
1778 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1779 * Starting:: Starting your program
1780 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1781 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1782
1783 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1784 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1785 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1786 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1787
1788 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1789 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1790 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1791 @end menu
1792
1793 @node Compilation
1794 @section Compiling for Debugging
1795
1796 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1797 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1798 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1799 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1800 and addresses in the executable code.
1801
1802 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1803 the compiler.
1804
1805 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1806 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1807 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1808 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1809 executables containing debugging information.
1810
1811 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1812 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1813 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1814 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1815 in pushing your luck.
1816
1817 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1818 @cindex debugging optimized code
1819 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1820 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1821 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1822 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1823 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1824 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1825
1826 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1827 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1828 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1829 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1830 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1831
1832 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1833 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1834 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1835
1836 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1837 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1838 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1839 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1840 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1841 provides macro information if you specify the options
1842 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1843 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1844 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1845 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1846 @option{-g} alone.
1847
1848 @need 2000
1849 @node Starting
1850 @section Starting your Program
1851 @cindex starting
1852 @cindex running
1853
1854 @table @code
1855 @kindex run
1856 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1857 @item run
1858 @itemx r
1859 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1860 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1861 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1862 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1863 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1864
1865 @end table
1866
1867 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1868 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1869 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1870 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1871 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1872 message like this one:
1873
1874 @smallexample
1875 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1876 Try "help target" or "continue".
1877 @end smallexample
1878
1879 @noindent
1880 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1881 first (@pxref{load}).
1882
1883 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1884 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1885 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1886 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1887 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1888 divided into four categories:
1889
1890 @table @asis
1891 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1892 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1893 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1894 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1895 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1896 the arguments.
1897 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1898 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1899 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1900
1901 @item The @emph{environment.}
1902 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1903 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1904 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1905 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1906
1907 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1908 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1909 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1910 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1911
1912 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1913 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1914 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1915 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1916 set a different device for your program.
1917 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1918
1919 @cindex pipes
1920 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1921 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1922 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1923 wrong program.
1924 @end table
1925
1926 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1927 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1928 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1929 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1930 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1931
1932 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1933 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1934 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1935 your current breakpoints.
1936
1937 @table @code
1938 @kindex start
1939 @item start
1940 @cindex run to main procedure
1941 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1942 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1943 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1944 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1945 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1946 procedure, depending on the language used.
1947
1948 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1949 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1950 the @samp{run} command.
1951
1952 @cindex elaboration phase
1953 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1954 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1955 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1956 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1957 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1958 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1959 will remain to halt execution.
1960
1961 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1962 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1963 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1964 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1965 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1966
1967 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1968 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1969 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1970 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1971 elaboration code before running your program.
1972
1973 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1974 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1975 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1976 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1977 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1978 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1979 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1980 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1981 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1982 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1983 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1984
1985 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1986 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1987 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1988 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1989
1990 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1991 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1992 environment:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1996 (@value{GDBP}) run
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2000 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2001
2002 @kindex set disable-randomization
2003 @item set disable-randomization
2004 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2005 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2006 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2007 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2008 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2009
2010 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2011 behavior using
2012
2013 @smallexample
2014 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2015 @end smallexample
2016
2017 @item set disable-randomization off
2018 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2019 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2020 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2021 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2022 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2023 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2024
2025 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2026 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2027 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2028 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2029 a code at its expected addresses.
2030
2031 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2032 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2033 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2034 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2035 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2036 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2037 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2038 a randomly chosen address.
2039
2040 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2041 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2042 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2043 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2044 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2045
2046 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2047 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2048
2049 @item show disable-randomization
2050 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2051 the virtual address space of the started program.
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 @node Arguments
2056 @section Your Program's Arguments
2057
2058 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2059 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2060 @code{run} command.
2061 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2062 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2063 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2064 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2065 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2066
2067 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2068 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2069 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2070 the program, not by the shell.
2071
2072 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2073 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2074
2075 @table @code
2076 @kindex set args
2077 @item set args
2078 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2079 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2080 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2081 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2082 it again without arguments.
2083
2084 @kindex show args
2085 @item show args
2086 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2087 @end table
2088
2089 @node Environment
2090 @section Your Program's Environment
2091
2092 @cindex environment (of your program)
2093 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2094 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2095 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2096 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2097 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2098 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2099 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2100
2101 @table @code
2102 @kindex path
2103 @item path @var{directory}
2104 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2105 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2106 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2107 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2108 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2109 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2110 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2111
2112 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2113 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2114 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2115 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2116 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2117 @var{directory} to the search path.
2118 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2119 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2120
2121 @kindex show paths
2122 @item show paths
2123 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2124 environment variable).
2125
2126 @kindex show environment
2127 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2128 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2129 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2130 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2131 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2132
2133 @kindex set environment
2134 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2135 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2136 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2137 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2138 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2139 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2140 null value.
2141 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2142 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2143
2144 For example, this command:
2145
2146 @smallexample
2147 set env USER = foo
2148 @end smallexample
2149
2150 @noindent
2151 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2152 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2153 are not actually required.)
2154
2155 @kindex unset environment
2156 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2157 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2158 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2159 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2160 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2161 @end table
2162
2163 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2164 the shell indicated
2165 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2166 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2167 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2168 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2169 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2170 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2171 @file{.profile}.
2172
2173 @node Working Directory
2174 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2175
2176 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2177 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2178 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2179 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2180 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2181 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2182
2183 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2184 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2185 Specify Files}.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex cd
2189 @cindex change working directory
2190 @item cd @var{directory}
2191 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2192
2193 @kindex pwd
2194 @item pwd
2195 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2196 @end table
2197
2198 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2199 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2200 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2201 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2202 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2203 current working directory of the debuggee.
2204
2205 @node Input/Output
2206 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2207
2208 @cindex redirection
2209 @cindex i/o
2210 @cindex terminal
2211 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2212 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2213 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2214 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2215 running your program.
2216
2217 @table @code
2218 @kindex info terminal
2219 @item info terminal
2220 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2221 program is using.
2222 @end table
2223
2224 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2225 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2226
2227 @smallexample
2228 run > outfile
2229 @end smallexample
2230
2231 @noindent
2232 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2233
2234 @kindex tty
2235 @cindex controlling terminal
2236 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2237 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2238 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2239 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2240 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2241
2242 @smallexample
2243 tty /dev/ttyb
2244 @end smallexample
2245
2246 @noindent
2247 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2248 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2249 that as their controlling terminal.
2250
2251 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2252 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2253 terminal.
2254
2255 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2256 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2257 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2258 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2259
2260 @cindex inferior tty
2261 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2262 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2263 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2264 program.
2265
2266 @table @code
2267 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2268 @kindex set inferior-tty
2269 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2270
2271 @item show inferior-tty
2272 @kindex show inferior-tty
2273 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2274 @end table
2275
2276 @node Attach
2277 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2278 @kindex attach
2279 @cindex attach
2280
2281 @table @code
2282 @item attach @var{process-id}
2283 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2284 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2285 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2286 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2287 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2288
2289 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2290 executing the command.
2291 @end table
2292
2293 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2294 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2295 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2296 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2297
2298 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2299 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2300 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2301 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2302 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2303 Specify Files}.
2304
2305 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2306 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2307 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2308 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2309 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2310 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2311 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2312
2313 @table @code
2314 @kindex detach
2315 @item detach
2316 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2317 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2318 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2319 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2320 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2321 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2322 executing the command.
2323 @end table
2324
2325 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2326 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2327 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2328 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2329 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2330 Messages}).
2331
2332 @node Kill Process
2333 @section Killing the Child Process
2334
2335 @table @code
2336 @kindex kill
2337 @item kill
2338 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2339 @end table
2340
2341 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2342 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2343 is running.
2344
2345 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2346 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2347 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2348 outside the debugger.
2349
2350 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2351 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2352 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2353 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2354 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2355 breakpoint settings).
2356
2357 @node Threads
2358 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2359
2360 @cindex threads of execution
2361 @cindex multiple threads
2362 @cindex switching threads
2363 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2364 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2365 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2366 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2367 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2368 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2369 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2370
2371 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2372 programs:
2373
2374 @itemize @bullet
2375 @item automatic notification of new threads
2376 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2377 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2378 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2379 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2380 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2381 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2382 messages on thread start and exit.
2383 @end itemize
2384
2385 @quotation
2386 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2387 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2388 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2389 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2390 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2391 like this:
2392
2393 @smallexample
2394 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2395 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2396 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2397 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2398 @end smallexample
2399 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2400 @c doesn't support threads"?
2401 @end quotation
2402
2403 @cindex focus of debugging
2404 @cindex current thread
2405 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2406 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2407 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2408 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2409 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2410
2411 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2412 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2413 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2414 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2415 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2416 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2417 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2418 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2419 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2420 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2421
2422 @smallexample
2423 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2424 @end smallexample
2425
2426 @noindent
2427 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2428 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2429 further qualifier.
2430
2431 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2432 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2433 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2434 @c program?
2435 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2436 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2437 @c threads ab initio?
2438
2439 @cindex thread number
2440 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2441 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2442 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2443
2444 @table @code
2445 @kindex info threads
2446 @item info threads
2447 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2448 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2449
2450 @enumerate
2451 @item
2452 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2453
2454 @item
2455 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2456
2457 @item
2458 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2459 @end enumerate
2460
2461 @noindent
2462 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2463 indicates the current thread.
2464
2465 For example,
2466 @end table
2467 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2468
2469 @smallexample
2470 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2471 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2472 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2473 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2474 at threadtest.c:68
2475 @end smallexample
2476
2477 On HP-UX systems:
2478
2479 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2480 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2481 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2482 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2483 thread in your program.
2484
2485 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2486 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2487 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2488 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2489 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2490 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2491 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2492 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2493 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2494 HP-UX, you see
2495
2496 @smallexample
2497 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2498 @end smallexample
2499
2500 @noindent
2501 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2502
2503 @table @code
2504 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2505 @item info threads
2506 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2507 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2508
2509 @enumerate
2510 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2511
2512 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2513
2514 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2515 @end enumerate
2516
2517 @noindent
2518 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2519 indicates the current thread.
2520
2521 For example,
2522 @end table
2523 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2524
2525 @smallexample
2526 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2527 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2528 at quicksort.c:137
2529 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2530 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2531 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2532 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2533 @end smallexample
2534
2535 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2536 Solaris-specific command:
2537
2538 @table @code
2539 @item maint info sol-threads
2540 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2541 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2542 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2543 @end table
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2547 @item thread @var{threadno}
2548 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2549 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2550 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2551 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2552 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2553
2554 @smallexample
2555 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2556 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2557 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2558 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2559 @end smallexample
2560
2561 @noindent
2562 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2563 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2564 threads.
2565
2566 @kindex thread apply
2567 @cindex apply command to several threads
2568 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2569 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2570 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2571 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2572 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2573 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2574 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2575 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2576
2577 @kindex set print thread-events
2578 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2579 @item set print thread-events
2580 @itemx set print thread-events on
2581 @itemx set print thread-events off
2582 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2583 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2584 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2585 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2586 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2587
2588 @kindex show print thread-events
2589 @item show print thread-events
2590 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2591 have started and exited.
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2595 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2596 programs with multiple threads.
2597
2598 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2599 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2600
2601 @node Processes
2602 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2603
2604 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2605 @cindex multiple processes
2606 @cindex processes, multiple
2607 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2608 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2609 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2610 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2611 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2612 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2613 will cause it to terminate.
2614
2615 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2616 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2617 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2618 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2619 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2620 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2621 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2622 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2623 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2624 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2625
2626 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2627 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2628 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2629 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2630
2631 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2632 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2633
2634 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2635 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2636
2637 @table @code
2638 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2639 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2640 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2641 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2642 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @item parent
2646 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2647 unimpeded. This is the default.
2648
2649 @item child
2650 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2651 unimpeded.
2652
2653 @end table
2654
2655 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2656 @item show follow-fork-mode
2657 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2658 @end table
2659
2660 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2661 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2662 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2663
2664 @table @code
2665 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2666 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2667 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2668 retain debugger control over them both.
2669
2670 @table @code
2671 @item on
2672 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2673 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2674 independently. This is the default.
2675
2676 @item off
2677 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2678 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2679 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2680 is held suspended.
2681
2682 @end table
2683
2684 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2685 @item show detach-on-fork
2686 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2687 @end table
2688
2689 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2690 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2691 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2692 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2693 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex info forks
2697 @item info forks
2698 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2699 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2700 position (program counter) of the process.
2701
2702 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2703 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2704 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2705 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2706 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2707
2708 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2709 @item process @var{process-id}
2710 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2711 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2712 @samp{info forks}.
2713
2714 @end table
2715
2716 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2717 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2718 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2719 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2720
2721 @table @code
2722 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2723 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2724 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2725 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2726 allowed to run independently.
2727
2728 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2729 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2730 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2731 and remove it from the fork list.
2732
2733 @end table
2734
2735 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2736 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2737 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2738 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2739 the child process's @code{main}.
2740
2741 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2742 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2743
2744 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2745 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2746 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2747 argument.
2748
2749 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2750 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2751 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2752
2753 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2754 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2755
2756 @cindex checkpoint
2757 @cindex restart
2758 @cindex bookmark
2759 @cindex snapshot of a process
2760 @cindex rewind program state
2761
2762 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2763 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2764 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2765 later.
2766
2767 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2768 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2769 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2770 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2771 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2772
2773 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2774 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2775 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2776 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2777 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2778 start again from there.
2779
2780 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2781 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2782
2783 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2784
2785 @table @code
2786 @kindex checkpoint
2787 @item checkpoint
2788 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2789 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2790 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2791
2792 @kindex info checkpoints
2793 @item info checkpoints
2794 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2795 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2796 listed:
2797
2798 @table @code
2799 @item Checkpoint ID
2800 @item Process ID
2801 @item Code Address
2802 @item Source line, or label
2803 @end table
2804
2805 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2806 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2807 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2808 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2809 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2810 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2811 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2812
2813 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2814 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2815 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2816 the debugger.
2817
2818 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2819 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2820 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2821
2822 @end table
2823
2824 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2825 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2826 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2827 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2828 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2829 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2830 previously read data can be read again.
2831
2832 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2833 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2834 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2835 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2836 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2837 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2838
2839 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2840 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2841 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2842 different execution path this time.
2843
2844 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2845 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2846 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2847 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2848 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2849 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2850 potentially pose a problem.
2851
2852 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2853
2854 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2855 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2856 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2857 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2858 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2859 next.
2860
2861 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2862 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2863 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2864 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2865 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2866
2867 @node Stopping
2868 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2869
2870 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2871 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2872 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2873
2874 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2875 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2876 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2877 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2878 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2879 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2880 explicitly request this information at any time.
2881
2882 @table @code
2883 @kindex info program
2884 @item info program
2885 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2886 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2887 @end table
2888
2889 @menu
2890 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2891 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2892 * Signals:: Signals
2893 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2894 @end menu
2895
2896 @node Breakpoints
2897 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2898
2899 @cindex breakpoints
2900 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2901 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2902 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2903 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2904 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2905 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2906 program.
2907
2908 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2909 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2910 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2911 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2912 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2913 call).
2914
2915 @cindex watchpoints
2916 @cindex data breakpoints
2917 @cindex memory tracing
2918 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2919 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2920 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2921 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2922 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2923 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2924 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2925 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2926 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2927 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2928 same commands.
2929
2930 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2931 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2932 Automatic Display}.
2933
2934 @cindex catchpoints
2935 @cindex breakpoint on events
2936 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2937 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2938 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2939 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2940 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2941 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2942 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2943
2944 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2945 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2946 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2947 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2948 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2949 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2950 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2951 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2952 enable it again.
2953
2954 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2955 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2956 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2957 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2958 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2959 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2960 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2961
2962 @menu
2963 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2964 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2965 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2966 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2967 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2968 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2969 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2970 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2971 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2972 @end menu
2973
2974 @node Set Breaks
2975 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2976
2977 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2978 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2979 @c
2980 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2981
2982 @kindex break
2983 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2984 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2985 @cindex latest breakpoint
2986 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2987 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2988 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2989 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2990 convenience variables.
2991
2992 @table @code
2993 @item break @var{location}
2994 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2995 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2996 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2997 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2998 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2999
3000 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3001 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3002 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3003 that situation.
3004
3005 @item break
3006 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3007 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3008 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3009 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3010 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3011 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3012 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3013 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3014 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3015 inside loops.
3016
3017 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3018 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3019 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3020 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3021 existed when your program stopped.
3022
3023 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3024 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3025 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3026 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3027 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3028 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3029 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3030
3031 @kindex tbreak
3032 @item tbreak @var{args}
3033 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3034 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3035 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3036 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3037
3038 @kindex hbreak
3039 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3040 @item hbreak @var{args}
3041 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3042 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3043 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3044 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3045 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3046 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3047 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3048 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3049 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3050 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3051 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3052 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3053 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3054 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3055 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3056 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3057 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3058 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3059
3060 @kindex thbreak
3061 @item thbreak @var{args}
3062 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3063 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3064 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3065 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3066 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3067 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3068 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3069 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3070
3071 @kindex rbreak
3072 @cindex regular expression
3073 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3074 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3075 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3076 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3077 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3078 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3079 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3080 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3081 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3082
3083 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3084 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3085 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3086 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3087 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3088 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3089
3090 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3091 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3092 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3093 classes.
3094
3095 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3096 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3097 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3098
3099 @smallexample
3100 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3101 @end smallexample
3102
3103 @kindex info breakpoints
3104 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3105 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3106 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3107 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3108 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3109 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3110 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3111 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3112
3113 @table @emph
3114 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3115 @item Type
3116 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3117 @item Disposition
3118 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3119 @item Enabled or Disabled
3120 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3121 that are not enabled.
3122 @item Address
3123 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3124 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3125 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3126 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3127 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3128 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3129 @item What
3130 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3131 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3132 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3133 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3134 @end table
3135
3136 @noindent
3137 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3138 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3139 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3140 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3141 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3142 valid location.
3143
3144 @noindent
3145 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3146 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3147 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3148 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3149 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3150
3151 @noindent
3152 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3153 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3154 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3155 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3156 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3157 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3158 @end table
3159
3160 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3161 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3162 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3163 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3164
3165 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3166 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3167 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3168 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3169
3170 @itemize @bullet
3171 @item
3172 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3173 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3174
3175 @item
3176 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3177 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3178
3179 @item
3180 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3181 several places where that function is inlined.
3182 @end itemize
3183
3184 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3185 the relevant locations@footnote{
3186 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3187 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3188 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3189 info with line numbers for them.}.
3190
3191 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3192 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3193 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3194 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3195 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3196 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3197 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3198
3199 For example:
3200
3201 @smallexample
3202 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3203 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3204 stop only if i==1
3205 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3206 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3207 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3208 @end smallexample
3209
3210 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3211 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3212 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3213 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3214 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3215 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3216 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3217 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3218 that belong to that breakpoint.
3219
3220 @cindex pending breakpoints
3221 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3222 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3223 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3224 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3225 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3226 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3227 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3228 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3229 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3230 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3231 is not yet resolved.
3232
3233 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3234 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3235 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3236 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3237 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3238 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3239
3240 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3241 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3242 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3243 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3244
3245 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3246 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3247 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3248
3249 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3250 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3251 address specification to an address:
3252
3253 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3254 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3255 @table @code
3256 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3257 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3258 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3259
3260 @item set breakpoint pending on
3261 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3262 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3263
3264 @item set breakpoint pending off
3265 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3266 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3267 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3268
3269 @item show breakpoint pending
3270 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3271 @end table
3272
3273 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3274 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3275 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3276
3277 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3278 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3279 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3280 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3281 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3282 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3283 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3284 breakpoints.
3285
3286 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3287
3288 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3289 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3290 @table @code
3291 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3292 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3293 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3294 breakpoint must be used.
3295
3296 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3297 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3298 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3299 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3300 @end table
3301
3302 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3303 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3304 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3305 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3306 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3307 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3308 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3309 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3310 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3311
3312 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3313 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3314 @table @code
3315 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3316 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3317 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3318 removed from the target when it stops.
3319
3320 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3321 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3322 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3323 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3324 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3325
3326 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3327 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3328 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3329 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3330 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3331 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3332 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3333 @end table
3334
3335 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3336 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3337 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3338 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3339 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3340 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3341 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3342 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3343
3344
3345 @node Set Watchpoints
3346 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3347
3348 @cindex setting watchpoints
3349 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3350 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3351 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3352 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3353 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3354
3355 @itemize @bullet
3356 @item
3357 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3358
3359 @item
3360 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3361 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3362 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3363
3364 @item
3365 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3366 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3367 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3368 @end itemize
3369
3370 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3371 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3372 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3373 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3374 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3375 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3376 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3377 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3378 the expression changes.
3379
3380 @cindex software watchpoints
3381 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3382 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3383 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3384 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3385 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3386 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3387 culprit.)
3388
3389 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3390 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3391 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3392
3393 @table @code
3394 @kindex watch
3395 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3396 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3397 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3398 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3399 to watch the value of a single variable:
3400
3401 @smallexample
3402 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3403 @end smallexample
3404
3405 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3406 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3407 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3408 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3409 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3410 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3411
3412 @kindex rwatch
3413 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3414 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3415 by the program.
3416
3417 @kindex awatch
3418 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3419 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3420 or written into by the program.
3421
3422 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3423 @item info watchpoints
3424 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3425 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3426 @end table
3427
3428 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3429 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3430 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3431 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3432 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3433 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3434
3435 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3436 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3437 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3438 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3439 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3440 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3441 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3442 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3443
3444 @table @code
3445 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3446 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3447 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3448
3449 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3450 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3451 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3452 @end table
3453
3454 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3455 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3456 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3457
3458 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3459
3460 @smallexample
3461 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3462 @end smallexample
3463
3464 @noindent
3465 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3466
3467 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3468 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3469 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3470 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3471 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3472 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3473 will print a message like this:
3474
3475 @smallexample
3476 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3477 @end smallexample
3478
3479 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3480 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3481 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3482 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3483 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3484 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3485 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3486 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3487
3488 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3489 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3490 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3491 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3492 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3493 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3494
3495 @smallexample
3496 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3497 @end smallexample
3498
3499 @noindent
3500 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3501
3502 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3503 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3504 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3505 expression with separately allocated resources.
3506
3507 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3508 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3509 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3510
3511 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3512 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3513 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3514 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3515 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3516 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3517 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3518 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3519 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3520
3521 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3522 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3523 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3524 watched expression from every thread.
3525
3526 @quotation
3527 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3528 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3529 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3530 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3531 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3532 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3533 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3534 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3535 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3536 @end quotation
3537
3538 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3539
3540 @node Set Catchpoints
3541 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3542 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3543 @cindex exception handlers
3544 @cindex event handling
3545
3546 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3547 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3548 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3549
3550 @table @code
3551 @kindex catch
3552 @item catch @var{event}
3553 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3554 @table @code
3555 @item throw
3556 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3557 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3558
3559 @item catch
3560 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3561
3562 @item exception
3563 @cindex Ada exception catching
3564 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3565 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3566 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3567 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3568 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3569
3570 @item exception unhandled
3571 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3572
3573 @item assert
3574 A failed Ada assertion.
3575
3576 @item exec
3577 @cindex break on fork/exec
3578 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3579 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3580
3581 @item fork
3582 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3583 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3584
3585 @item vfork
3586 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3587 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3588
3589 @item load
3590 @itemx load @var{libname}
3591 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3592 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3593 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3594
3595 @item unload
3596 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3597 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3598 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3599 @end table
3600
3601 @item tcatch @var{event}
3602 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3603 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3604
3605 @end table
3606
3607 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3608
3609 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3610 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3611
3612 @itemize @bullet
3613 @item
3614 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3615 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3616 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3617 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3618 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3619 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3620 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3621 disabled within interactive calls.
3622
3623 @item
3624 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3625
3626 @item
3627 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3628 @end itemize
3629
3630 @cindex raise exceptions
3631 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3632 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3633 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3634 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3635 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3636 out where the exception was raised.
3637
3638 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3639 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3640 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3641 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3642
3643 @smallexample
3644 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3645 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3646 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3647 @end smallexample
3648
3649 @noindent
3650 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3651 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3652 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3653
3654 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3655 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3656 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3657 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3658 raised.
3659
3660
3661 @node Delete Breaks
3662 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3663
3664 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3665 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3666 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3667 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3668 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3669 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3670
3671 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3672 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3673 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3674 their breakpoint numbers.
3675
3676 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3677 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3678 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3679
3680 @table @code
3681 @kindex clear
3682 @item clear
3683 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3684 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3685 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3686 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3687
3688 @item clear @var{location}
3689 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3690 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3691 most useful ones are listed below:
3692
3693 @table @code
3694 @item clear @var{function}
3695 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3696 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3697
3698 @item clear @var{linenum}
3699 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3700 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3701 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3702 @end table
3703
3704 @cindex delete breakpoints
3705 @kindex delete
3706 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3707 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3708 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3709 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3710 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3711 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3712 @end table
3713
3714 @node Disabling
3715 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3716
3717 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3718 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3719 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3720 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3721 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3722
3723 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3724 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3725 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3726 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3727 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3728
3729 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3730 affects all of its locations.
3731
3732 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3733 states of enablement:
3734
3735 @itemize @bullet
3736 @item
3737 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3738 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3739 @item
3740 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3741 @item
3742 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3743 disabled.
3744 @item
3745 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3746 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3747 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3748 @end itemize
3749
3750 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3751 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3752
3753 @table @code
3754 @kindex disable
3755 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3756 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3757 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3758 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3759 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3760 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3761 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3762
3763 @kindex enable
3764 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3765 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3766 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3767
3768 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3769 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3770 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3771
3772 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3773 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3774 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3775 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3776 @end table
3777
3778 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3779 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3780 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3781 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3782 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3783 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3784 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3785 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3786 Stepping}.)
3787
3788 @node Conditions
3789 @subsection Break Conditions
3790 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3791 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3792
3793 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3794 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3795 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3796 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3797 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3798 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3799 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3800 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3801
3802 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3803 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3804 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3805 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3806 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3807
3808 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3809 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3810 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3811 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3812 one.
3813
3814 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3815 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3816 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3817 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3818 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3819 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3820 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3821 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3822 conditions for the
3823 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3824 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3825
3826 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3827 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3828 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3829 with the @code{condition} command.
3830
3831 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3832 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3833 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3834 catchpoint.
3835
3836 @table @code
3837 @kindex condition
3838 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3839 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3840 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3841 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3842 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3843 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3844 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3845 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3846 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3847 prints an error message:
3848
3849 @smallexample
3850 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3851 @end smallexample
3852
3853 @noindent
3854 @value{GDBN} does
3855 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3856 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3857 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3858
3859 @item condition @var{bnum}
3860 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3861 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3862 @end table
3863
3864 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3865 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3866 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3867 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3868 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3869 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3870 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3871 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3872 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3873 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3874 your program reaches it.
3875
3876 @table @code
3877 @kindex ignore
3878 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3879 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3880 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3881 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3882 takes no action.
3883
3884 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3885 a count of zero.
3886
3887 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3888 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3889 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3890 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3891
3892 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3893 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3894 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3895
3896 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3897 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3898 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3899 Variables}.
3900 @end table
3901
3902 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3903
3904
3905 @node Break Commands
3906 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3907
3908 @cindex breakpoint commands
3909 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3910 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3911 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3912 enable other breakpoints.
3913
3914 @table @code
3915 @kindex commands
3916 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3917 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3918 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3919 @itemx end
3920 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3921 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3922 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3923
3924 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3925 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3926
3927 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3928 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3929 recently encountered).
3930 @end table
3931
3932 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3933 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3934
3935 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3936 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3937 that resumes execution.
3938
3939 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3940 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3941 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3942 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3943 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3944
3945 @kindex silent
3946 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3947 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3948 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3949 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3950 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3951 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3952
3953 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3954 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3955 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3956
3957 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3958 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3959
3960 @smallexample
3961 break foo if x>0
3962 commands
3963 silent
3964 printf "x is %d\n",x
3965 cont
3966 end
3967 @end smallexample
3968
3969 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3970 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3971 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3972 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3973 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3974 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3975 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3976
3977 @smallexample
3978 break 403
3979 commands
3980 silent
3981 set x = y + 4
3982 cont
3983 end
3984 @end smallexample
3985
3986 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3987 @node Error in Breakpoints
3988 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3989 @c
3990 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3991 @c
3992 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3993 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3994 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3995 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3996
3997 @smallexample
3998 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3999 The same program may be running in another process.
4000 @end smallexample
4001
4002 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
4003
4004 @enumerate
4005 @item
4006 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
4007
4008 @item
4009 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
4010 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
4011 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
4012 Then start your program again.
4013
4014 @item
4015 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
4016 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
4017 to nonsharable executables.
4018 @end enumerate
4019 @c @end ifclear
4020
4021 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
4022 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
4023
4024 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4025 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4026 @smallexample
4027 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4028 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4029 @end smallexample
4030
4031 @noindent
4032 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4033 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4034 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4035
4036 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4037 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4038
4039 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4040 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4041 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4042
4043 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4044 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4045 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4046 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4047
4048 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4049 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4050 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4051 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4052 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4053 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4054 first in the bundle.
4055
4056 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4057 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4058 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4059 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4060 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4061 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4062 is hit.
4063
4064 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4065 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4066
4067 @smallexample
4068 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4069 @end smallexample
4070
4071 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4072 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4073 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4074 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4075 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4076 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4077 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4078 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4079
4080 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4081 adjusted breakpoints:
4082
4083 @smallexample
4084 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4085 to 0x00010410.
4086 @end smallexample
4087
4088 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4089 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4090 frequently than expected.
4091
4092 @node Continuing and Stepping
4093 @section Continuing and Stepping
4094
4095 @cindex stepping
4096 @cindex continuing
4097 @cindex resuming execution
4098 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4099 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4100 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4101 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4102 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4103 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4104 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4105 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4106
4107 @table @code
4108 @kindex continue
4109 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4110 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4111 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4112 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4113 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4114 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4115 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4116 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4117 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4118 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4119
4120 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4121 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4122 @code{continue} is ignored.
4123
4124 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4125 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4126 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4127 @code{continue}.
4128 @end table
4129
4130 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4131 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4132 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4133 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4134
4135 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4136 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4137 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4138 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4139 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4140 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4141
4142 @table @code
4143 @kindex step
4144 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4145 @item step
4146 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4147 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4148 abbreviated @code{s}.
4149
4150 @quotation
4151 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4152 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4153 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4154 @c distinction here.
4155 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4156 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4157 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4158 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4159 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4160 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4161 below.
4162 @end quotation
4163
4164 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4165 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4166 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4167 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4168 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4169 called within the line.
4170
4171 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4172 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4173 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4174 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4175 was any debugging information about the routine.
4176
4177 @item step @var{count}
4178 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4179 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4180 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4181
4182 @kindex next
4183 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4184 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4185 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4186 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4187 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4188 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4189 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4190 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4191
4192 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4193
4194
4195 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4196 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4197 @c
4198 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4199 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4200 @c function are executed without stopping.
4201
4202 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4203 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4204 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4205
4206 @kindex set step-mode
4207 @item set step-mode
4208 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4209 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4210 @itemx set step-mode on
4211 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4212 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4213 information rather than stepping over it.
4214
4215 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4216 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4217 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4218
4219 @item set step-mode off
4220 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4221 debug information. This is the default.
4222
4223 @item show step-mode
4224 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4225 source line debug information.
4226
4227 @kindex finish
4228 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4229 @item finish
4230 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4231 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4232 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4233
4234 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4235 ,Returning from a Function}).
4236
4237 @kindex until
4238 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4239 @cindex run until specified location
4240 @item until
4241 @itemx u
4242 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4243 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4244 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4245 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4246 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4247 than the address of the jump.
4248
4249 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4250 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4251 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4252 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4253 through the next iteration.
4254
4255 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4256 stack frame.
4257
4258 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4259 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4260 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4261 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4262 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 (@value{GDBP}) f
4266 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4267 206 expand_input();
4268 (@value{GDBP}) until
4269 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4270 @end smallexample
4271
4272 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4273 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4274 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4275 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4276 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4277 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4278 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4279
4280 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4281 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4282 argument.
4283
4284 @item until @var{location}
4285 @itemx u @var{location}
4286 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4287 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4288 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4289 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4290 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4291 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4292 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4293 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4294 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4295 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4296 invocations have returned.
4297
4298 @smallexample
4299 94 int factorial (int value)
4300 95 @{
4301 96 if (value > 1) @{
4302 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4303 98 @}
4304 99 return (value);
4305 100 @}
4306 @end smallexample
4307
4308
4309 @kindex advance @var{location}
4310 @itemx advance @var{location}
4311 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4312 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4313 @ref{Specify Location}.
4314 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4315 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4316 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4317 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4318
4319
4320 @kindex stepi
4321 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4322 @item stepi
4323 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4324 @itemx si
4325 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4326
4327 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4328 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4329 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4330 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4331
4332 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4333
4334 @need 750
4335 @kindex nexti
4336 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4337 @item nexti
4338 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4339 @itemx ni
4340 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4341 proceed until the function returns.
4342
4343 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4344 @end table
4345
4346 @node Signals
4347 @section Signals
4348 @cindex signals
4349
4350 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4351 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4352 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4353 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4354 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4355 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4356 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4357 requested an alarm).
4358
4359 @cindex fatal signals
4360 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4361 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4362 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4363 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4364 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4365 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4366
4367 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4368 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4369 signal.
4370
4371 @cindex handling signals
4372 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4373 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4374 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4375 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4376 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4377
4378 @table @code
4379 @kindex info signals
4380 @kindex info handle
4381 @item info signals
4382 @itemx info handle
4383 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4384 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4385 the defined types of signals.
4386
4387 @item info signals @var{sig}
4388 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4389
4390 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4391
4392 @kindex handle
4393 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4394 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4395 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4396 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4397 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4398 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4399 say what change to make.
4400 @end table
4401
4402 @c @group
4403 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4404 Their full names are:
4405
4406 @table @code
4407 @item nostop
4408 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4409 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4410
4411 @item stop
4412 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4413 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4414
4415 @item print
4416 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4417
4418 @item noprint
4419 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4420 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4421
4422 @item pass
4423 @itemx noignore
4424 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4425 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4426 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4427
4428 @item nopass
4429 @itemx ignore
4430 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4431 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4432 @end table
4433 @c @end group
4434
4435 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4436 program until you
4437 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4438 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4439 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4440 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4441 program sees that signal when you continue.
4442
4443 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4444 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4445 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4446 erroneous signals.
4447
4448 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4449 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4450 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4451 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4452 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4453 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4454 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4455 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4456 Program a Signal}.
4457
4458 @node Thread Stops
4459 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4460
4461 @cindex stopped threads
4462 @cindex threads, stopped
4463
4464 @cindex continuing threads
4465 @cindex threads, continuing
4466
4467 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4468 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4469 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4470 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4471 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4472 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4473 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4474 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4475 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4476
4477 @menu
4478 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4479 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4480 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4481 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4482 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4483 @end menu
4484
4485 @node All-Stop Mode
4486 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4487
4488 @cindex all-stop mode
4489
4490 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4491 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4492 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4493 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4494 underfoot.
4495
4496 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4497 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4498 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4499
4500 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4501 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4502 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4503 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4504 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4505 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4506 stops.
4507
4508 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4509 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4510 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4511 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4512
4513 @cindex automatic thread selection
4514 @cindex switching threads automatically
4515 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4516 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4517 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4518 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4519 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4520 thread.
4521
4522 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4523 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4524
4525 @table @code
4526 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4527 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4528 @cindex lock scheduler
4529 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4530 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4531 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4532 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4533 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4534 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4535 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4536 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4537 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4538 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4539 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4540 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4541
4542 @item show scheduler-locking
4543 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4544 @end table
4545
4546 @node Non-Stop Mode
4547 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4548
4549 @cindex non-stop mode
4550
4551 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4552 @c with more details.
4553
4554 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4555 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4556 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4557 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4558 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4559 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4560
4561 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4562 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4563 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4564 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4565 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4566 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4567 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4568 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4569 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4570 independently and simultaneously.
4571
4572 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4573 or attach to your program:
4574
4575 @c FIXME: can we fix this recipe to avoid the linux-async/remote-async details?
4576
4577 @smallexample
4578 # Enable the async interface.
4579 # For target remote, use remote-async instead of linux-async.
4580 maint set linux-async 1
4581
4582 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4583 set pagination off
4584
4585 # Finally, turn it on!
4586 set non-stop on
4587 @end smallexample
4588
4589 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4590
4591 @table @code
4592 @kindex set non-stop
4593 @item set non-stop on
4594 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4595 @item set non-stop off
4596 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4597 @kindex show non-stop
4598 @item show non-stop
4599 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4600 @end table
4601
4602 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4603 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4604 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4605 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4606 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4607 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4608 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4609 default.
4610
4611 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4612 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4613 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4614
4615 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4616 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4617 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4618 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4619 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4620
4621 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4622 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4623 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4624 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4625 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4626
4627 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4628
4629 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4630 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4631 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4632 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4633 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4634 previously current thread.
4635
4636 @node Background Execution
4637 @subsection Background Execution
4638
4639 @cindex foreground execution
4640 @cindex background execution
4641 @cindex asynchronous execution
4642 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4643
4644 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4645 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4646 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4647 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4648 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4649 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4650
4651 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4652 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4653 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4654 are:
4655
4656 @table @code
4657 @kindex run&
4658 @item run
4659 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4660
4661 @item attach
4662 @kindex attach&
4663 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4664
4665 @item step
4666 @kindex step&
4667 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4668
4669 @item stepi
4670 @kindex stepi&
4671 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4672
4673 @item next
4674 @kindex next&
4675 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4676
4677 @item continue
4678 @kindex continue&
4679 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4680
4681 @item finish
4682 @kindex finish&
4683 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4684
4685 @item until
4686 @kindex until&
4687 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4688
4689 @end table
4690
4691 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4692 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4693 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4694 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4695 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4696 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4697
4698 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4699 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4700
4701 @table @code
4702 @kindex interrupt
4703 @item interrupt
4704 @itemx interrupt -a
4705
4706 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4707 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4708 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4709 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4710 @end table
4711
4712 You may need to explicitly enable async mode before you can use background
4713 execution commands. @xref{Maintenance Commands}, for details. If the
4714 target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error message
4715 if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4716
4717 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4718 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4719
4720 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4721 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4722 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4723
4724 @table @code
4725 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4726 @cindex thread breakpoints
4727 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4728 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4729 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4730 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4731 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4732 specify some source line.
4733
4734 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4735 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4736 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4737 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4738 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4739
4740 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4741 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4742 program.
4743
4744 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4745 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4746 breakpoint condition, like this:
4747
4748 @smallexample
4749 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4750 @end smallexample
4751
4752 @end table
4753
4754 @node Interrupted System Calls
4755 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4756
4757 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4758 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4759 @cindex premature return from system calls
4760 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4761 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4762 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4763 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4764 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4765 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4766 stop execution.
4767
4768 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4769 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4770 style anyways.
4771
4772 For example, do not write code like this:
4773
4774 @smallexample
4775 sleep (10);
4776 @end smallexample
4777
4778 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4779 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4780
4781 Instead, write this:
4782
4783 @smallexample
4784 int unslept = 10;
4785 while (unslept > 0)
4786 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4787 @end smallexample
4788
4789 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4790 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4791 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4792 @value{GDBN}.
4793
4794 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4795 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4796 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4797 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4798
4799
4800
4801 @node Stack
4802 @chapter Examining the Stack
4803
4804 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4805 stopped and how it got there.
4806
4807 @cindex call stack
4808 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4809 is generated.
4810 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4811 the arguments of the call,
4812 and the local variables of the function being called.
4813 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4814 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4815 stack}.
4816
4817 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4818 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4819
4820 @cindex selected frame
4821 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4822 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4823 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4824 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4825 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4826 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4827
4828 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4829 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4830 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4831
4832 @menu
4833 * Frames:: Stack frames
4834 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4835 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4836 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4837
4838 @end menu
4839
4840 @node Frames
4841 @section Stack Frames
4842
4843 @cindex frame, definition
4844 @cindex stack frame
4845 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4846 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4847 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4848 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4849 which the function is executing.
4850
4851 @cindex initial frame
4852 @cindex outermost frame
4853 @cindex innermost frame
4854 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4855 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4856 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4857 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4858 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4859 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4860 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4861 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4862
4863 @cindex frame pointer
4864 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4865 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4866 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4867 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4868 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4869 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4870
4871 @cindex frame number
4872 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4873 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4874 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4875 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4876 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4877
4878 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4879 @c underflow problems.
4880 @cindex frameless execution
4881 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4882 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4883 @smallexample
4884 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4885 @end smallexample
4886 generates functions without a frame.)
4887 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4888 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4889 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4890 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4891 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4892 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4893 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4894
4895 @table @code
4896 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4897 @cindex current stack frame
4898 @item frame @var{args}
4899 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4900 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4901 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4902 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4903
4904 @kindex select-frame
4905 @cindex selecting frame silently
4906 @item select-frame
4907 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4908 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4909 @code{frame}.
4910 @end table
4911
4912 @node Backtrace
4913 @section Backtraces
4914
4915 @cindex traceback
4916 @cindex call stack traces
4917 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4918 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4919 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4920 stack.
4921
4922 @table @code
4923 @kindex backtrace
4924 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4925 @item backtrace
4926 @itemx bt
4927 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4928 frames in the stack.
4929
4930 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4931 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4932
4933 @item backtrace @var{n}
4934 @itemx bt @var{n}
4935 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4936
4937 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4938 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4939 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4940
4941 @item backtrace full
4942 @itemx bt full
4943 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4944 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4945 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4946 number of frames to print, as described above.
4947 @end table
4948
4949 @kindex where
4950 @kindex info stack
4951 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4952 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4953
4954 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4955 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4956 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4957 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4958 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4959 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4960 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4961 multi-threaded program.
4962
4963 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4964 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4965 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4966 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4967 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4968 line number.
4969
4970 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4971 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4972
4973 @smallexample
4974 @group
4975 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4976 at builtin.c:993
4977 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4978 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4979 at macro.c:71
4980 (More stack frames follow...)
4981 @end group
4982 @end smallexample
4983
4984 @noindent
4985 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4986 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4987 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4988
4989 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4990 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4991 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4992 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4993 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4994 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4995 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4996 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4997 such a backtrace might look like:
4998
4999 @smallexample
5000 @group
5001 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5002 at builtin.c:993
5003 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5004 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5005 at macro.c:71
5006 (More stack frames follow...)
5007 @end group
5008 @end smallexample
5009
5010 @noindent
5011 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5012 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5013
5014 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5015 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5016 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5017
5018 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5019 @cindex program entry point
5020 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5021 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5022 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5023 @code{main}@footnote{
5024 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5025 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5026 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5027 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5028 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5029 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5030
5031 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5032 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5033
5034 @table @code
5035 @item set backtrace past-main
5036 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5037 @kindex set backtrace
5038 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5039
5040 @item set backtrace past-main off
5041 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5042 default.
5043
5044 @item show backtrace past-main
5045 @kindex show backtrace
5046 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5047
5048 @item set backtrace past-entry
5049 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5050 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5051 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5052 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5053
5054 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5055 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5056 application. This is the default.
5057
5058 @item show backtrace past-entry
5059 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5060
5061 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5062 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5063 @cindex backtrace limit
5064 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5065 unlimited.
5066
5067 @item show backtrace limit
5068 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5069 @end table
5070
5071 @node Selection
5072 @section Selecting a Frame
5073
5074 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5075 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5076 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5077 of the stack frame just selected.
5078
5079 @table @code
5080 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5081 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5082 @item frame @var{n}
5083 @itemx f @var{n}
5084 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5085 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5086 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5087 @code{main}.
5088
5089 @item frame @var{addr}
5090 @itemx f @var{addr}
5091 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5092 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5093 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5094 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5095 switches between them.
5096
5097 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5098 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5099
5100 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5101 pointer and a program counter.
5102
5103 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5104 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5105
5106 @kindex up
5107 @item up @var{n}
5108 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5109 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5110 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5111
5112 @kindex down
5113 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5114 @item down @var{n}
5115 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5116 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5117 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5118 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5119 @end table
5120
5121 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5122 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5123 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5124 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5125
5126 @need 1000
5127 For example:
5128
5129 @smallexample
5130 @group
5131 (@value{GDBP}) up
5132 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5133 at env.c:10
5134 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5135 @end group
5136 @end smallexample
5137
5138 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5139 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5140 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5141 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5142 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5143 for details.
5144
5145 @table @code
5146 @kindex down-silently
5147 @kindex up-silently
5148 @item up-silently @var{n}
5149 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5150 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5151 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5152 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5153 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5154 distracting.
5155 @end table
5156
5157 @node Frame Info
5158 @section Information About a Frame
5159
5160 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5161 stack frame.
5162
5163 @table @code
5164 @item frame
5165 @itemx f
5166 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5167 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5168 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5169 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5170 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5171
5172 @kindex info frame
5173 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5174 @item info frame
5175 @itemx info f
5176 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5177 including:
5178
5179 @itemize @bullet
5180 @item
5181 the address of the frame
5182 @item
5183 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5184 @item
5185 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5186 @item
5187 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5188 @item
5189 the address of the frame's arguments
5190 @item
5191 the address of the frame's local variables
5192 @item
5193 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5194 @item
5195 which registers were saved in the frame
5196 @end itemize
5197
5198 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5199 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5200 the usual conventions.
5201
5202 @item info frame @var{addr}
5203 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5204 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5205 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5206 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5207 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5208 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5209
5210 @kindex info args
5211 @item info args
5212 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5213
5214 @item info locals
5215 @kindex info locals
5216 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5217 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5218 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5219
5220 @kindex info catch
5221 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5222 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5223 @item info catch
5224 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5225 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5226 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5227 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5228 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5229
5230 @end table
5231
5232
5233 @node Source
5234 @chapter Examining Source Files
5235
5236 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5237 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5238 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5239 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5240 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5241 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5242 source files by explicit command.
5243
5244 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5245 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5246 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5247
5248 @menu
5249 * List:: Printing source lines
5250 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5251 * Edit:: Editing source files
5252 * Search:: Searching source files
5253 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5254 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5255 @end menu
5256
5257 @node List
5258 @section Printing Source Lines
5259
5260 @kindex list
5261 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5262 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5263 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5264 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5265 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5266
5267 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5268
5269 @table @code
5270 @item list @var{linenum}
5271 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5272 current source file.
5273
5274 @item list @var{function}
5275 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5276 @var{function}.
5277
5278 @item list
5279 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5280 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5281 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5282 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5283 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5284
5285 @item list -
5286 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5287 @end table
5288
5289 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5290 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5291 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5292
5293 @table @code
5294 @kindex set listsize
5295 @item set listsize @var{count}
5296 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5297 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5298
5299 @kindex show listsize
5300 @item show listsize
5301 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5302 @end table
5303
5304 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5305 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5306 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5307 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5308 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5309
5310 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5311 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5312 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5313 to specify some source line.
5314
5315 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5316
5317 @table @code
5318 @item list @var{linespec}
5319 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5320
5321 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5322 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5323 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5324 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5325 the same source file as the first linespec.
5326
5327 @item list ,@var{last}
5328 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5329
5330 @item list @var{first},
5331 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5332
5333 @item list +
5334 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5335
5336 @item list -
5337 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5338
5339 @item list
5340 As described in the preceding table.
5341 @end table
5342
5343 @node Specify Location
5344 @section Specifying a Location
5345 @cindex specifying location
5346 @cindex linespec
5347
5348 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5349 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5350 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5351 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5352
5353 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5354 @value{GDBN} understands:
5355
5356 @table @code
5357 @item @var{linenum}
5358 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5359
5360 @item -@var{offset}
5361 @itemx +@var{offset}
5362 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5363 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5364 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5365 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5366 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5367 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5368 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5369 linespec.
5370
5371 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5372 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5373
5374 @item @var{function}
5375 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5376 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5377
5378 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5379 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5380 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5381 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5382 functions in different source files.
5383
5384 @item *@var{address}
5385 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5386 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5387 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5388 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5389 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5390 source files.
5391
5392 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5393 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5394 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5395 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5396 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5397 of @var{address}:
5398
5399 @table @code
5400 @item @var{expression}
5401 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5402
5403 @item @var{funcaddr}
5404 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5405 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5406 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5407 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5408 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5409 (although the Pascal form also works).
5410
5411 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5412 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5413
5414 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5415 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5416 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5417 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5418 functions with identical names in different source files.
5419 @end table
5420
5421 @end table
5422
5423
5424 @node Edit
5425 @section Editing Source Files
5426 @cindex editing source files
5427
5428 @kindex edit
5429 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5430 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5431 The editing program of your choice
5432 is invoked with the current line set to
5433 the active line in the program.
5434 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5435 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5436
5437 @table @code
5438 @item edit @var{location}
5439 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5440 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5441 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5442 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5443 command most commonly used:
5444
5445 @table @code
5446 @item edit @var{number}
5447 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5448
5449 @item edit @var{function}
5450 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5451 @end table
5452
5453 @end table
5454
5455 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5456 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5457 @footnote{
5458 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5459 following command-line syntax:
5460 @smallexample
5461 ex +@var{number} file
5462 @end smallexample
5463 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5464 the file where to start editing.}.
5465 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5466 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5467 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5468 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5469 @smallexample
5470 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5471 export EDITOR
5472 gdb @dots{}
5473 @end smallexample
5474 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5475 @smallexample
5476 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5477 gdb @dots{}
5478 @end smallexample
5479
5480 @node Search
5481 @section Searching Source Files
5482 @cindex searching source files
5483
5484 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5485 regular expression.
5486
5487 @table @code
5488 @kindex search
5489 @kindex forward-search
5490 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5491 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5492 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5493 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5494 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5495 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5496 @code{fo}.
5497
5498 @kindex reverse-search
5499 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5500 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5501 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5502 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5503 this command as @code{rev}.
5504 @end table
5505
5506 @node Source Path
5507 @section Specifying Source Directories
5508
5509 @cindex source path
5510 @cindex directories for source files
5511 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5512 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5513 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5514 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5515 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5516 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5517 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5518
5519 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5520 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5521 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5522 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5523 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5524 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5525 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5526 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5527 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5528 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5529 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5530
5531 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5532 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5533 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5534 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5535 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5536 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5537
5538 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5539 source files.
5540
5541 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5542 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5543 each line is in the file.
5544
5545 @kindex directory
5546 @kindex dir
5547 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5548 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5549 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5550
5551 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5552 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5553
5554 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5555 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5556 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5557 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5558 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5559 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5560 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5561 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5562 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5563 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5564 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5565 name to look up the sources.
5566
5567 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5568 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5569 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5570 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5571 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5572 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5573 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5574 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5575
5576 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5577 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5578 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5579 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5580 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5581 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5582 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5583
5584 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5585 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5586 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5587 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5588 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5589 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5590 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5591 command.
5592
5593 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5594 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5595 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5596 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5597 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5598 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5599 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5600
5601 @table @code
5602 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5603 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5604 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5605 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5606 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5607 part of absolute file names) or
5608 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5609 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5610
5611 @kindex cdir
5612 @kindex cwd
5613 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5614 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5615 @cindex compilation directory
5616 @cindex current directory
5617 @cindex working directory
5618 @cindex directory, current
5619 @cindex directory, compilation
5620 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5621 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5622 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5623 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5624 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5625 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5626
5627 @item directory
5628 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5629
5630 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5631 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5632
5633 @item show directories
5634 @kindex show directories
5635 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5636
5637 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5638 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5639 @kindex set substitute-path
5640 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5641 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5642 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5643
5644 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5645 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5646
5647 @smallexample
5648 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5649 @end smallexample
5650
5651 @noindent
5652 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5653 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5654 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5655
5656 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5657 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5658 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5659 the substitution.
5660
5661 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5662
5663 @smallexample
5664 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5665 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5666 @end smallexample
5667
5668 @noindent
5669 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5670 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5671 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5672 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5673
5674
5675 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5676 @kindex unset substitute-path
5677 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5678 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5679 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5680
5681 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5682
5683 @item show substitute-path [path]
5684 @kindex show substitute-path
5685 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5686 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5687
5688 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5689 rules.
5690
5691 @end table
5692
5693 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5694 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5695 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5696
5697 @enumerate
5698 @item
5699 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5700
5701 @item
5702 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5703 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5704 directories in one command.
5705 @end enumerate
5706
5707 @node Machine Code
5708 @section Source and Machine Code
5709 @cindex source line and its code address
5710
5711 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5712 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5713 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5714 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5715 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5716 well as hex.
5717
5718 @table @code
5719 @kindex info line
5720 @item info line @var{linespec}
5721 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5722 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5723 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5724 @end table
5725
5726 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5727 the object code for the first line of function
5728 @code{m4_changequote}:
5729
5730 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5731 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5732 @smallexample
5733 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5734 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5735 @end smallexample
5736
5737 @noindent
5738 @cindex code address and its source line
5739 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5740 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5741 @smallexample
5742 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5743 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5744 @end smallexample
5745
5746 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5747 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5748 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5749 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5750 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5751 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5752 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5753 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5754 Variables}).
5755
5756 @table @code
5757 @kindex disassemble
5758 @cindex assembly instructions
5759 @cindex instructions, assembly
5760 @cindex machine instructions
5761 @cindex listing machine instructions
5762 @item disassemble
5763 @itemx disassemble /m
5764 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5765 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5766 the @code{/m} modifier.
5767 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5768 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5769 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5770 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5771 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5772 @end table
5773
5774 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5775 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5776
5777 @smallexample
5778 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5779 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5780 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5781 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5782 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5783 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5784 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5785 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5786 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5787 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5788 End of assembler dump.
5789 @end smallexample
5790
5791 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5792
5793 @smallexample
5794 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5795 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5796 5 @{
5797 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
5798 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
5799 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
5800 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
5801 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5802
5803 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
5804 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
5805 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5806
5807 7 return 0;
5808 8 @}
5809 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
5810 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
5811 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5812
5813 End of assembler dump.
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5817 mnemonics or other syntax.
5818
5819 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5820 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5821 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5822 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5823 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5824
5825 @table @code
5826 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5827 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5828 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5829 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5830 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5831 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5832
5833 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5834 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5835 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5836 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5837
5838 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5839 @item show disassembly-flavor
5840 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5841 @end table
5842
5843
5844 @node Data
5845 @chapter Examining Data
5846
5847 @cindex printing data
5848 @cindex examining data
5849 @kindex print
5850 @kindex inspect
5851 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5852 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5853 @c different window or something like that.
5854 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5855 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5856 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5857 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5858 Different Languages}).
5859
5860 @table @code
5861 @item print @var{expr}
5862 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5863 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5864 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5865 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5866 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5867 Formats}.
5868
5869 @item print
5870 @itemx print /@var{f}
5871 @cindex reprint the last value
5872 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5873 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5874 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5875 @end table
5876
5877 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5878 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5879 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5880
5881 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5882 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5883 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5884 Table}.
5885
5886 @menu
5887 * Expressions:: Expressions
5888 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5889 * Variables:: Program variables
5890 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5891 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5892 * Memory:: Examining memory
5893 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5894 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5895 * Value History:: Value history
5896 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5897 * Registers:: Registers
5898 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5899 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5900 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5901 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5902 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5903 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5904 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5905 character set than GDB does
5906 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5907 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
5908 @end menu
5909
5910 @node Expressions
5911 @section Expressions
5912
5913 @cindex expressions
5914 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5915 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5916 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5917 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5918 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5919 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5920 @ref{Compilation}.
5921
5922 @cindex arrays in expressions
5923 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5924 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5925 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5926 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5927 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5928 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5929
5930 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5931 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5932 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5933 languages.
5934
5935 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5936 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5937
5938 @cindex casts, in expressions
5939 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5940 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5941 at that address in memory.
5942 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5943
5944 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5945 to programming languages:
5946
5947 @table @code
5948 @item @@
5949 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5950 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5951
5952 @item ::
5953 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5954 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5955
5956 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5957 @cindex type casting memory
5958 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5959 @cindex casts, to view memory
5960 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5961 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5962 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5963 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5964 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5965 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5966 @end table
5967
5968 @node Ambiguous Expressions
5969 @section Ambiguous Expressions
5970 @cindex ambiguous expressions
5971
5972 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5973 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5974 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5975 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5976 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5977 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5978 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5979
5980 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5981 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5982 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5983 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5984 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5985 as well.
5986
5987 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5988 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5989 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5990 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5991 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5992 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5993 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5994 choices.
5995
5996 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5997 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5998 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5999
6000 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6001 @smallexample
6002 @group
6003 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6004 [0] cancel
6005 [1] all
6006 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6007 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6008 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6009 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6010 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6011 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6012 > 2 4 6
6013 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6014 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6015 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6016 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6017 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6018 breakpoints.
6019 (@value{GDBP})
6020 @end group
6021 @end smallexample
6022
6023 @table @code
6024 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6025 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6026 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6027
6028 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6029 is ambiguous.
6030
6031 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6032 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6033 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6034 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6035 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6036 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6037 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6038 in the use of the menu.
6039
6040 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6041 when an ambiguity is detected.
6042
6043 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6044 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6045
6046 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6047 @item show multiple-symbols
6048 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6049 @end table
6050
6051 @node Variables
6052 @section Program Variables
6053
6054 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6055 in your program.
6056
6057 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6058 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6059
6060 @itemize @bullet
6061 @item
6062 global (or file-static)
6063 @end itemize
6064
6065 @noindent or
6066
6067 @itemize @bullet
6068 @item
6069 visible according to the scope rules of the
6070 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6071 @end itemize
6072
6073 @noindent This means that in the function
6074
6075 @smallexample
6076 foo (a)
6077 int a;
6078 @{
6079 bar (a);
6080 @{
6081 int b = test ();
6082 bar (b);
6083 @}
6084 @}
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 @noindent
6088 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6089 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6090 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6091 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6092
6093 @cindex variable name conflict
6094 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6095 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6096 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6097 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6098 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6099 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6100 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6101
6102 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6103 @ifnotinfo
6104 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6105 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6106 @end ifnotinfo
6107 @smallexample
6108 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6109 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6110 @end smallexample
6111
6112 @noindent
6113 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6114 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6115 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6116 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6117
6118 @smallexample
6119 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6120 @end smallexample
6121
6122 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6123 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6124 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6125 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6126 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6127 @c conflict?? --mew
6128
6129 @cindex wrong values
6130 @cindex variable values, wrong
6131 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6132 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6133 @quotation
6134 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6135 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6136 scope, and just before exit.
6137 @end quotation
6138 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6139 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6140 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6141 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6142 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6143 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6144 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6145 variable definitions may be gone.
6146
6147 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6148 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6149 when compiling.
6150
6151 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6152 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6153 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6154 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6155 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6156 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6157 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6158
6159 @smallexample
6160 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6161 @end smallexample
6162
6163 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6164 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6165 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6166 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6167 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6168 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6169 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6170 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6171 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6172 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6173 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6174
6175 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6176 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6177 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6178 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6179
6180 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6181 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6182 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6183 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6184 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6185 For program code
6186
6187 @smallexample
6188 char var0[] = "A";
6189 signed char var1[] = "A";
6190 @end smallexample
6191
6192 You get during debugging
6193 @smallexample
6194 (gdb) print var0
6195 $1 = "A"
6196 (gdb) print var1
6197 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6198 @end smallexample
6199
6200 @node Arrays
6201 @section Artificial Arrays
6202
6203 @cindex artificial array
6204 @cindex arrays
6205 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6206 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6207 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6208 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6209 program.
6210
6211 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6212 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6213 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6214 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6215 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6216 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6217 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6218 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6219 example. If a program says
6220
6221 @smallexample
6222 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6223 @end smallexample
6224
6225 @noindent
6226 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6227
6228 @smallexample
6229 p *array@@len
6230 @end smallexample
6231
6232 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6233 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6234 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6235 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6236 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6237
6238 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6239 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6240 The value need not be in memory:
6241 @smallexample
6242 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6243 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6244 @end smallexample
6245
6246 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6247 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6248 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6249 @smallexample
6250 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6251 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6252 @end smallexample
6253
6254 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6255 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6256 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6257 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6258 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6259 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6260 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6261 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6262 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6263 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6264
6265 @smallexample
6266 set $i = 0
6267 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6268 @key{RET}
6269 @key{RET}
6270 @dots{}
6271 @end smallexample
6272
6273 @node Output Formats
6274 @section Output Formats
6275
6276 @cindex formatted output
6277 @cindex output formats
6278 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6279 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6280 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6281 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6282 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6283
6284 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6285 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6286 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6287 letters supported are:
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @item x
6291 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6292 hexadecimal.
6293
6294 @item d
6295 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6296
6297 @item u
6298 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6299
6300 @item o
6301 Print as integer in octal.
6302
6303 @item t
6304 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6305 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6306 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6307 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6308
6309 @item a
6310 @cindex unknown address, locating
6311 @cindex locate address
6312 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6313 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6314 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6315
6316 @smallexample
6317 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6318 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6319 @end smallexample
6320
6321 @noindent
6322 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6323 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6324
6325 @item c
6326 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6327 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6328 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6329 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6330
6331 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6332 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6333 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6334 data.
6335
6336 @item f
6337 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6338 using typical floating point syntax.
6339
6340 @item s
6341 @cindex printing strings
6342 @cindex printing byte arrays
6343 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6344 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6345 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6346 natural types.
6347
6348 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6349 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6350 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6351 array.
6352 @end table
6353
6354 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6355
6356 @smallexample
6357 p/x $pc
6358 @end smallexample
6359
6360 @noindent
6361 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6362 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6363
6364 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6365 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6366 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6367
6368 @node Memory
6369 @section Examining Memory
6370
6371 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6372 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6373
6374 @cindex examining memory
6375 @table @code
6376 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6377 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6378 @itemx x @var{addr}
6379 @itemx x
6380 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6381 @end table
6382
6383 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6384 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6385 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6386 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6387 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6388
6389 @table @r
6390 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6391 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6392 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6393 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6394 @c 4.1.2.
6395
6396 @item @var{f}, the display format
6397 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6398 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6399 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6400 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6401 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6402
6403 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6404 The unit size is any of
6405
6406 @table @code
6407 @item b
6408 Bytes.
6409 @item h
6410 Halfwords (two bytes).
6411 @item w
6412 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6413 @item g
6414 Giant words (eight bytes).
6415 @end table
6416
6417 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6418 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6419 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6420
6421 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6422 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6423 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6424 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6425 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6426 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6427 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6428 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6429 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6430 a value from memory).
6431 @end table
6432
6433 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6434 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6435 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6436 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6437 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6438
6439 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6440 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6441 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6442 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6443 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6444
6445 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6446 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6447 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6448 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6449 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6450 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6451 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6452 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6453 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6454
6455 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6456 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6457 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6458 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6459 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6460 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6461 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6462
6463 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6464 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6465 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6466 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6467 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6468 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6469 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6470 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6471 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6472
6473 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6474 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6475 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6476
6477 @cindex remote memory comparison
6478 @cindex verify remote memory image
6479 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6480 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6481 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6482 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6483 situations.
6484
6485 @table @code
6486 @kindex compare-sections
6487 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6488 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6489 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6490 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6491 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6492 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6493 remote request.
6494 @end table
6495
6496 @node Auto Display
6497 @section Automatic Display
6498 @cindex automatic display
6499 @cindex display of expressions
6500
6501 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6502 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6503 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6504 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6505 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6506 The automatic display looks like this:
6507
6508 @smallexample
6509 2: foo = 38
6510 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6511 @end smallexample
6512
6513 @noindent
6514 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6515 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6516 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6517 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6518 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6519 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6520
6521 @table @code
6522 @kindex display
6523 @item display @var{expr}
6524 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6525 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6526
6527 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6528
6529 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6530 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6531 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6532 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6533 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6534
6535 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6536 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6537 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6538 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6539 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6540 @end table
6541
6542 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6543 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6544 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6545
6546 @table @code
6547 @kindex delete display
6548 @kindex undisplay
6549 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6550 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6551 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6552
6553 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6554 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6555
6556 @kindex disable display
6557 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6558 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6559 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6560 enabled again later.
6561
6562 @kindex enable display
6563 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6564 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6565 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6566
6567 @item display
6568 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6569 done when your program stops.
6570
6571 @kindex info display
6572 @item info display
6573 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6574 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6575 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6576 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6577 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6578 @end table
6579
6580 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6581 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6582 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6583 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6584 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6585 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6586 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6587 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6588 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6589 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6590 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6591
6592 @node Print Settings
6593 @section Print Settings
6594
6595 @cindex format options
6596 @cindex print settings
6597 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6598 and symbols are printed.
6599
6600 @noindent
6601 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6602
6603 @table @code
6604 @kindex set print
6605 @item set print address
6606 @itemx set print address on
6607 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6608 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6609 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6610 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6611 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6612 @code{set print address on}:
6613
6614 @smallexample
6615 @group
6616 (@value{GDBP}) f
6617 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6618 at input.c:530
6619 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6620 @end group
6621 @end smallexample
6622
6623 @item set print address off
6624 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6625 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6626
6627 @smallexample
6628 @group
6629 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6630 (@value{GDBP}) f
6631 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6632 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6633 @end group
6634 @end smallexample
6635
6636 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6637 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6638 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6639 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6640
6641 @kindex show print
6642 @item show print address
6643 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6644 @end table
6645
6646 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6647 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6648 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6649 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6650 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6651 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6652 it prints a symbolic address:
6653
6654 @table @code
6655 @item set print symbol-filename on
6656 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6657 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6658 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6659 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6660
6661 @item set print symbol-filename off
6662 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6663 default.
6664
6665 @item show print symbol-filename
6666 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6667 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6668 @end table
6669
6670 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6671 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6672 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6673
6674 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6675 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6676
6677 @table @code
6678 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6679 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6680 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6681 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6682 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6683 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6684
6685 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6686 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6687 symbolic address.
6688 @end table
6689
6690 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6691 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6692 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6693 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6694 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6695 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6696 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6697 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6698
6699 @smallexample
6700 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6701 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6702 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6703 @end smallexample
6704
6705 @quotation
6706 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6707 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6708 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6709 @end quotation
6710
6711 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6712
6713 @table @code
6714 @item set print array
6715 @itemx set print array on
6716 @cindex pretty print arrays
6717 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6718 but uses more space. The default is off.
6719
6720 @item set print array off
6721 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6722
6723 @item show print array
6724 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6725 arrays.
6726
6727 @cindex print array indexes
6728 @item set print array-indexes
6729 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6730 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6731 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6732 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6733
6734 @item set print array-indexes off
6735 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6736
6737 @item show print array-indexes
6738 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6739 arrays.
6740
6741 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6742 @cindex number of array elements to print
6743 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6744 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6745 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6746 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6747 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6748 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6749 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6750
6751 @item show print elements
6752 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6753 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6754
6755 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6756 @cindex printing frame argument values
6757 @cindex print all frame argument values
6758 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6759 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6760 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6761 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6762 values are:
6763
6764 @table @code
6765 @item all
6766 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6767
6768 @item scalars
6769 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6770 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6771 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6772
6773 @smallexample
6774 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6775 at frame-args.c:23
6776 @end smallexample
6777
6778 @item none
6779 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6780 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6781
6782 @smallexample
6783 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6784 at frame-args.c:23
6785 @end smallexample
6786 @end table
6787
6788 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6789 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6790 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6791 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6792 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6793 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6794 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6795 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6796
6797 @item show print frame-arguments
6798 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6799
6800 @item set print repeats
6801 @cindex repeated array elements
6802 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6803 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6804 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6805 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6806 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6807 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6808 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6809
6810 @item show print repeats
6811 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6812 elements.
6813
6814 @item set print null-stop
6815 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6816 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6817 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6818 contain only short strings.
6819 The default is off.
6820
6821 @item show print null-stop
6822 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6823 @sc{null} character.
6824
6825 @item set print pretty on
6826 @cindex print structures in indented form
6827 @cindex indentation in structure display
6828 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6829 per line, like this:
6830
6831 @smallexample
6832 @group
6833 $1 = @{
6834 next = 0x0,
6835 flags = @{
6836 sweet = 1,
6837 sour = 1
6838 @},
6839 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6840 @}
6841 @end group
6842 @end smallexample
6843
6844 @item set print pretty off
6845 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6846
6847 @smallexample
6848 @group
6849 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6850 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6851 @end group
6852 @end smallexample
6853
6854 @noindent
6855 This is the default format.
6856
6857 @item show print pretty
6858 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6859
6860 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6861 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6862 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6863 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6864 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6865 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6866 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6867 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6868
6869 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6870 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6871 international character sets, and is the default.
6872
6873 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6874 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6875
6876 @item set print union on
6877 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6878 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6879 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6880
6881 @item set print union off
6882 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6883 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6884 instead.
6885
6886 @item show print union
6887 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6888 structures and other unions.
6889
6890 For example, given the declarations
6891
6892 @smallexample
6893 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6894 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6895 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6896 Bug_forms;
6897
6898 struct thing @{
6899 Species it;
6900 union @{
6901 Tree_forms tree;
6902 Bug_forms bug;
6903 @} form;
6904 @};
6905
6906 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6907 @end smallexample
6908
6909 @noindent
6910 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6911
6912 @smallexample
6913 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6914 @end smallexample
6915
6916 @noindent
6917 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6918
6919 @smallexample
6920 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6921 @end smallexample
6922
6923 @noindent
6924 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6925 and in Pascal.
6926 @end table
6927
6928 @need 1000
6929 @noindent
6930 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6931
6932 @table @code
6933 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6934 @item set print demangle
6935 @itemx set print demangle on
6936 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6937 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6938 linkage. The default is on.
6939
6940 @item show print demangle
6941 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6942
6943 @item set print asm-demangle
6944 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6945 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6946 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6947 The default is off.
6948
6949 @item show print asm-demangle
6950 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6951 or demangled form.
6952
6953 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6954 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6955 @kindex set demangle-style
6956 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6957 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6958 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6959
6960 @table @code
6961 @item auto
6962 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6963
6964 @item gnu
6965 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6966 This is the default.
6967
6968 @item hp
6969 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6970
6971 @item lucid
6972 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6973
6974 @item arm
6975 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6976 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6977 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6978 require further enhancement to permit that.
6979
6980 @end table
6981 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6982
6983 @item show demangle-style
6984 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6985
6986 @item set print object
6987 @itemx set print object on
6988 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6989 @cindex display derived types
6990 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6991 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6992 the virtual function table.
6993
6994 @item set print object off
6995 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6996 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6997
6998 @item show print object
6999 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7000
7001 @item set print static-members
7002 @itemx set print static-members on
7003 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7004 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7005
7006 @item set print static-members off
7007 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7008
7009 @item show print static-members
7010 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7011
7012 @item set print pascal_static-members
7013 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7014 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7015 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7016 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7017
7018 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7019 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7020
7021 @item show print pascal_static-members
7022 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7023
7024 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7025 @item set print vtbl
7026 @itemx set print vtbl on
7027 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7028 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7029 @cindex VTBL display
7030 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7031 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7032 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7033
7034 @item set print vtbl off
7035 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7036
7037 @item show print vtbl
7038 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7039 @end table
7040
7041 @node Value History
7042 @section Value History
7043
7044 @cindex value history
7045 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7046 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7047 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7048 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7049 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7050 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7051 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7052 symbol table.
7053
7054 @cindex @code{$}
7055 @cindex @code{$$}
7056 @cindex history number
7057 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7058 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7059 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7060 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7061 history number.
7062
7063 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7064 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7065 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7066 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7067 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7068 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7069 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7070
7071 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7072 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7073
7074 @smallexample
7075 p *$
7076 @end smallexample
7077
7078 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7079 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7080
7081 @smallexample
7082 p *$.next
7083 @end smallexample
7084
7085 @noindent
7086 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7087 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7088
7089 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7090 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7091
7092 @smallexample
7093 print x
7094 set x=5
7095 @end smallexample
7096
7097 @noindent
7098 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7099 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7100
7101 @table @code
7102 @kindex show values
7103 @item show values
7104 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7105 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7106 values} does not change the history.
7107
7108 @item show values @var{n}
7109 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7110
7111 @item show values +
7112 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7113 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7114 @end table
7115
7116 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7117 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7118
7119 @node Convenience Vars
7120 @section Convenience Variables
7121
7122 @cindex convenience variables
7123 @cindex user-defined variables
7124 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7125 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7126 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7127 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7128 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7129
7130 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7131 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7132 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7133 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7134 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7135
7136 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7137 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7138 For example:
7139
7140 @smallexample
7141 set $foo = *object_ptr
7142 @end smallexample
7143
7144 @noindent
7145 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7146 @code{object_ptr}.
7147
7148 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7149 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7150 value with another assignment at any time.
7151
7152 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7153 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7154 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7155 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7156
7157 @table @code
7158 @kindex show convenience
7159 @cindex show all user variables
7160 @item show convenience
7161 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7162 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7163
7164 @kindex init-if-undefined
7165 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7166 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7167 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7168 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7169 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7170 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7171 override default values used in a command script.
7172
7173 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7174 any side-effects do not occur.
7175 @end table
7176
7177 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7178 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7179 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7180
7181 @smallexample
7182 set $i = 0
7183 print bar[$i++]->contents
7184 @end smallexample
7185
7186 @noindent
7187 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7188
7189 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7190 values likely to be useful.
7191
7192 @table @code
7193 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7194 @item $_
7195 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7196 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7197 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7198 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7199 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7200 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7201 to the type of @code{$__}.
7202
7203 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7204 @item $__
7205 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7206 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7207 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7208
7209 @item $_exitcode
7210 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7211 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7212 the program being debugged terminates.
7213 @end table
7214
7215 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7216 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7217 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7218
7219 @node Registers
7220 @section Registers
7221
7222 @cindex registers
7223 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7224 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7225 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7226 your machine.
7227
7228 @table @code
7229 @kindex info registers
7230 @item info registers
7231 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7232 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7233
7234 @kindex info all-registers
7235 @cindex floating point registers
7236 @item info all-registers
7237 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7238 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7239
7240 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7241 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7242 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7243 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7244 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7245 @end table
7246
7247 @cindex stack pointer register
7248 @cindex program counter register
7249 @cindex process status register
7250 @cindex frame pointer register
7251 @cindex standard registers
7252 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7253 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7254 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7255 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7256 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7257 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7258 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7259 you could print the program counter in hex with
7260
7261 @smallexample
7262 p/x $pc
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 @noindent
7266 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7267
7268 @smallexample
7269 x/i $pc
7270 @end smallexample
7271
7272 @noindent
7273 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7274 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7275 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7276 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7277 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7278 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7279 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7280
7281 @smallexample
7282 set $sp += 4
7283 @end smallexample
7284
7285 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7286 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7287 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7288 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7289 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7290 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7291 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7292
7293 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7294 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7295 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7296 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7297 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7298 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7299 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7300
7301 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7302 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7303 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7304 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7305 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7306 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7307 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7308 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7309 prints the data in both formats.
7310
7311 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7312 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7313 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7314 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7315 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7316 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7317 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7318
7319 @smallexample
7320 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7321 $1 = @{
7322 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7323 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7324 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7325 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7326 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7327 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7328 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7329 @}
7330 @end smallexample
7331
7332 @noindent
7333 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7334 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7335 value to a @code{struct} member:
7336
7337 @smallexample
7338 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7339 @end smallexample
7340
7341 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7342 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7343 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7344 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7345 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7346 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7347
7348 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7349 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7350 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7351 frame makes no difference.
7352
7353 @node Floating Point Hardware
7354 @section Floating Point Hardware
7355 @cindex floating point
7356
7357 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7358 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7359
7360 @table @code
7361 @kindex info float
7362 @item info float
7363 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7364 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7365 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7366 the ARM and x86 machines.
7367 @end table
7368
7369 @node Vector Unit
7370 @section Vector Unit
7371 @cindex vector unit
7372
7373 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7374 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7375
7376 @table @code
7377 @kindex info vector
7378 @item info vector
7379 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7380 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7381 @end table
7382
7383 @node OS Information
7384 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7385 @cindex OS information
7386
7387 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7388 you debug your program.
7389
7390 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7391 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7392 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7393 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7394 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7395 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7396 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7397 structure.
7398
7399 @table @code
7400 @item info udot
7401 @kindex info udot
7402 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7403 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7404 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7405 the @code{examine} command.
7406 @end table
7407
7408 @cindex auxiliary vector
7409 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7410 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7411 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7412 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7413 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7414 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7415 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7416 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7417 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7418 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7419 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7420 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7421
7422 @table @code
7423 @kindex info auxv
7424 @item info auxv
7425 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7426 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7427 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7428 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7429 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7430 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7431 an unrecognized tag.
7432 @end table
7433
7434
7435 @node Memory Region Attributes
7436 @section Memory Region Attributes
7437 @cindex memory region attributes
7438
7439 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7440 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7441 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7442 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7443 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7444 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7445 user can override the fetched regions.
7446
7447 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7448 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7449 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7450 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7451 all memory.
7452
7453 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7454 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @kindex mem
7458 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7459 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7460 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7461 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7462 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7463 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7464
7465 @item mem auto
7466 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7467 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7468
7469 @kindex delete mem
7470 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7471 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7472 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7473
7474 @kindex disable mem
7475 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7476 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7477 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7478 It may be enabled again later.
7479
7480 @kindex enable mem
7481 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7482 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7483
7484 @kindex info mem
7485 @item info mem
7486 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7487 for each region:
7488
7489 @table @emph
7490 @item Memory Region Number
7491 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7492 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7493 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7494
7495 @item Lo Address
7496 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7497
7498 @item Hi Address
7499 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7500
7501 @item Attributes
7502 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7503 @end table
7504 @end table
7505
7506
7507 @subsection Attributes
7508
7509 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7510 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7511 write accesses to a memory region.
7512
7513 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7514 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7515 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7516
7517 @table @code
7518 @item ro
7519 Memory is read only.
7520 @item wo
7521 Memory is write only.
7522 @item rw
7523 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7524 @end table
7525
7526 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7527 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7528 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7529 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7530 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7531
7532 @table @code
7533 @item 8
7534 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7535 @item 16
7536 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7537 @item 32
7538 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7539 @item 64
7540 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7541 @end table
7542
7543 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7544 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7545 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7546 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7547 @c
7548 @c @table @code
7549 @c @item hwbreak
7550 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7551 @c @item swbreak (default)
7552 @c @end table
7553
7554 @subsubsection Data Cache
7555 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7556 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7557 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7558 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7559 registers.
7560
7561 @table @code
7562 @item cache
7563 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7564 @item nocache
7565 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7566 @end table
7567
7568 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7569 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7570 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7571 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7572 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7573
7574 @table @code
7575 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7576 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7577 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7578 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7579 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7580 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7581 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7582 The default value is @code{on}.
7583 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7584 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7585 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7586 @end table
7587
7588
7589 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7590 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7591 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7592 @c
7593 @c @table @code
7594 @c @item verify
7595 @c @item noverify (default)
7596 @c @end table
7597
7598 @node Dump/Restore Files
7599 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7600 @cindex dump/restore files
7601 @cindex append data to a file
7602 @cindex dump data to a file
7603 @cindex restore data from a file
7604
7605 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7606 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7607 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7608 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7609 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7610 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7611 files.
7612
7613 @table @code
7614
7615 @kindex dump
7616 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7617 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7618 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7619 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7620
7621 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7622 @table @code
7623 @item binary
7624 Raw binary form.
7625 @item ihex
7626 Intel hex format.
7627 @item srec
7628 Motorola S-record format.
7629 @item tekhex
7630 Tektronix Hex format.
7631 @end table
7632
7633 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7634 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7635 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7636 form.
7637
7638 @kindex append
7639 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7640 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7641 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7642 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7643 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7644
7645 @kindex restore
7646 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7647 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7648 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7649 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7650 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7651
7652 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7653 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7654 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7655 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7656 from that location.
7657
7658 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7659 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7660 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7661 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7662
7663 @end table
7664
7665 @node Core File Generation
7666 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7667 @cindex dump core from inferior
7668
7669 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7670 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7671 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7672 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7673 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7674 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7675 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7676
7677 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7678 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7679 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7680
7681 @table @code
7682 @kindex gcore
7683 @kindex generate-core-file
7684 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7685 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7686 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7687 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7688 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7689 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7690
7691 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7692 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7693 @end table
7694
7695 @node Character Sets
7696 @section Character Sets
7697 @cindex character sets
7698 @cindex charset
7699 @cindex translating between character sets
7700 @cindex host character set
7701 @cindex target character set
7702
7703 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7704 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7705 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7706 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7707 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7708 @dfn{target character set}.
7709
7710 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7711 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7712 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7713 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7714 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7715 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7716 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7717 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7718 character and string literals in expressions.
7719
7720 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7721 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7722 target-charset} command, described below.
7723
7724 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7725 support:
7726
7727 @table @code
7728 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7729 @kindex set target-charset
7730 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7731 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7732 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7733 list the target character sets it supports.
7734 @end table
7735
7736 @table @code
7737 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7738 @kindex set host-charset
7739 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7740
7741 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7742 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7743 @code{set host-charset} command.
7744
7745 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7746 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7747 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7748 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7749 list the host character sets it supports.
7750
7751 @item set charset @var{charset}
7752 @kindex set charset
7753 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7754 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7755 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7756 for both host and target.
7757
7758
7759 @item show charset
7760 @kindex show charset
7761 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7762
7763 @itemx show host-charset
7764 @kindex show host-charset
7765 Show the name of the current host charset.
7766
7767 @itemx show target-charset
7768 @kindex show target-charset
7769 Show the name of the current target charset.
7770
7771 @end table
7772
7773 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7774 sets:
7775
7776 @table @code
7777
7778 @item ASCII
7779 @cindex ASCII character set
7780 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7781 character set.
7782
7783 @item ISO-8859-1
7784 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7785 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7786 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7787 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7788 this as its host character set.
7789
7790 @item EBCDIC-US
7791 @itemx IBM1047
7792 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7793 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7794 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7795 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7796 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7797
7798 @end table
7799
7800 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7801 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7802 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7803
7804 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7805 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7806 @file{charset-test.c}:
7807
7808 @smallexample
7809 #include <stdio.h>
7810
7811 char ascii_hello[]
7812 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7813 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7814 char ibm1047_hello[]
7815 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7816 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7817
7818 main ()
7819 @{
7820 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7821 @}
7822 @end smallexample
7823
7824 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7825 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7826 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7827
7828 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7829
7830 @smallexample
7831 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7832 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7833 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7834 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7835 @dots{}
7836 (@value{GDBP})
7837 @end smallexample
7838
7839 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7840 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7841 strings:
7842
7843 @smallexample
7844 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7845 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7846 (@value{GDBP})
7847 @end smallexample
7848
7849 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7850 initial character set:
7851 @smallexample
7852 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7853 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7854 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7855 (@value{GDBP})
7856 @end smallexample
7857
7858 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7859 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7860 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7861 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7862 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7863
7864 @smallexample
7865 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7866 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7867 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7868 $2 = 72 'H'
7869 (@value{GDBP})
7870 @end smallexample
7871
7872 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7873 literals you use in expressions:
7874
7875 @smallexample
7876 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7877 $3 = 43 '+'
7878 (@value{GDBP})
7879 @end smallexample
7880
7881 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7882 character.
7883
7884 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7885 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7886 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7887
7888 @smallexample
7889 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7890 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7891 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7892 $5 = 200 '\310'
7893 (@value{GDBP})
7894 @end smallexample
7895
7896 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7897 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7898
7899 @smallexample
7900 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7901 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7902 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7903 @end smallexample
7904
7905 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7906 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7907 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7908 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7909 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7910
7911 @smallexample
7912 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7913 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7914 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7915 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7916 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7917 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7918 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7919 $7 = 72 '\110'
7920 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7921 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7922 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7923 $9 = 200 'H'
7924 (@value{GDBP})
7925 @end smallexample
7926
7927 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7928 string literals you use in expressions:
7929
7930 @smallexample
7931 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7932 $10 = 78 '+'
7933 (@value{GDBP})
7934 @end smallexample
7935
7936 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7937 character.
7938
7939 @node Caching Remote Data
7940 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7941 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7942
7943 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7944 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7945 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7946 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7947 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7948 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7949 volatile registers are in use.
7950
7951 @table @code
7952 @kindex set remotecache
7953 @item set remotecache on
7954 @itemx set remotecache off
7955 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7956 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7957
7958 @kindex show remotecache
7959 @item show remotecache
7960 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7961
7962 @kindex info dcache
7963 @item info dcache
7964 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7965 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7966 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7967 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7968 the data cache operation.
7969 @end table
7970
7971 @node Searching Memory
7972 @section Search Memory
7973 @cindex searching memory
7974
7975 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
7976 @code{find} command.
7977
7978 @table @code
7979 @kindex find
7980 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7981 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7982 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
7983 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
7984 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
7985 @end table
7986
7987 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
7988 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
7989
7990 @table @r
7991 @item @var{s}, search query size
7992 The size of each search query value.
7993
7994 @table @code
7995 @item b
7996 bytes
7997 @item h
7998 halfwords (two bytes)
7999 @item w
8000 words (four bytes)
8001 @item g
8002 giant words (eight bytes)
8003 @end table
8004
8005 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8006 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8007 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8008
8009 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8010 value's type in the current language.
8011 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8012 pattern as a mixture of types.
8013 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8014 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8015 which is typically four bytes.
8016
8017 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8018 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8019 @end table
8020
8021 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8022 (@code{"}).
8023 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8024 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8025
8026 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8027 number of matches found.
8028
8029 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8030 @samp{$_}.
8031 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8032
8033 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8034
8035 @smallexample
8036 void
8037 hello ()
8038 @{
8039 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8040 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8041 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8042 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8043 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8044 @}
8045 @end smallexample
8046
8047 @noindent
8048 you get during debugging:
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8052 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8053 1 pattern found
8054 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8055 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8056 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8057 2 patterns found
8058 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8059 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8060 1 pattern found
8061 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8062 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8063 1 pattern found
8064 (gdb) print $numfound
8065 $1 = 1
8066 (gdb) print $_
8067 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8068 @end smallexample
8069
8070 @node Macros
8071 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8072
8073 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8074 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8075 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8076 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8077 where it was defined.
8078
8079 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8080 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8081 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8082 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8083
8084 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8085 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8086 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8087 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8088 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8089 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8090 see @ref{List}.
8091
8092 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
8093 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
8094 variable-arity macros.
8095
8096 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8097 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8098 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8099
8100 @table @code
8101
8102 @kindex macro expand
8103 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8104 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8105 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8106 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8107 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8108 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8109 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8110 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8111 it can be any string of tokens.
8112
8113 @kindex macro exp1
8114 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8115 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8116 @cindex expand macro once
8117 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8118 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8119 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8120 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8121 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8122 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8123 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8124 can be any string of tokens.
8125
8126 @kindex info macro
8127 @cindex macro definition, showing
8128 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8129 @item info macro @var{macro}
8130 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8131 source location where that definition was established.
8132
8133 @kindex macro define
8134 @cindex user-defined macros
8135 @cindex defining macros interactively
8136 @cindex macros, user-defined
8137 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8138 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8139 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8140 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8141 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8142 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8143 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8144 @var{arglist}.
8145
8146 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8147 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8148 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8149 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8150 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8151
8152 @kindex macro undef
8153 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8154 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8155 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8156 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8157 in the program being debugged.
8158
8159 @kindex macro list
8160 @item macro list
8161 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8162 @end table
8163
8164 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8165 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8166 show our source files:
8167
8168 @smallexample
8169 $ cat sample.c
8170 #include <stdio.h>
8171 #include "sample.h"
8172
8173 #define M 42
8174 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8175
8176 main ()
8177 @{
8178 #define N 28
8179 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8180 #undef N
8181 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8182 #define N 1729
8183 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8184 @}
8185 $ cat sample.h
8186 #define Q <
8187 $
8188 @end smallexample
8189
8190 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8191 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8192 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8193 information.
8194
8195 @smallexample
8196 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8197 $
8198 @end smallexample
8199
8200 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8201
8202 @smallexample
8203 $ gdb -nw sample
8204 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8205 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8206 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8207 (@value{GDBP})
8208 @end smallexample
8209
8210 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8211 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8212 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8213
8214 @smallexample
8215 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8216 3
8217 4 #define M 42
8218 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8219 6
8220 7 main ()
8221 8 @{
8222 9 #define N 28
8223 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8224 11 #undef N
8225 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8226 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8227 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8228 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8229 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8230 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8231 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8232 #define Q <
8233 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8234 expands to: (42 + 1)
8235 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8236 expands to: once (M + 1)
8237 (@value{GDBP})
8238 @end smallexample
8239
8240 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8241 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8242 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8243 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8244
8245 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8246 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8247
8248 @smallexample
8249 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8250 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8251 (@value{GDBP}) run
8252 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8253
8254 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8255 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8256 (@value{GDBP})
8257 @end smallexample
8258
8259 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8260
8261 @smallexample
8262 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8263 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8264 #define N 28
8265 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8266 expands to: 28 < 42
8267 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8268 $1 = 1
8269 (@value{GDBP})
8270 @end smallexample
8271
8272 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8273 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8274 thereof) in force at each point:
8275
8276 @smallexample
8277 (@value{GDBP}) next
8278 Hello, world!
8279 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8280 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8281 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8282 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8283 (@value{GDBP}) next
8284 We're so creative.
8285 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8286 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8287 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8288 #define N 1729
8289 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8290 expands to: 1729 < 42
8291 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8292 $2 = 0
8293 (@value{GDBP})
8294 @end smallexample
8295
8296
8297 @node Tracepoints
8298 @chapter Tracepoints
8299 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8300 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8301
8302 @cindex tracepoints
8303 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8304 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8305 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8306 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8307 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8308 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8309 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8310
8311 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8312 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8313 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8314 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8315 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8316 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8317 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8318 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8319 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8320 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8321 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8322
8323 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8324 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8325 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8326 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8327 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8328 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8329 Packets}.
8330
8331 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8332
8333 @menu
8334 * Set Tracepoints::
8335 * Analyze Collected Data::
8336 * Tracepoint Variables::
8337 @end menu
8338
8339 @node Set Tracepoints
8340 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8341
8342 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8343 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8344 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8345 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8346 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8347 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8348 work on.
8349
8350 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8351 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8352 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8353 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8354 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8355 tracepoint was hit.
8356
8357 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8358 conditions and actions.
8359
8360 @menu
8361 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8362 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8363 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8364 * Tracepoint Actions::
8365 * Listing Tracepoints::
8366 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8367 @end menu
8368
8369 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8370 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8371
8372 @table @code
8373 @cindex set tracepoint
8374 @kindex trace
8375 @item trace
8376 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8377 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8378 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8379 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8380 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8381 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8382 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8383 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8384 running.
8385
8386 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8387
8388 @smallexample
8389 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8390
8391 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8392
8393 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8394
8395 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8396
8397 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8398 @end smallexample
8399
8400 @noindent
8401 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8402
8403 @vindex $tpnum
8404 @cindex last tracepoint number
8405 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8406 @cindex tracepoint number
8407 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8408 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8409
8410 @kindex delete tracepoint
8411 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8412 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8413 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8414 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8415
8416 Examples:
8417
8418 @smallexample
8419 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8420
8421 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8422 @end smallexample
8423
8424 @noindent
8425 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8426 @end table
8427
8428 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8429 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8430
8431 @table @code
8432 @kindex disable tracepoint
8433 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8434 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8435 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8436 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8437 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8438
8439 @kindex enable tracepoint
8440 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8441 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8442 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8443 run.
8444 @end table
8445
8446 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8447 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8448
8449 @table @code
8450 @kindex passcount
8451 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8452 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8453 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8454 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8455 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8456 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8457 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8458 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8459 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8460 user.
8461
8462 Examples:
8463
8464 @smallexample
8465 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8466 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8467
8468 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8469 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8470 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8471 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8472 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8473 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8474 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8475 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8476 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8477 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8478 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8479 @end smallexample
8480 @end table
8481
8482 @node Tracepoint Actions
8483 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8484
8485 @table @code
8486 @kindex actions
8487 @cindex tracepoint actions
8488 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8489 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8490 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8491 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8492 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8493 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8494 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8495 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8496 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8497 @code{while-stepping}.
8498
8499 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8500 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8501 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8502
8503 @smallexample
8504 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8505
8506 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8507
8508 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8509 @end smallexample
8510
8511 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8512 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8513 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8514 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8515 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8516 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8517 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8518 @code{end} command.
8519
8520 @smallexample
8521 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8523 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8524 > collect bar,baz
8525 > collect $regs
8526 > while-stepping 12
8527 > collect $fp, $sp
8528 > end
8529 end
8530 @end smallexample
8531
8532 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8533 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8534 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8535 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8536 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8537 special arguments are supported:
8538
8539 @table @code
8540 @item $regs
8541 collect all registers
8542
8543 @item $args
8544 collect all function arguments
8545
8546 @item $locals
8547 collect all local variables.
8548 @end table
8549
8550 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8551 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8552 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8553
8554 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8555 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8556
8557 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8558 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8559 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8560 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8561 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8562 its own @code{end} command):
8563
8564 @smallexample
8565 > while-stepping 12
8566 > collect $regs, myglobal
8567 > end
8568 >
8569 @end smallexample
8570
8571 @noindent
8572 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8573 @code{stepping}.
8574 @end table
8575
8576 @node Listing Tracepoints
8577 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8578
8579 @table @code
8580 @kindex info tracepoints
8581 @kindex info tp
8582 @cindex information about tracepoints
8583 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8584 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8585 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8586 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8587 shown:
8588
8589 @itemize @bullet
8590 @item
8591 its number
8592 @item
8593 whether it is enabled or disabled
8594 @item
8595 its address
8596 @item
8597 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8598 @item
8599 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8600 @item
8601 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8602 @item
8603 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8604 @end itemize
8605
8606 @smallexample
8607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8608 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8609 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8610 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8611 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8612 (@value{GDBP})
8613 @end smallexample
8614
8615 @noindent
8616 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8617 @end table
8618
8619 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8620 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8621
8622 @table @code
8623 @kindex tstart
8624 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8625 @cindex collected data discarded
8626 @item tstart
8627 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8628 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8629 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8630 experiment.
8631
8632 @kindex tstop
8633 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8634 @item tstop
8635 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8636 stops collecting data.
8637
8638 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8639 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8640 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8641
8642 @kindex tstatus
8643 @cindex status of trace data collection
8644 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8645 @item tstatus
8646 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8647 collection.
8648 @end table
8649
8650 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8651
8652 @smallexample
8653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8655 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8656 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8657 > while-stepping 11
8658 > collect $regs
8659 > end
8660 > end
8661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8662 [time passes @dots{}]
8663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8664 @end smallexample
8665
8666
8667 @node Analyze Collected Data
8668 @section Using the Collected Data
8669
8670 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8671 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8672 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8673 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8674 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8675 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8676 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8677 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8678 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8679 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8680 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8681 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8682 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8683 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8684 the buffer will fail.
8685
8686 @menu
8687 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8688 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8689 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8690 @end menu
8691
8692 @node tfind
8693 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8694
8695 @kindex tfind
8696 @cindex select trace snapshot
8697 @cindex find trace snapshot
8698 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8699 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8700 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8701 snapshot is selected.
8702
8703 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8704
8705 @table @code
8706 @item tfind start
8707 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8708 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8709
8710 @item tfind none
8711 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8712
8713 @item tfind end
8714 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8715
8716 @item tfind
8717 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8718
8719 @item tfind -
8720 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8721 retracing earlier steps.
8722
8723 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8724 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8725 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8726 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8727 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8728
8729 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8730 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8731 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8732 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8733 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8734
8735 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8736 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8737 addresses.
8738
8739 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8740 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8741 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8742
8743 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8744 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8745 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8746 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8747 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8748 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8749 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8750 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8751 @end table
8752
8753 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8754 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8755 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8756 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8757 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8758 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8759 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8760 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8761 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8762 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8763 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8764 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8765 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8766 tracepoint as the current one.
8767
8768 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8769 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8770 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8771 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8772 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8773
8774 @smallexample
8775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8777 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8778 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8779 > tfind
8780 > end
8781
8782 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8783 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8784 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8785 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8786 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8787 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8788 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8789 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8790 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8791 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8792 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8793 @end smallexample
8794
8795 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8796 the buffer:
8797
8798 @smallexample
8799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8800 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8801 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8802 > tfind line
8803 > end
8804
8805 Frame 0, X = 1
8806 Frame 7, X = 2
8807 Frame 13, X = 255
8808 @end smallexample
8809
8810 @node tdump
8811 @subsection @code{tdump}
8812 @kindex tdump
8813 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8814 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8815
8816 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8817 the current trace snapshot.
8818
8819 @smallexample
8820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8822 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8823 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8824 > end
8825
8826 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8827
8828 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8829 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8830 at gdb_test.c:444
8831 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8832
8833 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8834 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8835 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8836 d1 0x18 24
8837 d2 0x80 128
8838 d3 0x33 51
8839 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8840 d5 0x22 34
8841 d6 0xe0 224
8842 d7 0x380035 3670069
8843 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8844 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8845 a2 0x100 256
8846 a3 0x322000 3284992
8847 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8848 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8849 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8850 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8851 ps 0x0 0
8852 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8853 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8854 fpstatus 0x0 0
8855 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8856 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8857 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8858 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8859 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8860 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8861 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8862 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8863 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8864
8865 (@value{GDBP})
8866 @end smallexample
8867
8868 @node save-tracepoints
8869 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8870 @kindex save-tracepoints
8871 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8872
8873 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8874 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8875 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8876 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8877 Files}).
8878
8879 @node Tracepoint Variables
8880 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8881 @cindex tracepoint variables
8882 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8883
8884 @table @code
8885 @vindex $trace_frame
8886 @item (int) $trace_frame
8887 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8888 snapshot is selected.
8889
8890 @vindex $tracepoint
8891 @item (int) $tracepoint
8892 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8893
8894 @vindex $trace_line
8895 @item (int) $trace_line
8896 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8897
8898 @vindex $trace_file
8899 @item (char []) $trace_file
8900 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8901
8902 @vindex $trace_func
8903 @item (char []) $trace_func
8904 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8905 @end table
8906
8907 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8908 use @code{output} instead.
8909
8910 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8911 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8912 data.
8913
8914 @smallexample
8915 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8916
8917 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8918 > output $trace_file
8919 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8920 > tfind
8921 > end
8922 @end smallexample
8923
8924 @node Overlays
8925 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8926 @cindex overlays
8927
8928 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8929 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8930 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8931 use overlays.
8932
8933 @menu
8934 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8935 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8936 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8937 mapped by asking the inferior.
8938 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8939 @end menu
8940
8941 @node How Overlays Work
8942 @section How Overlays Work
8943 @cindex mapped overlays
8944 @cindex unmapped overlays
8945 @cindex load address, overlay's
8946 @cindex mapped address
8947 @cindex overlay area
8948
8949 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8950 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8951 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8952 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8953 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8954
8955 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8956 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8957 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8958 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8959 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8960 largest overlay as well.
8961
8962 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8963 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8964 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8965 there.
8966
8967 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8968 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8969 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8970
8971 @smallexample
8972 @group
8973 Data Instruction Larger
8974 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8975 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8976 | | | | | |
8977 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8978 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8979 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8980 | and heap | | | | | |
8981 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8982 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8983 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8984 | | | | | |
8985 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8986 address | | | | | |
8987 | overlay | <-' | | |
8988 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8989 | | <---. | | load address
8990 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8991 | | | |
8992 +-----------+ | |
8993 +-----------+
8994 | |
8995 +-----------+
8996
8997 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8998 @end group
8999 @end smallexample
9000
9001 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9002 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9003 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9004 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9005 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9006 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9007 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9008 program and the overlay area.
9009
9010 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9011 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9012 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9013 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9014 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9015 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9016 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9017
9018 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9019 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9020 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9021
9022 @itemize @bullet
9023
9024 @item
9025 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9026 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9027 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9028 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9029
9030 @item
9031 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9032 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9033 your program's performance.
9034
9035 @item
9036 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9037 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9038 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9039 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9040 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9041 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9042 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9043
9044 @item
9045 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9046 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9047 instruction and data spaces.
9048
9049 @end itemize
9050
9051 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9052 improved in many ways:
9053
9054 @itemize @bullet
9055
9056 @item
9057 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9058 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9059 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9060 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9061 area in the usual way.
9062
9063 @item
9064 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9065 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9066
9067 @item
9068 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9069 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9070 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9071 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9072 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9073 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9074 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9075
9076 @end itemize
9077
9078
9079 @node Overlay Commands
9080 @section Overlay Commands
9081
9082 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9083 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9084 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9085 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9086 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9087 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9088
9089 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9090 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9091
9092 @table @code
9093 @item overlay off
9094 @kindex overlay
9095 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9096 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9097 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9098 overlay support is disabled.
9099
9100 @item overlay manual
9101 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9102 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9103 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9104 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9105 commands described below.
9106
9107 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9108 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9109 @cindex map an overlay
9110 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9111 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9112 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9113 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9114 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9115 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9116
9117 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9118 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9119 @cindex unmap an overlay
9120 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9121 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9122 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9123 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9124
9125 @item overlay auto
9126 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9127 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9128 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9129 Overlay Debugging}.
9130
9131 @item overlay load-target
9132 @itemx overlay load
9133 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9134 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9135 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9136 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9137 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9138 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9139
9140 @item overlay list-overlays
9141 @itemx overlay list
9142 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9143 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9144 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9145
9146 @end table
9147
9148 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9149 of the function the address falls in:
9150
9151 @smallexample
9152 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9153 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9154 @end smallexample
9155 @noindent
9156 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9157 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9158 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9159 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9160
9161 @smallexample
9162 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9163 No sections are mapped.
9164 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9165 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9166 @end smallexample
9167 @noindent
9168 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9169 name normally:
9170
9171 @smallexample
9172 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9173 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9174 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9175 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9176 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9177 @end smallexample
9178
9179 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9180 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9181 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9182 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9183 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9184
9185 @itemize @bullet
9186 @item
9187 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9188 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9189 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9190 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9191 @item
9192 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9193 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9194 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9195 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9196 breakpoints properly.
9197 @end itemize
9198
9199
9200 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9201 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9202 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9203
9204 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9205 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9206 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9207 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9208 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9209 current state of the overlays.
9210
9211 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9212 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9213
9214 @table @asis
9215
9216 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9217 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9218
9219 @smallexample
9220 struct
9221 @{
9222 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9223 unsigned long vma;
9224
9225 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9226 unsigned long size;
9227
9228 /* The overlay's load address. */
9229 unsigned long lma;
9230
9231 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9232 zero otherwise. */
9233 unsigned long mapped;
9234 @}
9235 @end smallexample
9236
9237 @item @code{_novlys}:
9238 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9239 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9240
9241 @end table
9242
9243 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9244 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9245 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9246 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9247 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9248 currently mapped.
9249
9250 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9251 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9252 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9253 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9254 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9255 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9256 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9257 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9258 are not being executed.
9259
9260 @node Overlay Sample Program
9261 @section Overlay Sample Program
9262 @cindex overlay example program
9263
9264 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9265 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9266 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9267 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9268 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9269 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9270 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9271
9272 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9273 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9274 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9275 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9276
9277 @table @file
9278 @item overlays.c
9279 The main program file.
9280 @item ovlymgr.c
9281 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9282 @item foo.c
9283 @itemx bar.c
9284 @itemx baz.c
9285 @itemx grbx.c
9286 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9287 @item d10v.ld
9288 @itemx m32r.ld
9289 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9290 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9291 @end table
9292
9293 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9294 cross-compiler like this:
9295
9296 @smallexample
9297 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9298 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9299 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9300 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9301 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9302 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9303 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9304 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9305 @end smallexample
9306
9307 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9308 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9309 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9310
9311
9312 @node Languages
9313 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9314 @cindex languages
9315
9316 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9317 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9318 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9319 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9320 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9321 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9322
9323 @cindex working language
9324 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9325 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9326 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9327 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9328 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9329 language}.
9330
9331 @menu
9332 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9333 * Show:: Displaying the language
9334 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9335 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9336 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9337 @end menu
9338
9339 @node Setting
9340 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9341
9342 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9343 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9344 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9345 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9346 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9347 are printed, etc.
9348
9349 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9350 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9351 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9352 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9353 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9354 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9355 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9356 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9357 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9358 Displaying the Language}.
9359
9360 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9361 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9362 another language. In that case, make the
9363 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9364 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9365 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9366
9367 @menu
9368 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9369 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9370 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9371 @end menu
9372
9373 @node Filenames
9374 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9375
9376 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9377 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9378
9379 @table @file
9380 @item .ada
9381 @itemx .ads
9382 @itemx .adb
9383 @itemx .a
9384 Ada source file.
9385
9386 @item .c
9387 C source file
9388
9389 @item .C
9390 @itemx .cc
9391 @itemx .cp
9392 @itemx .cpp
9393 @itemx .cxx
9394 @itemx .c++
9395 C@t{++} source file
9396
9397 @item .m
9398 Objective-C source file
9399
9400 @item .f
9401 @itemx .F
9402 Fortran source file
9403
9404 @item .mod
9405 Modula-2 source file
9406
9407 @item .s
9408 @itemx .S
9409 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9410 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9411 @end table
9412
9413 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9414 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9415
9416 @node Manually
9417 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9418
9419 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9420 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9421 your program.
9422
9423 @kindex set language
9424 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9425 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9426 a language, such as
9427 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9428 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9429
9430 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9431 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9432 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9433 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9434 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9435 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9436 command such as:
9437
9438 @smallexample
9439 print a = b + c
9440 @end smallexample
9441
9442 @noindent
9443 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9444 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9445 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9446 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9447
9448 @node Automatically
9449 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9450
9451 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9452 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9453 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9454 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9455 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9456 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9457 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9458 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9459 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9460
9461 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9462 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9463 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9464 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9465 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9466
9467 @node Show
9468 @section Displaying the Language
9469
9470 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9471 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9472
9473 @table @code
9474 @item show language
9475 @kindex show language
9476 Display the current working language. This is the
9477 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9478 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9479
9480 @item info frame
9481 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9482 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9483 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9484 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9485 information listed here.
9486
9487 @item info source
9488 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9489 Display the source language of this source file.
9490 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9491 information listed here.
9492 @end table
9493
9494 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9495 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9496 with a language explicitly:
9497
9498 @table @code
9499 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9500 @kindex set extension-language
9501 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9502 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9503
9504 @item info extensions
9505 @kindex info extensions
9506 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9507 @end table
9508
9509 @node Checks
9510 @section Type and Range Checking
9511
9512 @quotation
9513 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9514 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9515 section documents the intended facilities.
9516 @end quotation
9517 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9518
9519 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9520 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9521 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9522 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9523 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9524 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9525 errors when your program is running.
9526
9527 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9528 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9529 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9530 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9531 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9532 automatically based on your program's source language.
9533 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9534 settings of supported languages.
9535
9536 @menu
9537 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9538 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9539 @end menu
9540
9541 @cindex type checking
9542 @cindex checks, type
9543 @node Type Checking
9544 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9545
9546 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9547 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9548 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9549 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9550
9551 @smallexample
9552 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9553 @exdent but
9554 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9555 @end smallexample
9556
9557 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9558 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9559
9560 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9561 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9562 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9563 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9564 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9565 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9566 also issues a warning.
9567
9568 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9569 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9570 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9571 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9572 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9573 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9574
9575 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9576 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9577 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9578 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9579 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9580 details on specific languages.
9581
9582 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9583
9584 @kindex set check type
9585 @kindex show check type
9586 @table @code
9587 @item set check type auto
9588 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9589 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9590 each language.
9591
9592 @item set check type on
9593 @itemx set check type off
9594 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9595 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9596 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9597 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9598 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9599
9600 @item set check type warn
9601 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9602 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9603 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9604 numbers and structures.
9605
9606 @item show type
9607 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9608 is setting it automatically.
9609 @end table
9610
9611 @cindex range checking
9612 @cindex checks, range
9613 @node Range Checking
9614 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9615
9616 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9617 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9618 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9619 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9620 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9621
9622 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9623 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9624 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9625 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9626
9627 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9628 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9629 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9630 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9631 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9632 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9633
9634 @smallexample
9635 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9636 @end smallexample
9637
9638 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9639 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9640 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9641
9642 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9643
9644 @kindex set check range
9645 @kindex show check range
9646 @table @code
9647 @item set check range auto
9648 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9649 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9650 each language.
9651
9652 @item set check range on
9653 @itemx set check range off
9654 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9655 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9656 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9657 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9658
9659 @item set check range warn
9660 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9661 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9662 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9663 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9664 systems).
9665
9666 @item show range
9667 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9668 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9669 @end table
9670
9671 @node Supported Languages
9672 @section Supported Languages
9673
9674 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9675 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9676 @c This is false ...
9677 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9678 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9679 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9680 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9681 language.
9682
9683 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9684 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9685 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9686 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9687 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9688 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9689 language reference or tutorial.
9690
9691 @menu
9692 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9693 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9694 * Fortran:: Fortran
9695 * Pascal:: Pascal
9696 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9697 * Ada:: Ada
9698 @end menu
9699
9700 @node C
9701 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9702
9703 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9704 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9705
9706 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9707 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9708 together.
9709
9710 @cindex C@t{++}
9711 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9712 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9713 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9714 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9715 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9716 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9717 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9718
9719 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9720 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9721 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9722 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9723 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9724 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9725
9726 @menu
9727 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9728 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9729 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9730 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9731 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9732 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9733 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9734 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9735 @end menu
9736
9737 @node C Operators
9738 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9739
9740 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9741
9742 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9743 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9744 often defined on groups of types.
9745
9746 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9747
9748 @itemize @bullet
9749
9750 @item
9751 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9752 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9753
9754 @item
9755 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9756 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9757
9758 @item
9759 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9760
9761 @item
9762 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9763
9764 @end itemize
9765
9766 @noindent
9767 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9768 in order of increasing precedence:
9769
9770 @table @code
9771 @item ,
9772 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9773 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9774 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9775
9776 @item =
9777 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9778 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9779
9780 @item @var{op}=
9781 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9782 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9783 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9784 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9785 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9786
9787 @item ?:
9788 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9789 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9790 integral type.
9791
9792 @item ||
9793 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9794
9795 @item &&
9796 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9797
9798 @item |
9799 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9800
9801 @item ^
9802 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9803
9804 @item &
9805 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9806
9807 @item ==@r{, }!=
9808 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9809 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9810
9811 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9812 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9813 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9814 and non-zero for true.
9815
9816 @item <<@r{, }>>
9817 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9818
9819 @item @@
9820 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9821
9822 @item +@r{, }-
9823 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9824 pointer types.
9825
9826 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9827 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9828 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9829 integral types.
9830
9831 @item ++@r{, }--
9832 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9833 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9834 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9835 operation takes place.
9836
9837 @item *
9838 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9839 @code{++}.
9840
9841 @item &
9842 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9843
9844 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9845 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9846 to examine the address
9847 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9848 stored.
9849
9850 @item -
9851 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9852 precedence as @code{++}.
9853
9854 @item !
9855 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9856 @code{++}.
9857
9858 @item ~
9859 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9860 @code{++}.
9861
9862
9863 @item .@r{, }->
9864 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9865 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9866 pointer based on the stored type information.
9867 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9868
9869 @item .*@r{, }->*
9870 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9871
9872 @item []
9873 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9874 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9875
9876 @item ()
9877 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9878
9879 @item ::
9880 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9881 and @code{class} types.
9882
9883 @item ::
9884 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9885 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9886 above.
9887 @end table
9888
9889 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9890 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9891 predefined meaning.
9892
9893 @node C Constants
9894 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9895
9896 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9897
9898 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9899 following ways:
9900
9901 @itemize @bullet
9902 @item
9903 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9904 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9905 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9906 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9907 @code{long} value.
9908
9909 @item
9910 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9911 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9912 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9913 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9914 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9915 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9916 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9917 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9918 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9919 constant.
9920
9921 @item
9922 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9923 integral equivalents.
9924
9925 @item
9926 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9927 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9928 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9929 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9930 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9931 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9932 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9933 @samp{\n} for newline.
9934
9935 @item
9936 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9937 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9938 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9939 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9940 characters.
9941
9942 @item
9943 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9944 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9945
9946 @item
9947 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9948 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9949 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9950 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9951 @end itemize
9952
9953 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9954 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9955
9956 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9957 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9958
9959 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9960 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9961 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9962 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9963 @quotation
9964 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9965 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9966 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9967 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9968 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9969 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9970 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9971 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9972 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9973 C@t{++} code.
9974 @end quotation
9975
9976 @enumerate
9977
9978 @cindex member functions
9979 @item
9980 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9981
9982 @smallexample
9983 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9984 @end smallexample
9985
9986 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9987 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9988 @item
9989 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9990 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9991 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9992 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9993
9994 @cindex call overloaded functions
9995 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9996 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9997 @item
9998 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9999 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10000 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10001 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10002 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10003 default arguments.
10004
10005 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10006 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10007 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10008 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10009 number of function arguments.
10010
10011 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10012 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10013 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10014
10015 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10016 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10017 @smallexample
10018 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10019 @end smallexample
10020
10021 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10022 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10023
10024 @cindex reference declarations
10025 @item
10026 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10027 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10028 dereferenced.
10029
10030 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10031 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10032 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10033 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10034 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10035
10036 @item
10037 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10038 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10039 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10040 necessary, for example in an expression like
10041 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10042 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10043 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10044 @end enumerate
10045
10046 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10047 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10048 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10049 invoking user-defined operators.
10050
10051 @node C Defaults
10052 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10053
10054 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10055
10056 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10057 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10058 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10059 selects the working language.
10060
10061 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10062 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10063 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10064 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10065 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10066 for further details.
10067
10068 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10069 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10070 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10071
10072 @node C Checks
10073 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10074
10075 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10076
10077 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10078 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10079 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10080
10081 @itemize @bullet
10082 @item
10083 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10084 enumerated tag.
10085
10086 @item
10087 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10088 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10089
10090 @ignore
10091 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10092 @c FIXME--beers?
10093 @item
10094 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10095 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10096 compilers.)
10097 @end ignore
10098 @end itemize
10099
10100 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10101 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10102 that is not itself an array.
10103
10104 @node Debugging C
10105 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10106
10107 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10108 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10109 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10110 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10111
10112 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10113 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10114 ,Expressions}.
10115
10116 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10117 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10118
10119 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10120
10121 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10122 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10123
10124 @table @code
10125 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10126 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10127 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10128 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10129 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10130 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10131
10132 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10133 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10134 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10135 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10136 classes.
10137 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10138
10139 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10140 @item catch throw
10141 @itemx catch catch
10142 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10143 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10144
10145 @cindex inheritance
10146 @item ptype @var{typename}
10147 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10148 @var{typename}.
10149 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10150
10151 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10152 @item set print demangle
10153 @itemx show print demangle
10154 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10155 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10156 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10157 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10158 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10159
10160 @item set print object
10161 @itemx show print object
10162 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10163 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10164
10165 @item set print vtbl
10166 @itemx show print vtbl
10167 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10168 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10169 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10170 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10171
10172 @kindex set overload-resolution
10173 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10174 @item set overload-resolution on
10175 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10176 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10177 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10178 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10179 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10180 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10181
10182 @item set overload-resolution off
10183 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10184 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10185 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10186 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10187 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10188 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10189 argument types.
10190
10191 @kindex show overload-resolution
10192 @item show overload-resolution
10193 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10194
10195 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10196 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10197 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10198 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10199 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10200 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10201 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10202 @end table
10203
10204 @node Decimal Floating Point
10205 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10206 @cindex decimal floating point format
10207
10208 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10209 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10210 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10211 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10212
10213 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10214 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10215 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10216 target.
10217
10218 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10219 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10220 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10221
10222 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10223 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10224 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10225
10226 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10227 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10228 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10229
10230 @node Objective-C
10231 @subsection Objective-C
10232
10233 @cindex Objective-C
10234 This section provides information about some commands and command
10235 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10236 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10237 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10238
10239 @menu
10240 * Method Names in Commands::
10241 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10242 @end menu
10243
10244 @node Method Names in Commands
10245 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10246
10247 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10248 names as line specifications:
10249
10250 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10251 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10252 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10253 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10254 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10255 @itemize
10256 @item @code{clear}
10257 @item @code{break}
10258 @item @code{info line}
10259 @item @code{jump}
10260 @item @code{list}
10261 @end itemize
10262
10263 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10264
10265 @smallexample
10266 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10267 @end smallexample
10268
10269 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10270 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10271 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10272 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10273 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10274 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10275 debugged, enter:
10276
10277 @smallexample
10278 break -[Fruit create]
10279 @end smallexample
10280
10281 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10282 enter:
10283
10284 @smallexample
10285 list +[NSText initialize]
10286 @end smallexample
10287
10288 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10289 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10290 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10291 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10292
10293 @smallexample
10294 break create
10295 @end smallexample
10296
10297 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10298 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10299 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10300 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10301 none apply.
10302
10303 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10304 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10305
10306 @smallexample
10307 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10308 @end smallexample
10309
10310 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10311 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10312 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10313 @kindex print-object
10314 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10315
10316 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10317
10318 @smallexample
10319 print -[@var{object} hash]
10320 @end smallexample
10321
10322 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10323 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10324 @noindent
10325 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10326 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10327 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10328 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10329 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10330 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10331
10332 @node Fortran
10333 @subsection Fortran
10334 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10335
10336 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10337 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10338
10339 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10340 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10341 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10342 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10343 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10344 underscore.
10345
10346 @menu
10347 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10348 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10349 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10350 @end menu
10351
10352 @node Fortran Operators
10353 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10354
10355 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10356
10357 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10358 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10359 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10360
10361 @table @code
10362 @item **
10363 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10364 of the second one.
10365
10366 @item :
10367 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10368 represent a section of array.
10369
10370 @item %
10371 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10372 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10373 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10374 union type.
10375 @end table
10376
10377 @node Fortran Defaults
10378 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10379
10380 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10381
10382 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10383 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10384 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10385 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10386
10387 @node Special Fortran Commands
10388 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10389
10390 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10391
10392 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10393 such as displaying common blocks.
10394
10395 @table @code
10396 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10397 @kindex info common
10398 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10399 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10400 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10401 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10402 printed.
10403 @end table
10404
10405 @node Pascal
10406 @subsection Pascal
10407
10408 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10409 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10410 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10411 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10412 syntax.
10413
10414 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10415 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10416 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10417
10418 @node Modula-2
10419 @subsection Modula-2
10420
10421 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10422
10423 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10424 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10425 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10426 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10427 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10428 table.
10429
10430 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10431 @menu
10432 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10433 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10434 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10435 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10436 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10437 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10438 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10439 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10440 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10441 @end menu
10442
10443 @node M2 Operators
10444 @subsubsection Operators
10445 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10446
10447 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10448 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10449 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10450 following definitions hold:
10451
10452 @itemize @bullet
10453
10454 @item
10455 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10456 their subranges.
10457
10458 @item
10459 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10460
10461 @item
10462 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10463
10464 @item
10465 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10466 @var{type}}.
10467
10468 @item
10469 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10470
10471 @item
10472 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10473
10474 @item
10475 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10476 @end itemize
10477
10478 @noindent
10479 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10480 increasing precedence:
10481
10482 @table @code
10483 @item ,
10484 Function argument or array index separator.
10485
10486 @item :=
10487 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10488 @var{value}.
10489
10490 @item <@r{, }>
10491 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10492 types.
10493
10494 @item <=@r{, }>=
10495 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10496 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10497 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10498
10499 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10500 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10501 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10502 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10503 comment character.
10504
10505 @item IN
10506 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10507 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10508
10509 @item OR
10510 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10511
10512 @item AND@r{, }&
10513 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10514
10515 @item @@
10516 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10517
10518 @item +@r{, }-
10519 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10520 and difference on set types.
10521
10522 @item *
10523 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10524 on set types.
10525
10526 @item /
10527 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10528 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10529
10530 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10531 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10532 precedence as @code{*}.
10533
10534 @item -
10535 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10536
10537 @item ^
10538 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10539
10540 @item NOT
10541 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10542 @code{^}.
10543
10544 @item .
10545 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10546 precedence as @code{^}.
10547
10548 @item []
10549 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10550
10551 @item ()
10552 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10553 as @code{^}.
10554
10555 @item ::@r{, }.
10556 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10557 @end table
10558
10559 @quotation
10560 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10561 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10562 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10563 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10564 @end quotation
10565
10566
10567 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10568 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10569 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10570
10571 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10572 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10573
10574 @table @var
10575
10576 @item a
10577 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10578
10579 @item c
10580 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10581
10582 @item i
10583 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10584
10585 @item m
10586 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10587 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10588 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10589
10590 @item n
10591 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10592
10593 @item r
10594 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10595
10596 @item t
10597 represents a type.
10598
10599 @item v
10600 represents a variable.
10601
10602 @item x
10603 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10604 explanation of the function for details.
10605 @end table
10606
10607 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10608
10609 @table @code
10610 @item ABS(@var{n})
10611 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10612
10613 @item CAP(@var{c})
10614 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10615 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10616
10617 @item CHR(@var{i})
10618 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10619
10620 @item DEC(@var{v})
10621 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10622
10623 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10624 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10625 new value.
10626
10627 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10628 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10629 set.
10630
10631 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10632 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10633
10634 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10635 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10636
10637 @item INC(@var{v})
10638 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10639
10640 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10641 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10642 new value.
10643
10644 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10645 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10646 there. Returns the new set.
10647
10648 @item MAX(@var{t})
10649 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10650
10651 @item MIN(@var{t})
10652 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10653
10654 @item ODD(@var{i})
10655 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10656
10657 @item ORD(@var{x})
10658 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10659 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10660 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10661 integral, character and enumerated types.
10662
10663 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10664 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10665
10666 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10667 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10668
10669 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10670 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10671
10672 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10673 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10674 @end table
10675
10676 @quotation
10677 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10678 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10679 an error.
10680 @end quotation
10681
10682 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10683 @node M2 Constants
10684 @subsubsection Constants
10685
10686 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10687 ways:
10688
10689 @itemize @bullet
10690
10691 @item
10692 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10693 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10694 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10695 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10696
10697 @item
10698 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10699 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10700 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10701 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10702 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10703 digits.
10704
10705 @item
10706 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10707 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10708 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10709 followed by a @samp{C}.
10710
10711 @item
10712 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10713 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10714 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10715 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10716 sequences.
10717
10718 @item
10719 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10720
10721 @item
10722 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10723 @code{FALSE}.
10724
10725 @item
10726 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10727
10728 @item
10729 Set constants are not yet supported.
10730 @end itemize
10731
10732 @node M2 Types
10733 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10734 @cindex Modula-2 types
10735
10736 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10737 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10738 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10739 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10740 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10741 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10742
10743 The first example contains the following section of code:
10744
10745 @smallexample
10746 VAR
10747 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10748 r: [20..40] ;
10749 @end smallexample
10750
10751 @noindent
10752 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10753 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10754
10755 @smallexample
10756 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10757 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10758 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10759 SET OF CHAR
10760 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10761 21
10762 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10763 [20..40]
10764 @end smallexample
10765
10766 @noindent
10767 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10768
10769 @smallexample
10770 VAR
10771 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10772 @end smallexample
10773
10774 @noindent
10775 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10776
10777 @smallexample
10778 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10779 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10780 @end smallexample
10781
10782 @noindent
10783 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10784 expressions using the debugger.
10785
10786 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10787 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10788
10789 @smallexample
10790 VAR
10791 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10792 @end smallexample
10793
10794 @smallexample
10795 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10796 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10797 @end smallexample
10798
10799 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10800 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10801 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10802 above.
10803
10804 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10805
10806 @smallexample
10807 TYPE
10808 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10809 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10810 VAR
10811 s: t ;
10812 BEGIN
10813 s := blue ;
10814 @end smallexample
10815
10816 @noindent
10817 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10818 and value of a variable.
10819
10820 @smallexample
10821 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10822 $1 = blue
10823 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10824 type = [blue..yellow]
10825 @end smallexample
10826
10827 @noindent
10828 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10829 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10830 their @code{C} counterparts.
10831
10832 @smallexample
10833 VAR
10834 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10835 BEGIN
10836 s[1] := 1 ;
10837 @end smallexample
10838
10839 @smallexample
10840 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10841 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10842 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10843 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10844 @end smallexample
10845
10846 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10847 pointer types as shown in this example:
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 VAR
10851 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10852 BEGIN
10853 NEW(s) ;
10854 s^[1] := 1 ;
10855 @end smallexample
10856
10857 @noindent
10858 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10859
10860 @smallexample
10861 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10862 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10863 @end smallexample
10864
10865 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10866 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10867 types:
10868
10869 @smallexample
10870 TYPE
10871 foo = RECORD
10872 f1: CARDINAL ;
10873 f2: CHAR ;
10874 f3: myarray ;
10875 END ;
10876
10877 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10878 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10879 VAR
10880 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10881 @end smallexample
10882
10883 @noindent
10884 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10885 below.
10886
10887 @smallexample
10888 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10889 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10890 f1 : CARDINAL;
10891 f2 : CHAR;
10892 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10893 END
10894 @end smallexample
10895
10896 @node M2 Defaults
10897 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10898 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10899
10900 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10901 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10902 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10903 selected the working language.
10904
10905 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10906 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10907 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10908 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10909
10910 @node Deviations
10911 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10912 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10913
10914 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10915 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10916
10917 @itemize @bullet
10918 @item
10919 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10920 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10921 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10922 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10923 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10924 returned a pointer.)
10925
10926 @item
10927 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10928 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10929 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10930 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10931
10932 @item
10933 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10934 argument.
10935
10936 @item
10937 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10938 @end itemize
10939
10940 @node M2 Checks
10941 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10942 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10943
10944 @quotation
10945 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10946 range checking.
10947 @end quotation
10948 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10949
10950 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10951
10952 @itemize @bullet
10953 @item
10954 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10955 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10956
10957 @item
10958 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10959 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10960 @end itemize
10961
10962 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10963 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10964
10965 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10966 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10967
10968 @node M2 Scope
10969 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10970 @cindex scope
10971 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10972 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10973 @ifinfo
10974 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10975 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10976 @end ifinfo
10977 @iftex
10978 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10979 @end iftex
10980
10981 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10982 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10983 similar syntax:
10984
10985 @smallexample
10986
10987 @var{module} . @var{id}
10988 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10989 @end smallexample
10990
10991 @noindent
10992 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10993 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10994 identifier within your program, except another module.
10995
10996 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10997 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10998 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10999 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11000
11001 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11002 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11003 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11004 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11005 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11006 @var{module}.
11007
11008 @node GDB/M2
11009 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11010
11011 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11012 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11013 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11014 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11015 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11016 analogue in Modula-2.
11017
11018 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11019 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11020 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11021 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11022 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11023 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11024
11025 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11026 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11027 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11028
11029 @node Ada
11030 @subsection Ada
11031 @cindex Ada
11032
11033 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11034 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11035 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11036 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11037 to be difficult.
11038
11039
11040 @cindex expressions in Ada
11041 @menu
11042 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11043 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11044 in @value{GDBN}.
11045 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11046 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11047 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11048 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11049 @end menu
11050
11051 @node Ada Mode Intro
11052 @subsubsection Introduction
11053 @cindex Ada mode, general
11054
11055 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11056 syntax, with some extensions.
11057 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11058
11059 @itemize @bullet
11060 @item
11061 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11062 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11063 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11064 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11065
11066 @item
11067 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11068 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11069
11070 @item
11071 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11072 @end itemize
11073
11074 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
11075 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
11076 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
11077 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
11078 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11079
11080 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11081 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11082 was translated from an Ada source file.
11083
11084 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11085 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11086 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11087 middle (to allow based literals).
11088
11089 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11090 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11091 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11092 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11093 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11094 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11095
11096 @node Omissions from Ada
11097 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11098 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11099
11100 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11101
11102 @itemize @bullet
11103 @item
11104 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11105
11106 @itemize @minus
11107 @item
11108 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11109 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11110
11111 @item
11112 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11113
11114 @item
11115 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11116
11117 @item
11118 @t{'Tag}.
11119
11120 @item
11121 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11122 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11123
11124 @item
11125 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11126 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11127
11128 @item
11129 @t{'Address}.
11130 @end itemize
11131
11132 @item
11133 The names in
11134 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11135 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11136 not currently available.
11137
11138 @item
11139 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11140 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11141 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11142 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11143 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11144 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11145 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11146 indeterminate values.
11147
11148 @item
11149 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11150 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11151 are not implemented.
11152
11153 @item
11154 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11155 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11156 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11157 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11158 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11159
11160 @smallexample
11161 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11162 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11163 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11164 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11165 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11166 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11167 @end smallexample
11168
11169 Changing a
11170 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11171 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11172 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11173 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11174 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11175 declared to have a type such as:
11176
11177 @smallexample
11178 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11179 Id : Integer;
11180 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11181 end record;
11182 @end smallexample
11183
11184 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11185 assignments:
11186
11187 @smallexample
11188 set A_Rec.Len := 4
11189 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11190 @end smallexample
11191
11192 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11193 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11194 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11195 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11196 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11197 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11198 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11199 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11200
11201 @item
11202 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11203
11204 @item
11205 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11206 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11207 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11208 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11209 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11210 the proper resolution.
11211
11212 @item
11213 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11214
11215 @item
11216 Entry calls are not implemented.
11217
11218 @item
11219 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11220 formats are not supported.
11221
11222 @item
11223 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11224 @end itemize
11225
11226 @node Additions to Ada
11227 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11228 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11229
11230 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11231 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11232
11233 @itemize @bullet
11234 @item
11235 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11236 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11237 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11238 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11239 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11240 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11241 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11242 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11243
11244 @item
11245 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11246 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11247 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11248
11249 @item
11250 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11251 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11252
11253 @item
11254 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11255 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11256 @end itemize
11257
11258 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11259 additions specific to Ada:
11260
11261 @itemize @bullet
11262 @item
11263 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11264 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11265
11266 @smallexample
11267 set x := y + 3
11268 print A(tmp := y + 1)
11269 @end smallexample
11270
11271 @item
11272 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11273 the value of its right-hand operand.
11274 This allows, for example,
11275 complex conditional breaks:
11276
11277 @smallexample
11278 break f
11279 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11280 @end smallexample
11281
11282 @item
11283 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11284 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11285 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11286 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11287 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11288 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11289 in strings. For example,
11290 @smallexample
11291 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11292 @end smallexample
11293 @noindent
11294 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11295 after each period.
11296
11297 @item
11298 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11299 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11300 to write
11301
11302 @smallexample
11303 print 'max(x, y)
11304 @end smallexample
11305
11306 @item
11307 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11308 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11309 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11310 of 3 might print as
11311
11312 @smallexample
11313 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11314 @end smallexample
11315
11316 @noindent
11317 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11318 clause.
11319
11320 @item
11321 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11322 multi-character subsequence of
11323 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11324 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11325 in place of @t{a'length}.
11326
11327 @item
11328 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11329 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11330 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11331 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11332 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11333 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11334 For example,
11335 @smallexample
11336 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11337 @end smallexample
11338
11339 @item
11340 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11341 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11342 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11343 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11344 object.
11345
11346 @end itemize
11347
11348 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11349 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11350
11351 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11352 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11353 before reaching the main procedure.
11354 As defined in the Ada Reference
11355 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11356 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11357 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11358 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11359
11360 @node Ada Glitches
11361 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11362 @cindex Ada, problems
11363
11364 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11365 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11366 @value{GDBN},
11367 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11368 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11369
11370 @itemize @bullet
11371 @item
11372 Currently, the debugger
11373 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11374 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11375 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11376 to get it printed properly.
11377
11378 @item
11379 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11380 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11381
11382 @item
11383 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11384 argument lists are treated as positional).
11385
11386 @item
11387 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11388
11389 @item
11390 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11391 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11392 the host machine.
11393
11394 @item
11395 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
11396
11397 @item
11398 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11399 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11400 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11401 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11402 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11403 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11404 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11405 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11406 you can usually resolve the confusion
11407 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11408 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11409 @end itemize
11410
11411 @node Unsupported Languages
11412 @section Unsupported Languages
11413
11414 @cindex unsupported languages
11415 @cindex minimal language
11416 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11417 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11418 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11419 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11420 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11421 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11422
11423 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11424 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11425 language.
11426
11427 @node Symbols
11428 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11429
11430 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11431 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11432 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11433 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11434 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11435 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11436 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11437
11438 @cindex symbol names
11439 @cindex names of symbols
11440 @cindex quoting names
11441 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11442 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11443 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11444 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11445 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11446 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11447 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11448 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11449
11450 @smallexample
11451 p 'foo.c'::x
11452 @end smallexample
11453
11454 @noindent
11455 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11456
11457 @table @code
11458 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11459 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11460 @kindex set case-sensitive
11461 @item set case-sensitive on
11462 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11463 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11464 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11465 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11466 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11467 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11468 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11469 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11470 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11471 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11472 case-insensitive matches.
11473
11474 @kindex show case-sensitive
11475 @item show case-sensitive
11476 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11477 lookups.
11478
11479 @kindex info address
11480 @cindex address of a symbol
11481 @item info address @var{symbol}
11482 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11483 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11484 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11485 is always stored.
11486
11487 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11488 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11489 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11490
11491 @kindex info symbol
11492 @cindex symbol from address
11493 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11494 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11495 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11496 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11497 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11498
11499 @smallexample
11500 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11501 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11502 @end smallexample
11503
11504 @noindent
11505 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11506 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11507
11508 @kindex whatis
11509 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11510 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11511 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11512 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11513 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11514 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11515 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11516 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11517 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11518 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11519 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11520
11521 @kindex ptype
11522 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11523 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11524 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11525 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11526
11527 For example, for this variable declaration:
11528
11529 @smallexample
11530 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11531 @end smallexample
11532
11533 @noindent
11534 the two commands give this output:
11535
11536 @smallexample
11537 @group
11538 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11539 type = struct complex
11540 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11541 type = struct complex @{
11542 double real;
11543 double imag;
11544 @}
11545 @end group
11546 @end smallexample
11547
11548 @noindent
11549 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11550 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11551
11552 @cindex incomplete type
11553 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11554 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11555 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11556 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11557 given these declarations:
11558
11559 @smallexample
11560 struct foo;
11561 struct foo *fooptr;
11562 @end smallexample
11563
11564 @noindent
11565 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11566
11567 @smallexample
11568 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11569 $1 = <incomplete type>
11570 @end smallexample
11571
11572 @noindent
11573 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11574 completely specified.
11575
11576 @kindex info types
11577 @item info types @var{regexp}
11578 @itemx info types
11579 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11580 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11581 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11582 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11583 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11584 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11585 name is @code{value}.
11586
11587 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11588 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11589 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11590
11591 @kindex info scope
11592 @cindex local variables
11593 @item info scope @var{location}
11594 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11595 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11596 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11597 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11598 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11599
11600 @smallexample
11601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11602 Scope for command_line_handler:
11603 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11604 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11605 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11606 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11607 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11608 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11609 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11610 @end smallexample
11611
11612 @noindent
11613 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11614 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11615 collect}.
11616
11617 @kindex info source
11618 @item info source
11619 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11620 the function containing the current point of execution:
11621 @itemize @bullet
11622 @item
11623 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11624 @item
11625 the directory it was compiled in,
11626 @item
11627 its length, in lines,
11628 @item
11629 which programming language it is written in,
11630 @item
11631 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11632 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11633 @item
11634 whether the debugging information includes information about
11635 preprocessor macros.
11636 @end itemize
11637
11638
11639 @kindex info sources
11640 @item info sources
11641 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11642 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11643 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11644
11645 @kindex info functions
11646 @item info functions
11647 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11648
11649 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11650 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11651 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11652 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11653 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11654 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11655 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11656 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11657
11658 @kindex info variables
11659 @item info variables
11660 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11661 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11662
11663 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11664 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11665 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11666 @var{regexp}.
11667
11668 @kindex info classes
11669 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11670 @item info classes
11671 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11672 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11673 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11674 expression.
11675
11676 @kindex info selectors
11677 @item info selectors
11678 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11679 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11680 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11681 expression.
11682
11683 @ignore
11684 This was never implemented.
11685 @kindex info methods
11686 @item info methods
11687 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11688 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11689 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11690 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11691 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11692 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11693 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11694 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11695 @end ignore
11696
11697 @cindex reloading symbols
11698 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11699 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11700 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11701 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11702 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11703
11704 @table @code
11705 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11706 @item set symbol-reloading on
11707 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11708 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11709
11710 @item set symbol-reloading off
11711 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11712 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11713 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11714 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11715 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11716 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11717 name.
11718
11719 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11720 @item show symbol-reloading
11721 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11722 @end table
11723
11724 @cindex opaque data types
11725 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11726 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11727 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11728 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11729 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11730 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11731 another source file. The default is on.
11732
11733 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11734 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11735
11736 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11737 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11738 is printed as follows:
11739 @smallexample
11740 @{<no data fields>@}
11741 @end smallexample
11742
11743 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11744 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11745 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11746
11747 @kindex set print symbol-loading
11748 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
11749 @item set print symbol-loading
11750 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
11751 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
11752 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
11753 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11754 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
11755 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
11756 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
11757 annoying than useful.
11758
11759 @kindex show print symbol-loading
11760 @item show print symbol-loading
11761 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11762
11763 @kindex maint print symbols
11764 @cindex symbol dump
11765 @kindex maint print psymbols
11766 @cindex partial symbol dump
11767 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11768 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11769 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11770 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11771 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11772 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11773 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11774 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11775 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11776 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11777 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11778 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11779 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11780 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11781 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11782 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11783 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11784
11785 @kindex maint info symtabs
11786 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11787 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11788 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11789 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11790 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11791 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11792 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11793
11794 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11795 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11796 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11797 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11798 structure in more detail. For example:
11799
11800 @smallexample
11801 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11802 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11803 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11804 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11805 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11806 readin no
11807 fullname (null)
11808 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11809 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11810 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11811 dependencies (none)
11812 @}
11813 @}
11814 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11815 (@value{GDBP})
11816 @end smallexample
11817 @noindent
11818 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11819 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11820 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11821 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11822 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11823
11824 @smallexample
11825 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11826 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11827 line 1574.
11828 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11829 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11830 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11831 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11832 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11833 dirname (null)
11834 fullname (null)
11835 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11836 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11837 debugformat DWARF 2
11838 @}
11839 @}
11840 (@value{GDBP})
11841 @end smallexample
11842 @end table
11843
11844
11845 @node Altering
11846 @chapter Altering Execution
11847
11848 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11849 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11850 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11851 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11852 program.
11853
11854 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11855 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11856 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11857
11858 @menu
11859 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11860 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11861 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11862 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11863 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11864 * Patching:: Patching your program
11865 @end menu
11866
11867 @node Assignment
11868 @section Assignment to Variables
11869
11870 @cindex assignment
11871 @cindex setting variables
11872 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11873 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11874
11875 @smallexample
11876 print x=4
11877 @end smallexample
11878
11879 @noindent
11880 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11881 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11882 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11883 information on operators in supported languages.
11884
11885 @kindex set variable
11886 @cindex variables, setting
11887 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11888 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11889 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11890 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11891 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11892
11893 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11894 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11895 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11896 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11897 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11898 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11899 command @code{set width}:
11900
11901 @smallexample
11902 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11903 type = double
11904 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11905 $4 = 13
11906 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11907 Invalid syntax in expression.
11908 @end smallexample
11909
11910 @noindent
11911 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11912 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11913
11914 @smallexample
11915 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11916 @end smallexample
11917
11918 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11919 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11920 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11921 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11922 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11923 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11924
11925 @smallexample
11926 @group
11927 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11928 type = double
11929 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11930 $1 = 1
11931 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11932 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11933 $2 = 1
11934 (@value{GDBP}) r
11935 The program being debugged has been started already.
11936 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11937 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11938 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11939 Invalid bfd target.
11940 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11941 The current BFD target is "=4".
11942 @end group
11943 @end smallexample
11944
11945 @noindent
11946 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11947 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11948 @code{g}, use
11949
11950 @smallexample
11951 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11952 @end smallexample
11953
11954 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11955 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11956 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11957 same length or shorter.
11958 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11959 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11960
11961 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11962 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11963 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11964 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11965 and representation in memory), and
11966
11967 @smallexample
11968 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11969 @end smallexample
11970
11971 @noindent
11972 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11973
11974 @node Jumping
11975 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11976
11977 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11978 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11979 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11980
11981 @table @code
11982 @kindex jump
11983 @item jump @var{linespec}
11984 @itemx jump @var{location}
11985 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11986 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11987 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11988 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11989 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11990 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11991
11992 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11993 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11994 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11995 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11996 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11997 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11998 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11999 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12000 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12001 @end table
12002
12003 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12004 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12005 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12006 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12007 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12008 example,
12009
12010 @smallexample
12011 set $pc = 0x485
12012 @end smallexample
12013
12014 @noindent
12015 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12016 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12017 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12018
12019 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12020 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12021 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12022 detail.
12023
12024 @c @group
12025 @node Signaling
12026 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12027 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12028
12029 @table @code
12030 @kindex signal
12031 @item signal @var{signal}
12032 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12033 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12034 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12035 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12036
12037 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12038 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12039 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12040 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12041 signal.
12042
12043 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12044 after executing the command.
12045 @end table
12046 @c @end group
12047
12048 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12049 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12050 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12051 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12052 passes the signal directly to your program.
12053
12054
12055 @node Returning
12056 @section Returning from a Function
12057
12058 @table @code
12059 @cindex returning from a function
12060 @kindex return
12061 @item return
12062 @itemx return @var{expression}
12063 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12064 command. If you give an
12065 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12066 value.
12067 @end table
12068
12069 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12070 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12071 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12072 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12073
12074 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12075 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12076 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12077 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12078 of functions.
12079
12080 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12081 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12082 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12083 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12084 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12085
12086 @node Calling
12087 @section Calling Program Functions
12088
12089 @table @code
12090 @cindex calling functions
12091 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12092 @item print @var{expr}
12093 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12094 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12095 debugged.
12096
12097 @kindex call
12098 @item call @var{expr}
12099 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12100 returned values.
12101
12102 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12103 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12104 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12105 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12106 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12107 value history.
12108 @end table
12109
12110 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12111 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12112 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12113 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12114
12115 @table @code
12116 @item set unwindonsignal
12117 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12118 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12119 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12120 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12121 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12122 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12123 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12124 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12125 received.
12126
12127 @item show unwindonsignal
12128 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12129 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12130 @value{GDBN}.
12131 @end table
12132
12133 @cindex weak alias functions
12134 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12135 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12136 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12137 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12138 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12139 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12140 function instead.
12141
12142 @node Patching
12143 @section Patching Programs
12144
12145 @cindex patching binaries
12146 @cindex writing into executables
12147 @cindex writing into corefiles
12148
12149 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12150 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12151 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12152 patching your program's binary.
12153
12154 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12155 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12156 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12157 repairs.
12158
12159 @table @code
12160 @kindex set write
12161 @item set write on
12162 @itemx set write off
12163 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12164 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
12165 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12166
12167 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12168 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12169 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12170
12171 @item show write
12172 @kindex show write
12173 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12174 as well as reading.
12175 @end table
12176
12177 @node GDB Files
12178 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12179
12180 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12181 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12182 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12183 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12184
12185 @menu
12186 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12187 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12188 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12189 @end menu
12190
12191 @node Files
12192 @section Commands to Specify Files
12193
12194 @cindex symbol table
12195 @cindex core dump file
12196
12197 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12198 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12199 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12200 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12201
12202 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12203 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12204 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12205 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12206 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12207 new files are useful.
12208
12209 @table @code
12210 @cindex executable file
12211 @kindex file
12212 @item file @var{filename}
12213 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12214 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12215 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12216 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12217 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12218 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12219 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12220 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12221
12222 @cindex unlinked object files
12223 @cindex patching object files
12224 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12225 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12226 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12227 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12228 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12229 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12230 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12231 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12232
12233 @item file
12234 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12235 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12236
12237 @kindex exec-file
12238 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12239 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12240 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12241 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12242 discard information on the executable file.
12243
12244 @kindex symbol-file
12245 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12246 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12247 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12248 table and program to run from the same file.
12249
12250 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12251 program's symbol table.
12252
12253 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12254 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12255 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12256 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12257 @value{GDBN}.
12258
12259 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12260 executing it once.
12261
12262 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12263 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12264 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12265 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12266 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12267 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12268 optimized code.
12269
12270 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12271 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12272 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12273 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12274 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12275
12276 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12277 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12278 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12279 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12280 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12281 Warnings and Messages}.)
12282
12283 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12284 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12285 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12286 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12287 in stabs format.
12288
12289 @kindex readnow
12290 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12291 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12292 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12293 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12294 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12295 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12296 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12297 entire symbol table available.
12298
12299 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12300 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12301 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12302 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12303 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12304 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12305 @c files.
12306
12307 @kindex core-file
12308 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12309 @itemx core
12310 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12311 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12312 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12313 executable file itself for other parts.
12314
12315 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12316 to be used.
12317
12318 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12319 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12320 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12321 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12322 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12323
12324 @kindex add-symbol-file
12325 @cindex dynamic linking
12326 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12327 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12328 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12329 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12330 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12331 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12332 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12333 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12334 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12335 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12336 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12337 @var{address} as an expression.
12338
12339 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12340 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12341 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12342 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12343 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12344
12345 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12346 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12347 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12348 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12349 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12350 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12351 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12352 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12353 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12354
12355 @itemize @bullet
12356 @item
12357 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12358 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12359 @item
12360 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12361 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12362 @item
12363 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12364 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12365 @end itemize
12366
12367 @noindent
12368 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12369 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12370 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12371 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12372 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12373 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12374 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12375 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12376 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12377 way.
12378
12379 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12380
12381 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12382 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12383 @cindex load symbols from memory
12384 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12385 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12386 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12387 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12388 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12389 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12390 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12391 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12392 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12393
12394 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12395 @kindex assf
12396 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12397 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12398 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12399 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12400 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12401 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12402 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12403 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12404 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12405 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12406
12407 @kindex section
12408 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12409 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12410 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12411 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12412 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12413 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12414 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12415 their addresses.
12416
12417 @kindex info files
12418 @kindex info target
12419 @item info files
12420 @itemx info target
12421 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12422 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12423 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12424 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12425 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12426 current ones.
12427
12428 @kindex maint info sections
12429 @item maint info sections
12430 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12431 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12432 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12433 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12434 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12435 may be arbitrarily combined):
12436
12437 @table @code
12438 @item ALLOBJ
12439 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12440 @item @var{sections}
12441 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12442 @item @var{section-flags}
12443 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12444 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12445 @table @code
12446 @item ALLOC
12447 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12448 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12449 @item LOAD
12450 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12451 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12452 @item RELOC
12453 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12454 @item READONLY
12455 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12456 @item CODE
12457 Section contains executable code only.
12458 @item DATA
12459 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12460 @item ROM
12461 Section will reside in ROM.
12462 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12463 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12464 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12465 Section is not empty.
12466 @item NEVER_LOAD
12467 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12468 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12469 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12470 COFF shared library information.
12471 @item IS_COMMON
12472 Section contains common symbols.
12473 @end table
12474 @end table
12475 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12476 @cindex read-only sections
12477 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12478 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12479 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12480 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12481 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12482 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12483 enhancement to debugging performance.
12484
12485 The default is off.
12486
12487 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12488 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12489 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12490 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12491
12492 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12493 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12494 @end table
12495
12496 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12497 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12498 name and remembers it that way.
12499
12500 @cindex shared libraries
12501 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12502 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12503 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12504
12505 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12506 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12507
12508 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12509 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12510 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12511 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12512 debugging a core file).
12513
12514 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12515 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12516
12517 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12518 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12519 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12520
12521 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12522 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12523 particularly large or there are many of them.
12524
12525 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12526 commands:
12527
12528 @table @code
12529 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12530 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12531 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12532 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12533 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12534 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12535 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12536 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12537
12538 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12539 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12540 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12541 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12542 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12543 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12544 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12545 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12546 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12547
12548 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12549 @item show auto-solib-add
12550 Display the current autoloading mode.
12551 @end table
12552
12553 @cindex load shared library
12554 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12555 command:
12556
12557 @table @code
12558 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12559 @kindex info share
12560 @item info share
12561 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12562 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12563
12564 @kindex sharedlibrary
12565 @kindex share
12566 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12567 @itemx share @var{regex}
12568 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12569 Unix regular expression.
12570 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12571 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12572 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12573 loaded.
12574
12575 @item nosharedlibrary
12576 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12577 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12578 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12579 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12580 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12581 discarded.
12582 @end table
12583
12584 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12585 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12586 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12587
12588 @table @code
12589 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12590 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12591 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12592 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12593 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12594 shared library.
12595
12596 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12597 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12598 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12599 library events happen.
12600 @end table
12601
12602 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12603 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12604 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12605 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12606 not.
12607
12608 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12609 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12610 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12611 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12612 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12613
12614 @table @code
12615 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12616 @cindex system root, alternate
12617 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12618 @kindex set sysroot
12619 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12620 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12621 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12622 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12623 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12624 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12625 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12626 under @var{path}.
12627
12628 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12629 sysroot}.
12630
12631 @cindex default system root
12632 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12633 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12634 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12635 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12636 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12637 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12638 location.
12639
12640 @kindex show sysroot
12641 @item show sysroot
12642 Display the current shared library prefix.
12643
12644 @kindex set solib-search-path
12645 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12646 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12647 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12648 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12649 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12650 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12651 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12652 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12653 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12654 of shared library symbols.
12655
12656 @kindex show solib-search-path
12657 @item show solib-search-path
12658 Display the current shared library search path.
12659 @end table
12660
12661
12662 @node Separate Debug Files
12663 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12664 @cindex separate debugging information files
12665 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12666 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12667 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12668 @cindex global debugging information directory
12669 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12670 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12671
12672 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12673 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12674 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12675 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12676 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12677 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12678 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12679
12680 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12681 file:
12682
12683 @itemize @bullet
12684 @item
12685 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12686 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12687 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12688 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12689 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12690 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12691 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12692 came from the same build.
12693
12694 @item
12695 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12696 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12697 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12698 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12699 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12700 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12701 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12702 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12703 below.
12704 @end itemize
12705
12706 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12707 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12708
12709 @itemize @bullet
12710 @item
12711 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12712 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12713 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12714 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12715 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12716
12717 @item
12718 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12719 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12720 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12721 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12722 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12723 hex characters, not 10.)
12724 @end itemize
12725
12726 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12727 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12728 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12729 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12730 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12731 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12732
12733 @itemize @minus
12734 @item
12735 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12736 @item
12737 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12738 @item
12739 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12740 @item
12741 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12742 @end itemize
12743
12744 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12745 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12746
12747 @table @code
12748
12749 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12750 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12751 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12752 information files to @var{directory}.
12753
12754 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12755 @item show debug-file-directory
12756 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12757 information files.
12758
12759 @end table
12760
12761 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12762 @cindex debug link sections
12763 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12764 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12765
12766 @itemize
12767 @item
12768 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12769 a zero byte,
12770 @item
12771 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12772 boundary within the section, and
12773 @item
12774 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12775 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12776 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12777 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12778 @end itemize
12779
12780 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12781 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12782 described above.
12783
12784 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12785 @cindex build ID sections
12786 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12787 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12788 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12789 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12790 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12791 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12792 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12793 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12794 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12795
12796 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12797 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12798 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12799 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12800 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12801 in an ordinary executable.
12802
12803 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12804 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12805 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12806 following commands:
12807
12808 @smallexample
12809 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12810 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12811 @end smallexample
12812
12813 @noindent
12814 These commands remove the debugging
12815 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12816 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12817 two files:
12818
12819 @itemize @bullet
12820 @item
12821 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12822 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12823
12824 @smallexample
12825 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12829 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12830 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12831 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12832
12833 @item
12834 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12835 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12836 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12837 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12838 @end itemize
12839
12840 @noindent
12841
12842 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12843 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12844 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12845 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12846
12847 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12848 @smallexample
12849 unsigned long
12850 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12851 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12852 @{
12853 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12854 @{
12855 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12856 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12857 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12858 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12859 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12860 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12861 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12862 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12863 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12864 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12865 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12866 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12867 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12868 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12869 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12870 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12871 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12872 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12873 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12874 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12875 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12876 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12877 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12878 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12879 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12880 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12881 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12882 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12883 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12884 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12885 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12886 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12887 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12888 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12889 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12890 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12891 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12892 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12893 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12894 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12895 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12896 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12897 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12898 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12899 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12900 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12901 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12902 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12903 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12904 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12905 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12906 0x2d02ef8d
12907 @};
12908 unsigned char *end;
12909
12910 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12911 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12912 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12913 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12914 @}
12915 @end smallexample
12916
12917 @noindent
12918 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12919
12920
12921 @node Symbol Errors
12922 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12923
12924 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12925 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12926 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12927 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12928 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12929 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12930 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12931 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12932 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12933 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12934 Messages}).
12935
12936 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12937
12938 @table @code
12939 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12940
12941 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12942 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12943 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12944 in its outer scope blocks.
12945
12946 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12947 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12948 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12949 function.
12950
12951 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12952
12953 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12954 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12955 do so.
12956
12957 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12958 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12959 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12960 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12961 Messages}.)
12962
12963 @item bad block start address patched
12964
12965 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12966 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12967 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12968
12969 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12970 starting on the previous source line.
12971
12972 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12973
12974 @cindex foo
12975 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12976 larger than the size of the string table.
12977
12978 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12979 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12980 with this name.
12981
12982 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12983
12984 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12985 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12986 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12987
12988 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12989 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12990 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12991 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12992 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12993 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12994
12995 @item stub type has NULL name
12996
12997 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12998
12999 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13000 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13001 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13002 it.
13003
13004 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13005
13006 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13007
13008 @end table
13009
13010 @node Targets
13011 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13012
13013 @cindex debugging target
13014 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13015
13016 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13017 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13018 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13019 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13020 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13021 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13022 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13023 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13024
13025 @cindex target architecture
13026 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13027 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13028 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13029 command.
13030
13031 @table @code
13032 @kindex set architecture
13033 @kindex show architecture
13034 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13035 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13036 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13037 supported architectures.
13038
13039 @item show architecture
13040 Show the current target architecture.
13041
13042 @item set processor
13043 @itemx processor
13044 @kindex set processor
13045 @kindex show processor
13046 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13047 and @code{show architecture}.
13048 @end table
13049
13050 @menu
13051 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13052 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13053 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13054 @end menu
13055
13056 @node Active Targets
13057 @section Active Targets
13058
13059 @cindex stacking targets
13060 @cindex active targets
13061 @cindex multiple targets
13062
13063 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13064 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13065 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13066 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13067 a core file.
13068
13069 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13070 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13071 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13072 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13073 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13074 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13075 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13076 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13077 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13078
13079 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13080 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13081 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13082 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13083 process target is active.
13084
13085 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13086 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13087 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13088 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13089 Process}).
13090
13091 @node Target Commands
13092 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13093
13094 @table @code
13095 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13096 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13097 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13098 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13099 protocol of the target machine.
13100
13101 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13102 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13103 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13104
13105 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13106 after executing the command.
13107
13108 @kindex help target
13109 @item help target
13110 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13111 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13112 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13113
13114 @item help target @var{name}
13115 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13116 select it.
13117
13118 @kindex set gnutarget
13119 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13120 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13121 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13122 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13123 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13124 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13125
13126 @quotation
13127 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13128 you must know the actual BFD name.
13129 @end quotation
13130
13131 @noindent
13132 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13133
13134 @kindex show gnutarget
13135 @item show gnutarget
13136 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13137 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13138 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13139 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13140 @end table
13141
13142 @cindex common targets
13143 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13144 configuration):
13145
13146 @table @code
13147 @kindex target
13148 @item target exec @var{program}
13149 @cindex executable file target
13150 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13151 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13152
13153 @item target core @var{filename}
13154 @cindex core dump file target
13155 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13156 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13157
13158 @item target remote @var{medium}
13159 @cindex remote target
13160 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13161 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13162 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13163
13164 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13165 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13166
13167 @smallexample
13168 target remote /dev/ttya
13169 @end smallexample
13170
13171 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13172 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13173 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13174 clobbered by the download.
13175
13176 @item target sim
13177 @cindex built-in simulator target
13178 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13179 In general,
13180 @smallexample
13181 target sim
13182 load
13183 run
13184 @end smallexample
13185 @noindent
13186 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13187 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13188 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13189 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13190 Processors}.
13191
13192 @end table
13193
13194 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13195
13196 @table @code
13197
13198 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13199 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13200 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13201
13202 @end table
13203
13204 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13205 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13206
13207 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13208 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13209 various aspects of this process.
13210
13211 @table @code
13212
13213 @item set hash
13214 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13215 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13216 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13217 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13218 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13219 monitor.
13220
13221 @item show hash
13222 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13223 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13224
13225 @item set debug monitor
13226 @kindex set debug monitor
13227 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13228 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13229 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13230
13231 @item show debug monitor
13232 @kindex show debug monitor
13233 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13234 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13235 @end table
13236
13237 @table @code
13238
13239 @kindex load @var{filename}
13240 @item load @var{filename}
13241 @anchor{load}
13242 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13243 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13244 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13245 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13246 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13247 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13248
13249 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13250 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13251 target is @dots{}}''
13252
13253 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13254 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13255 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13256 specifies a fixed address.
13257 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13258
13259 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13260 load programs into flash memory.
13261
13262 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13263 @end table
13264
13265 @node Byte Order
13266 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13267
13268 @cindex choosing target byte order
13269 @cindex target byte order
13270
13271 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13272 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13273 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13274 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13275 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13276 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13277
13278 @table @code
13279 @kindex set endian
13280 @item set endian big
13281 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13282
13283 @item set endian little
13284 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13285
13286 @item set endian auto
13287 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13288 executable.
13289
13290 @item show endian
13291 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13292
13293 @end table
13294
13295 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13296 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13297 target system.
13298
13299
13300 @node Remote Debugging
13301 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13302 @cindex remote debugging
13303
13304 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13305 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13306 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13307 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13308 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13309
13310 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13311 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13312 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13313 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13314 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13315 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13316
13317 Other remote targets may be available in your
13318 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13319
13320 @menu
13321 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13322 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13323 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13324 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13325 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13326 @end menu
13327
13328 @node Connecting
13329 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13330
13331 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13332 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13333 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13334 program as the first argument.
13335
13336 @cindex @code{target remote}
13337 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13338 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13339 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13340 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13341 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13342 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13343
13344 @table @code
13345
13346 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13347 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13348 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13349 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13350
13351 @smallexample
13352 target remote /dev/ttyb
13353 @end smallexample
13354
13355 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13356 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13357 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13358 @code{target} command.
13359
13360 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13361 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13362 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13363 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13364 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13365 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13366 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13367 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13368 target.
13369
13370 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13371 @code{manyfarms}:
13372
13373 @smallexample
13374 target remote manyfarms:2828
13375 @end smallexample
13376
13377 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13378 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13379 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13380 port 1234 on your local machine:
13381
13382 @smallexample
13383 target remote :1234
13384 @end smallexample
13385 @noindent
13386
13387 Note that the colon is still required here.
13388
13389 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13390 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13391 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13392 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13393
13394 @smallexample
13395 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13396 @end smallexample
13397
13398 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13399 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13400 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13401 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13402
13403 @item target remote | @var{command}
13404 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13405 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13406 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13407 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13408 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13409 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13410 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13411 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13412
13413 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13414 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13415 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13416
13417 @end table
13418
13419 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13420 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13421 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13422 need to use @kbd{run}.
13423
13424 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13425 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13426 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13427 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13428 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13429 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13430 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13431
13432 @smallexample
13433 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13434 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13435 @end smallexample
13436
13437 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13438 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13439 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13440 goes back to waiting.
13441
13442 @table @code
13443 @kindex detach (remote)
13444 @item detach
13445 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13446 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13447 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13448 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13449 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13450
13451 @kindex disconnect
13452 @item disconnect
13453 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13454 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13455 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13456 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13457 another target.
13458
13459 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13460 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13461 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13462 @kindex monitor
13463 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13464 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13465 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13466 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13467 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13468 and implement.
13469 @end table
13470
13471 @node File Transfer
13472 @section Sending files to a remote system
13473 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13474 @cindex file transfer
13475 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13476
13477 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13478 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13479 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13480 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13481 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13482 the only way to upload or download files.
13483
13484 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13485
13486 @table @code
13487 @kindex remote put
13488 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13489 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13490 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13491
13492 @kindex remote get
13493 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13494 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13495 on the host system.
13496
13497 @kindex remote delete
13498 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13499 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13500
13501 @end table
13502
13503 @node Server
13504 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13505
13506 @kindex gdbserver
13507 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13508 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13509 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13510 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13511
13512 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13513 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13514 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13515 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13516 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13517 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13518 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13519 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13520 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13521 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13522 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13523 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13524 choice for debugging.
13525
13526 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13527 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13528 protocol.
13529
13530 @quotation
13531 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13532 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13533 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13534 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13535 @code{gdbserver}.
13536 @end quotation
13537
13538 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13539 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13540
13541 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13542 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13543 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13544 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13545 system does all the symbol handling.
13546
13547 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13548 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13549 syntax is:
13550
13551 @smallexample
13552 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13553 @end smallexample
13554
13555 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13556 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13557 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13558 @file{/dev/com1}:
13559
13560 @smallexample
13561 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13562 @end smallexample
13563
13564 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13565 with it.
13566
13567 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13568
13569 @smallexample
13570 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13571 @end smallexample
13572
13573 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13574 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13575 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13576 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13577 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13578 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13579 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13580 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13581 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13582 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13583 @code{target remote} command.
13584
13585 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13586
13587 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13588 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13589
13590 @smallexample
13591 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13592 @end smallexample
13593
13594 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13595 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13596
13597 @pindex pidof
13598 @cindex attach to a program by name
13599 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13600 @code{pidof} utility:
13601
13602 @smallexample
13603 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13604 @end smallexample
13605
13606 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13607 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13608 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13609
13610 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13611 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13612 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13613
13614 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13615 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13616 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13617 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13618
13619 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13620 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13621 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13622 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13623 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13624 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13625 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13626 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13627 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13628
13629 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13630 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13631 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13632 the program you want to debug.
13633
13634 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13635 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13636 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13637
13638 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13639
13640 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13641 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13642 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13643 for bug reports to the developers.
13644
13645 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13646 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13647 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13648 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13649
13650 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13651 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13652 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13653 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13654
13655 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13656 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13657 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13658 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13659
13660 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13661 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13662 environment:
13663
13664 @smallexample
13665 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13666 @end smallexample
13667
13668 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13669
13670 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13671
13672 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13673 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13674 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13675 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13676
13677 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13678 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13679 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13680 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13681 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13682 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13683 programs.
13684
13685 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13686 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13687 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13688 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13689 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13690 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13691 already on the target.
13692
13693 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13694 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13695 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13696
13697 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13698 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13699 Here are the available commands.
13700
13701 @table @code
13702 @item monitor help
13703 List the available monitor commands.
13704
13705 @item monitor set debug 0
13706 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13707 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13708
13709 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13710 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13711 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13712 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13713
13714 @item monitor exit
13715 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13716 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13717 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13718 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13719 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13720
13721 @end table
13722
13723 @node Remote Configuration
13724 @section Remote Configuration
13725
13726 @kindex set remote
13727 @kindex show remote
13728 This section documents the configuration options available when
13729 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13730 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13731 system-call-allowed}.
13732
13733 @table @code
13734 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13735 @cindex address size for remote targets
13736 @cindex bits in remote address
13737 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13738 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13739 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13740 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13741
13742 @item show remoteaddresssize
13743 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13744
13745 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13746 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13747 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13748 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13749 remote targets.
13750
13751 @item show remotebaud
13752 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13753
13754 @item set remotebreak
13755 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13756 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13757 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13758 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13759 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13760 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13761 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13762 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13763
13764 @item show remotebreak
13765 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13766 interrupt the remote program.
13767
13768 @item set remoteflow on
13769 @itemx set remoteflow off
13770 @kindex set remoteflow
13771 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13772 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13773
13774 @item show remoteflow
13775 @kindex show remoteflow
13776 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13777
13778 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13779 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13780 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13781 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13782 @code{ascii}.
13783
13784 @item show remotelogbase
13785 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13786 protocol.
13787
13788 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13789 @cindex record serial communications on file
13790 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13791 default is not to record at all.
13792
13793 @item show remotelogfile.
13794 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13795 serial communications.
13796
13797 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13798 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13799 @cindex remote timeout
13800 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13801 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13802
13803 @item show remotetimeout
13804 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13805 responses.
13806
13807 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13808 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13809 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13810 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13811 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13812 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13813 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13814 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13815
13816 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13817 @itemx show remote exec-file
13818 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13819 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13820 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13821 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13822 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13823 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13824 @end table
13825
13826 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13827 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13828 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13829 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13830 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13831 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13832 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13833 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13834 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13835
13836 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13837 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13838 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13839 @value{GDBN} developers.
13840
13841 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13842 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13843 are:
13844
13845 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13846 @item Command Name
13847 @tab Remote Packet
13848 @tab Related Features
13849
13850 @item @code{fetch-register}
13851 @tab @code{p}
13852 @tab @code{info registers}
13853
13854 @item @code{set-register}
13855 @tab @code{P}
13856 @tab @code{set}
13857
13858 @item @code{binary-download}
13859 @tab @code{X}
13860 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13861
13862 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13863 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13864 @tab @code{info auxv}
13865
13866 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13867 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13868 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13869
13870 @item @code{attach}
13871 @tab @code{vAttach}
13872 @tab @code{attach}
13873
13874 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13875 @tab @code{vCont}
13876 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13877
13878 @item @code{run}
13879 @tab @code{vRun}
13880 @tab @code{run}
13881
13882 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13883 @tab @code{Z0}
13884 @tab @code{break}
13885
13886 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13887 @tab @code{Z1}
13888 @tab @code{hbreak}
13889
13890 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13891 @tab @code{Z2}
13892 @tab @code{watch}
13893
13894 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13895 @tab @code{Z3}
13896 @tab @code{rwatch}
13897
13898 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13899 @tab @code{Z4}
13900 @tab @code{awatch}
13901
13902 @item @code{target-features}
13903 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13904 @tab @code{set architecture}
13905
13906 @item @code{library-info}
13907 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13908 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13909
13910 @item @code{memory-map}
13911 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13912 @tab @code{info mem}
13913
13914 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13915 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13916 @tab @code{info spu}
13917
13918 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13919 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13920 @tab @code{info spu}
13921
13922 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13923 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13924 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13925
13926 @item @code{search-memory}
13927 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
13928 @tab @code{find}
13929
13930 @item @code{supported-packets}
13931 @tab @code{qSupported}
13932 @tab Remote communications parameters
13933
13934 @item @code{pass-signals}
13935 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13936 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13937
13938 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13939 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13940 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13941
13942 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13943 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13944 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13945
13946 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13947 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13948 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13949
13950 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13951 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13952 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13953
13954 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13955 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13956 @tab @code{remote delete}
13957
13958 @item @code{noack-packet}
13959 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
13960 @tab Packet acknowledgment
13961 @end multitable
13962
13963 @node Remote Stub
13964 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13965
13966 @cindex debugging stub, example
13967 @cindex remote stub, example
13968 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13969 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13970 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13971 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13972 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13973 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13974 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13975 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13976
13977 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13978 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13979 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13980 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13981 program, you need:
13982
13983 @enumerate
13984 @item
13985 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13986 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13987 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13988
13989 @item
13990 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13991 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13992
13993 @item
13994 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13995 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13996 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13997 documentation.
13998 @end enumerate
13999
14000 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14001 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14002 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14003
14004 @table @emph
14005 @item On the host,
14006 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14007 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14008 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14009
14010 @item On the target,
14011 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14012 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14013 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14014
14015 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14016 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14017 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14018 @end table
14019
14020 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14021 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14022 @sc{sparc} boards.
14023
14024 @cindex remote serial stub list
14025 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14026
14027 @table @code
14028
14029 @item i386-stub.c
14030 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14031 @cindex Intel
14032 @cindex i386
14033 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14034
14035 @item m68k-stub.c
14036 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14037 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14038 @cindex m680x0
14039 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14040
14041 @item sh-stub.c
14042 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14043 @cindex Renesas
14044 @cindex SH
14045 For Renesas SH architectures.
14046
14047 @item sparc-stub.c
14048 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14049 @cindex Sparc
14050 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14051
14052 @item sparcl-stub.c
14053 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14054 @cindex Fujitsu
14055 @cindex SparcLite
14056 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14057
14058 @end table
14059
14060 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14061 recently added stubs.
14062
14063 @menu
14064 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14065 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14066 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14067 @end menu
14068
14069 @node Stub Contents
14070 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14071
14072 @cindex remote serial stub
14073 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14074 subroutines:
14075
14076 @table @code
14077 @item set_debug_traps
14078 @findex set_debug_traps
14079 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14080 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14081 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14082 beginning of your program.
14083
14084 @item handle_exception
14085 @findex handle_exception
14086 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14087 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14088 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14089 run when a trap is triggered.
14090
14091 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14092 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14093 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14094 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14095 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14096 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14097 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14098 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14099 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14100 machine.
14101
14102 @item breakpoint
14103 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14104 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14105 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14106 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14107 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14108 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14109 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14110 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14111 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14112 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14113 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14114
14115 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14116 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14117 start of your debugging session.
14118 @end table
14119
14120 @node Bootstrapping
14121 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14122
14123 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14124 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14125 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14126 debugging target machine.
14127
14128 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14129 serial port.
14130
14131 @table @code
14132 @item int getDebugChar()
14133 @findex getDebugChar
14134 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14135 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14136 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14137
14138 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14139 @findex putDebugChar
14140 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14141 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14142 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14143 @end table
14144
14145 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14146 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14147 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14148 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14149 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14150 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14151 remote system to stop.
14152
14153 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14154 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14155 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14156 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14157
14158 Other routines you need to supply are:
14159
14160 @table @code
14161 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14162 @findex exceptionHandler
14163 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14164 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14165 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14166 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14167 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14168 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14169 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14170 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14171 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14172 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14173 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14174 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14175 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14176
14177 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14178 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14179 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14180 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14181 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14182
14183 @item void flush_i_cache()
14184 @findex flush_i_cache
14185 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14186 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14187 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14188
14189 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14190 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14191 @end table
14192
14193 @noindent
14194 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14195
14196 @table @code
14197 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14198 @findex memset
14199 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14200 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14201 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14202 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14203 @end table
14204
14205 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14206 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14207 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14208 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14209
14210
14211 @node Debug Session
14212 @subsection Putting it All Together
14213
14214 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14215 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14216 steps.
14217
14218 @enumerate
14219 @item
14220 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14221 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14222 @display
14223 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14224 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14225 @end display
14226
14227 @item
14228 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14229
14230 @smallexample
14231 set_debug_traps();
14232 breakpoint();
14233 @end smallexample
14234
14235 @item
14236 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14237 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14238
14239 @smallexample
14240 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14241 @end smallexample
14242
14243 @noindent
14244 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14245 function in your program, that function is called when
14246 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14247 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14248 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14249
14250 @item
14251 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14252 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14253
14254 @item
14255 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14256 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14257
14258 @item
14259 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14260 @c document that. FIXME.
14261 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14262 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14263
14264 @item
14265 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14266 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14267
14268 @end enumerate
14269
14270 @node Configurations
14271 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14272
14273 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14274 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14275 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14276
14277 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14278 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14279 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14280 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14281 are quite different from each other.
14282
14283 @menu
14284 * Native::
14285 * Embedded OS::
14286 * Embedded Processors::
14287 * Architectures::
14288 @end menu
14289
14290 @node Native
14291 @section Native
14292
14293 This section describes details specific to particular native
14294 configurations.
14295
14296 @menu
14297 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14298 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14299 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14300 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14301 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14302 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14303 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14304 @end menu
14305
14306 @node HP-UX
14307 @subsection HP-UX
14308
14309 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14310 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14311 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14312
14313
14314 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14315 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14316
14317 @cindex libkvm
14318 @cindex kernel memory image
14319 @cindex kernel crash dump
14320
14321 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14322 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14323 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14324 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14325 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14326 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14327 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14328 @code{kvm} target:
14329
14330 @smallexample
14331 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14332 @end smallexample
14333
14334 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14335 argument:
14336
14337 @smallexample
14338 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14339 @end smallexample
14340
14341 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14342 available:
14343
14344 @table @code
14345 @kindex kvm
14346 @item kvm pcb
14347 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14348
14349 @item kvm proc
14350 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14351 modern FreeBSD systems.
14352 @end table
14353
14354 @node SVR4 Process Information
14355 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14356 @cindex /proc
14357 @cindex examine process image
14358 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14359
14360 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14361 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14362 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14363 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14364 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14365 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14366 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14367 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14368 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14369
14370 @table @code
14371 @kindex info proc
14372 @cindex process ID
14373 @item info proc
14374 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14375 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14376 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14377 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14378 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14379 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14380 executable file's absolute file name.
14381
14382 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14383 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14384 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14385 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14386 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14387 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14388
14389 @item info proc mappings
14390 @cindex memory address space mappings
14391 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14392 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14393 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14394 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14395 memory access rights to that range.
14396
14397 @item info proc stat
14398 @itemx info proc status
14399 @cindex process detailed status information
14400 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14401 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14402 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14403 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14404 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14405 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14406 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14407
14408 @item info proc all
14409 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14410 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14411
14412 @ignore
14413 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14414 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14415 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14416 @kindex info proc times
14417 @item info proc times
14418 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14419 its children.
14420
14421 @kindex info proc id
14422 @item info proc id
14423 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14424 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14425 @end ignore
14426
14427 @item set procfs-trace
14428 @kindex set procfs-trace
14429 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14430 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14431
14432 @item show procfs-trace
14433 @kindex show procfs-trace
14434 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14435
14436 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14437 @kindex set procfs-file
14438 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14439 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14440 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14441 standard output.
14442
14443 @item show procfs-file
14444 @kindex show procfs-file
14445 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14446
14447 @item proc-trace-entry
14448 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14449 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14450 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14451 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14452 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14453 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14454 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14455 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14456 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14457
14458 @item info pidlist
14459 @kindex info pidlist
14460 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14461 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14462 processes and all the threads within each process.
14463
14464 @item info meminfo
14465 @kindex info meminfo
14466 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14467 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14468 @end table
14469
14470 @node DJGPP Native
14471 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14472 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14473 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14474 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14475
14476 @cindex DPMI
14477 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14478 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14479 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14480 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14481
14482 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14483 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14484 subsection describes those commands.
14485
14486 @table @code
14487 @kindex info dos
14488 @item info dos
14489 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14490 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14491
14492 @kindex sysinfo
14493 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14494 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14495 @item info dos sysinfo
14496 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14497 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14498 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14499
14500 @cindex GDT
14501 @cindex LDT
14502 @cindex IDT
14503 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14504 @cindex descriptor tables display
14505 @item info dos gdt
14506 @itemx info dos ldt
14507 @itemx info dos idt
14508 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14509 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14510 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14511 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14512 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14513 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14514 rights.
14515
14516 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14517 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14518 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14519 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14520 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14521
14522 @cindex garbled pointers
14523 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14524 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14525 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14526 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14527 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14528 debugged program's data segment:
14529
14530 @smallexample
14531 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14532 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14533 @end smallexample
14534
14535 @noindent
14536 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14537 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14538
14539 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14540 @item info dos pde
14541 @itemx info dos pte
14542 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14543 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14544 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14545 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14546 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14547 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14548 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14549 that is currently in use.
14550
14551 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14552 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14553 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14554 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14555 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14556 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14557 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14558
14559 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14560 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14561 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14562 controller.
14563
14564 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14565
14566 @cindex physical address from linear address
14567 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14568 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14569 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14570 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14571 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14572 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14573 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14574
14575 @smallexample
14576 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14577 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14578 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14579 @end smallexample
14580
14581 @noindent
14582 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14583 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14584 attributes of that page.
14585
14586 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14587 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14588 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14589 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14590 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14591 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14592
14593 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14594 transfer buffer:
14595
14596 @smallexample
14597 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14598 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14599 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14600 @end smallexample
14601
14602 @noindent
14603 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14604 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14605 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14606 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14607 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14608
14609 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14610 @end table
14611
14612 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14613 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14614 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14615 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14616
14617 @table @code
14618 @kindex set com1base
14619 @kindex set com1irq
14620 @kindex set com2base
14621 @kindex set com2irq
14622 @kindex set com3base
14623 @kindex set com3irq
14624 @kindex set com4base
14625 @kindex set com4irq
14626 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14627 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14628 port.
14629
14630 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14631 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14632 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14633
14634 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14635 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14636 other 3 COM ports.
14637
14638 @kindex show com1base
14639 @kindex show com1irq
14640 @kindex show com2base
14641 @kindex show com2irq
14642 @kindex show com3base
14643 @kindex show com3irq
14644 @kindex show com4base
14645 @kindex show com4irq
14646 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14647 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14648 lines used by the COM ports.
14649
14650 @item info serial
14651 @kindex info serial
14652 @cindex DOS serial port status
14653 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14654 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14655 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14656 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14657 @end table
14658
14659
14660 @node Cygwin Native
14661 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14662 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14663 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14664 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14665
14666 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14667 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14668 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14669 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14670 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14671
14672 @table @code
14673 @kindex info w32
14674 @item info w32
14675 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14676 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14677
14678 @item info w32 selector
14679 This command displays information returned by
14680 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14681 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14682 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14683 Without argument, this command displays information
14684 about the six segment registers.
14685
14686 @kindex info dll
14687 @item info dll
14688 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14689
14690 @kindex dll-symbols
14691 @item dll-symbols
14692 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14693 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14694
14695 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14696 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14697 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14698 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14699 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14700 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14701 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14702 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14703 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14704 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14705 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14706
14707 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14708 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14709 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14710 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14711
14712 @kindex set new-console
14713 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14714 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14715 be started in a new console on next start.
14716 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14717 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14718
14719 @kindex show new-console
14720 @item show new-console
14721 Displays whether a new console is used
14722 when the debuggee is started.
14723
14724 @kindex set new-group
14725 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14726 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14727 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14728 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14729 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14730
14731 @kindex show new-group
14732 @item show new-group
14733 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14734
14735 @kindex set debugevents
14736 @item set debugevents
14737 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14738 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14739 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14740 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14741 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14742
14743 @kindex set debugexec
14744 @item set debugexec
14745 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14746 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14747
14748 @kindex set debugexceptions
14749 @item set debugexceptions
14750 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14751 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14752
14753 @kindex set debugmemory
14754 @item set debugmemory
14755 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14756 and writes by the debugger.
14757
14758 @kindex set shell
14759 @item set shell
14760 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14761 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14762
14763 @kindex show shell
14764 @item show shell
14765 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14766
14767 @end table
14768
14769 @menu
14770 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14771 @end menu
14772
14773 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14774 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14775 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14776 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14777
14778 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14779 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14780 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14781 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14782 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14783 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14784 ``minimal symbols''.
14785
14786 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14787 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14788 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14789 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14790 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14791 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14792 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14793 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14794 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14795 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14796
14797 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14798
14799 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14800 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14801 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14802 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14803 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14804 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14805 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14806 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14807 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14808
14809 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14810 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14811 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14812 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14813 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14814 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14815
14816 @smallexample
14817 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14818 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14819
14820 Non-debugging symbols:
14821 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14822 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14823 @end smallexample
14824
14825 @smallexample
14826 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14827 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14828
14829 Non-debugging symbols:
14830 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14831 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14832 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14833 [etc...]
14834 @end smallexample
14835
14836 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14837
14838 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14839 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14840 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14841 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14842 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14843 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14844 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14845
14846 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14847 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14848 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14849 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14850 problem:
14851
14852 @smallexample
14853 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14854 $1 = 268572168
14855 @end smallexample
14856
14857 @smallexample
14858 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14859 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14860 @end smallexample
14861
14862 And two possible solutions:
14863
14864 @smallexample
14865 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14866 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14867 @end smallexample
14868
14869 @smallexample
14870 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14871 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14872 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14873 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14874 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14875 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14876 @end smallexample
14877
14878 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14879 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14880 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14881 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14882 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14883
14884 @smallexample
14885 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14886 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14887 @end smallexample
14888
14889 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14890 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14891 safe.
14892
14893 @node Hurd Native
14894 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14895 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14896
14897 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14898 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14899
14900 @table @code
14901 @item set signals
14902 @itemx set sigs
14903 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14904 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14905 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14906 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14907 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14908 @code{signals}.
14909
14910 @item show signals
14911 @itemx show sigs
14912 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14913 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14914 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14915
14916 @item set signal-thread
14917 @itemx set sigthread
14918 @kindex set signal-thread
14919 @kindex set sigthread
14920 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14921 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14922 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14923 signal-thread}.
14924
14925 @item show signal-thread
14926 @itemx show sigthread
14927 @kindex show signal-thread
14928 @kindex show sigthread
14929 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14930 delivered a signal.
14931
14932 @item set stopped
14933 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14934 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14935 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14936 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14937
14938 @item show stopped
14939 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14940 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14941 stopped.
14942
14943 @item set exceptions
14944 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14945 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14946 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14947 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14948 trapping on.
14949
14950 @item show exceptions
14951 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14952 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14953
14954 @item set task pause
14955 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14956 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14957 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14958 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14959 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14960 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14961 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14962 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14963 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14964
14965 @item show task pause
14966 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14967 Show the current state of task suspension.
14968
14969 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14970 @cindex task suspend count
14971 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14972 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14973 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14974
14975 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14976 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14977
14978 @item set task exception-port
14979 @itemx set task excp
14980 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14981 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14982 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14983 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14984
14985 @item set noninvasive
14986 @cindex noninvasive task options
14987 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14988 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14989 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14990 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14991
14992 @item info send-rights
14993 @itemx info receive-rights
14994 @itemx info port-rights
14995 @itemx info port-sets
14996 @itemx info dead-names
14997 @itemx info ports
14998 @itemx info psets
14999 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15000 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15001 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15002 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15003 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15004 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15005 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15006 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15007 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15008
15009 @item set thread pause
15010 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15011 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15012 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15013 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15014 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15015 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15016 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15017 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15018 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15019 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15020 only the current thread.
15021
15022 @item show thread pause
15023 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15024 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15025
15026 @item set thread run
15027 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15028
15029 @item show thread run
15030 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15031
15032 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15033 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15034 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15035 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15036 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15037 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15038 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15039
15040 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15041 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15042 detaching.
15043
15044 @item set thread exception-port
15045 @itemx set thread excp
15046 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15047 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15048 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15049
15050 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15051 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15052 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15053 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15054
15055 @item set thread default
15056 @itemx show thread default
15057 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15058 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15059 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15060 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15061 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15062 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15063 the non-default commands.
15064 @end table
15065
15066
15067 @node Neutrino
15068 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15069 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15070
15071 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15072 Neutrino target:
15073
15074 @table @code
15075 @item set debug nto-debug
15076 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15077 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15078 Neutrino support.
15079
15080 @item show debug nto-debug
15081 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15082 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15083 @end table
15084
15085
15086 @node Embedded OS
15087 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15088
15089 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15090 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15091 architectures.
15092
15093 @menu
15094 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15095 @end menu
15096
15097 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15098 various real-time operating systems.
15099
15100 @node VxWorks
15101 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15102
15103 @cindex VxWorks
15104
15105 @table @code
15106
15107 @kindex target vxworks
15108 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15109 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15110 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15111
15112 @end table
15113
15114 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15115 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15116
15117 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15118 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15119 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15120 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15121 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15122 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15123 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15124
15125 @table @code
15126 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15127 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15128 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15129 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15130 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15131 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15132 of a thin network line.
15133 @end table
15134
15135 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15136 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15137 procedures.
15138
15139 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15140 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15141 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15142 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15143 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15144 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15145 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15146 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15147 manual.
15148 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15149
15150 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15151 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15152 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15153 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15154
15155 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15156
15157 @smallexample
15158 (vxgdb)
15159 @end smallexample
15160
15161 @menu
15162 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15163 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15164 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15165 @end menu
15166
15167 @node VxWorks Connection
15168 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15169
15170 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15171 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15172
15173 @smallexample
15174 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15175 @end smallexample
15176
15177 @need 750
15178 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15179
15180 @smallexample
15181 Attaching remote machine across net...
15182 Connected to tt.
15183 @end smallexample
15184
15185 @need 1000
15186 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15187 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15188 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15189 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15190 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15191
15192 @smallexample
15193 prog.o: No such file or directory.
15194 @end smallexample
15195
15196 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15197 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15198 command again.
15199
15200 @node VxWorks Download
15201 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
15202
15203 @cindex download to VxWorks
15204 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15205 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15206 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15207 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15208 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15209 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15210 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15211 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15212 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15213 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15214 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15215 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15216 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15217 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15218 program, type this on VxWorks:
15219
15220 @smallexample
15221 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15222 @end smallexample
15223
15224 @noindent
15225 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15226
15227 @smallexample
15228 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15229 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15230 @end smallexample
15231
15232 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15233
15234 @smallexample
15235 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15236 @end smallexample
15237
15238 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15239 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15240 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15241 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15242 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15243 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15244 table.)
15245
15246 @node VxWorks Attach
15247 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15248
15249 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15250 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15251 follows:
15252
15253 @smallexample
15254 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15255 @end smallexample
15256
15257 @noindent
15258 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15259 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15260 the time of attachment.
15261
15262 @node Embedded Processors
15263 @section Embedded Processors
15264
15265 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15266 configurations.
15267
15268 @cindex send command to simulator
15269 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15270 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15271
15272 @table @code
15273 @item sim @var{command}
15274 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15275 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15276 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15277 acceptable commands.
15278 @end table
15279
15280
15281 @menu
15282 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15283 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15284 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15285 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15286 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15287 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15288 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15289 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15290 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15291 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15292 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15293 * CRIS:: CRIS
15294 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15295 @end menu
15296
15297 @node ARM
15298 @subsection ARM
15299 @cindex ARM RDI
15300
15301 @table @code
15302 @kindex target rdi
15303 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15304 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15305 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15306 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15307
15308 @kindex target rdp
15309 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15310 ARM Demon monitor.
15311
15312 @end table
15313
15314 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15315
15316 @table @code
15317 @item set arm disassembler
15318 @kindex set arm
15319 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15320 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15321
15322 @item show arm disassembler
15323 @kindex show arm
15324 Show the current disassembly style.
15325
15326 @item set arm apcs32
15327 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15328 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15329
15330 @item show arm apcs32
15331 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15332
15333 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15334 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15335 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15336
15337 @table @code
15338 @item auto
15339 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15340 @item softfpa
15341 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15342 processors.
15343 @item fpa
15344 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15345 @item softvfp
15346 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15347 @item vfp
15348 VFP co-processor.
15349 @end table
15350
15351 @item show arm fpu
15352 Show the current type of the FPU.
15353
15354 @item set arm abi
15355 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15356
15357 @item show arm abi
15358 Show the currently used ABI.
15359
15360 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15361 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15362 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15363 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15364 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15365 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15366 register).
15367
15368 @item show arm fallback-mode
15369 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15370
15371 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15372 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15373 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15374 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15375 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15376
15377 @item show arm force-mode
15378 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15379
15380 @item set debug arm
15381 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15382 target support subsystem.
15383
15384 @item show debug arm
15385 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15386 @end table
15387
15388 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15389 using the RDI interface:
15390
15391 @table @code
15392 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15393 @kindex rdilogfile
15394 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15395 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15396 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15397 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15398 @file{rdi.log}.
15399
15400 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15401 @kindex rdilogenable
15402 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15403 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15404 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15405 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15406 are logged to a file.
15407
15408 @item set rdiromatzero
15409 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15410 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15411 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15412 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15413 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15414 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15415
15416 @item show rdiromatzero
15417 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15418 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15419
15420 @item set rdiheartbeat
15421 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15422 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15423 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15424 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15425 well as the Angel monitor.
15426
15427 @item show rdiheartbeat
15428 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
15429 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15430 @end table
15431
15432
15433 @node M32R/D
15434 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15435
15436 @table @code
15437 @kindex target m32r
15438 @item target m32r @var{dev}
15439 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15440
15441 @kindex target m32rsdi
15442 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15443 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15444 @end table
15445
15446 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15447
15448 @table @code
15449 @item set download-path @var{path}
15450 @kindex set download-path
15451 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15452 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15453
15454 @item show download-path
15455 @kindex show download-path
15456 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15457
15458 @item set board-address @var{addr}
15459 @kindex set board-address
15460 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
15461 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15462
15463 @item show board-address
15464 @kindex show board-address
15465 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15466
15467 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15468 @kindex set server-address
15469 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15470 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15471 host machine.
15472
15473 @item show server-address
15474 @kindex show server-address
15475 Display the IP address of the download server.
15476
15477 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15478 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15479 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15480 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15481 executable file is uploaded.
15482
15483 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15484 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15485 Test the @code{upload} command.
15486 @end table
15487
15488 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15489
15490 @table @code
15491 @item sdireset
15492 @kindex sdireset
15493 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15494 This command resets the SDI connection.
15495
15496 @item sdistatus
15497 @kindex sdistatus
15498 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15499
15500 @item debug_chaos
15501 @kindex debug_chaos
15502 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15503 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15504
15505 @item use_debug_dma
15506 @kindex use_debug_dma
15507 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15508
15509 @item use_mon_code
15510 @kindex use_mon_code
15511 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15512
15513 @item use_ib_break
15514 @kindex use_ib_break
15515 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15516
15517 @item use_dbt_break
15518 @kindex use_dbt_break
15519 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15520 @end table
15521
15522 @node M68K
15523 @subsection M68k
15524
15525 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15526 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15527
15528 @table @code
15529
15530 @kindex target dbug
15531 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15532 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15533
15534 @end table
15535
15536 @node MIPS Embedded
15537 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15538
15539 @cindex MIPS boards
15540 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15541 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15542 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15543
15544 @need 1000
15545 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15546
15547 @table @code
15548 @item target mips @var{port}
15549 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15550 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15551 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15552 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15553 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15554 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15555 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15556
15557 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15558 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15559 debugger:
15560
15561 @smallexample
15562 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15563 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15564 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15565 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15566 (@value{GDBP}) run
15567 @end smallexample
15568
15569 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15570 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15571 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15572 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15573 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15574
15575 @item target pmon @var{port}
15576 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15577 PMON ROM monitor.
15578
15579 @item target ddb @var{port}
15580 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15581 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15582
15583 @item target lsi @var{port}
15584 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15585 LSI variant of PMON.
15586
15587 @kindex target r3900
15588 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15589 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15590
15591 @kindex target array
15592 @item target array @var{dev}
15593 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15594
15595 @end table
15596
15597
15598 @noindent
15599 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15600
15601 @table @code
15602 @item set mipsfpu double
15603 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15604 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15605 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15606 @itemx show mipsfpu
15607 @kindex set mipsfpu
15608 @kindex show mipsfpu
15609 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15610 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15611 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15612 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15613 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15614 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15615 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15616 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15617 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15618 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15619 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15620 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15621 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15622
15623 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15624 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15625 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15626
15627 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15628 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15629
15630 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15631 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15632 @itemx show timeout
15633 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15634 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15635 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15636 @kindex set timeout
15637 @kindex show timeout
15638 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15639 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15640 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15641 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15642 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15643 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
15644 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15645 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15646 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15647 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15648
15649 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15650 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15651 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15652 to run before stopping.
15653
15654 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15655 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15656 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15657 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15658 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15659 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15660
15661 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15662 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15663 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15664 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15665
15666 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15667 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15668 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15669 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15670 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15671 @table @asis
15672 @item pmon target
15673 @samp{PMON}
15674 @item ddb target
15675 @samp{NEC010}
15676 @item lsi target
15677 @samp{PMON>}
15678 @end table
15679
15680 @item show monitor-prompt
15681 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15682 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15683 remote monitor.
15684
15685 @item set monitor-warnings
15686 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15687 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15688 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15689 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15690 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15691
15692 @item show monitor-warnings
15693 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15694 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15695
15696 @item pmon @var{command}
15697 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15698 @cindex send PMON command
15699 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15700 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15701 @end table
15702
15703 @node OpenRISC 1000
15704 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15705 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15706
15707 @cindex or1k boards
15708 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15709 about platform and commands.
15710
15711 @table @code
15712
15713 @kindex target jtag
15714 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15715
15716 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15717 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15718 connected via parallel port to the board.
15719
15720 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15721
15722 @kindex or1ksim
15723 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15724 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15725 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15726
15727 @kindex info or1k spr
15728 @item info or1k spr
15729 Displays spr groups.
15730
15731 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15732 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15733 Displays register names in selected group.
15734
15735 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15736 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15737 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15738 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15739 Shows information about specified spr register.
15740
15741 @kindex spr
15742 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15743 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15744 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15745 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15746 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15747 @end table
15748
15749 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15750 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15751 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15752 triggers can be set using:
15753 @table @code
15754 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15755 Load effective address/data
15756 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15757 Store effective address/data
15758 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15759 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15760 @item $FETCH
15761 Fetch data
15762 @end table
15763
15764 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15765 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15766
15767 @code{htrace} commands:
15768 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15769 @table @code
15770 @kindex hwatch
15771 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15772 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15773 or Data. For example:
15774
15775 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15776
15777 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15778
15779 @kindex htrace
15780 @item htrace info
15781 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15782
15783 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15784 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15785
15786 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15787 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15788
15789 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15790 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15791
15792 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15793 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15794 triggered.
15795
15796 @item htrace enable
15797 @itemx htrace disable
15798 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15799
15800 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15801 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15802
15803 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15804 will be written there.
15805
15806 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15807 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15808
15809 @item htrace mode continuous
15810 Set continuous trace mode.
15811
15812 @item htrace mode suspend
15813 Set suspend trace mode.
15814
15815 @end table
15816
15817 @node PowerPC Embedded
15818 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15819
15820 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15821
15822 @table @code
15823 @kindex set powerpc
15824 @item set powerpc soft-float
15825 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15826 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15827 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15828 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15829
15830 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15831 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15832 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15833 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15834 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15835 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15836 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15837 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15838
15839 @kindex target dink32
15840 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15841 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15842
15843 @kindex target ppcbug
15844 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15845 @kindex target ppcbug1
15846 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15847 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15848
15849 @kindex target sds
15850 @item target sds @var{dev}
15851 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15852 @end table
15853
15854 @cindex SDS protocol
15855 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15856 by @value{GDBN}:
15857
15858 @table @code
15859 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15860 @kindex set sdstimeout
15861 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15862 default is 2 seconds.
15863
15864 @item show sdstimeout
15865 @kindex show sdstimeout
15866 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15867
15868 @item sds @var{command}
15869 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15870 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15871 @end table
15872
15873
15874 @node PA
15875 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15876
15877 @table @code
15878
15879 @kindex target op50n
15880 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15881 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15882
15883 @kindex target w89k
15884 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15885 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15886
15887 @end table
15888
15889 @node Sparclet
15890 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15891
15892 @cindex Sparclet
15893
15894 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15895 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15896 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15897 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15898 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15899
15900 @table @code
15901 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15902 @kindex remotetimeout
15903 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15904 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15905 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15906 @end table
15907
15908 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15909 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15910 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15911 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15912 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15913
15914 @smallexample
15915 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15916 @end smallexample
15917
15918 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15919
15920 @smallexample
15921 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15922 @end smallexample
15923
15924 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15925 Once you have set
15926 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15927 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15928 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15929
15930 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15931
15932 @smallexample
15933 (gdbslet)
15934 @end smallexample
15935
15936 @menu
15937 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15938 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15939 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15940 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15941 @end menu
15942
15943 @node Sparclet File
15944 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15945
15946 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15947
15948 @smallexample
15949 (gdbslet) file prog
15950 @end smallexample
15951
15952 @need 1000
15953 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15954 @value{GDBN} locates
15955 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15956 path.
15957 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15958 files will be searched as well.
15959 @value{GDBN} locates
15960 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15961 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15962 If it fails
15963 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15964
15965 @smallexample
15966 prog: No such file or directory.
15967 @end smallexample
15968
15969 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15970 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15971 @code{target} command again.
15972
15973 @node Sparclet Connection
15974 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15975
15976 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15977 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15978
15979 @smallexample
15980 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15981 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15982 main () at ../prog.c:3
15983 @end smallexample
15984
15985 @need 750
15986 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15987
15988 @smallexample
15989 Connected to ttya.
15990 @end smallexample
15991
15992 @node Sparclet Download
15993 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15994
15995 @cindex download to Sparclet
15996 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15997 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15998 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15999 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16000 command.
16001 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16002 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16003 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16004 of each of the file's sections.
16005 For instance, if the program
16006 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16007 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16008
16009 @smallexample
16010 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16011 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16012 @end smallexample
16013
16014 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16015 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16016 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16017
16018 @node Sparclet Execution
16019 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16020
16021 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16022 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16023 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16024 manual for the list of commands.
16025
16026 @smallexample
16027 (gdbslet) b main
16028 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16029 (gdbslet) run
16030 Starting program: prog
16031 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16032 3 char *symarg = 0;
16033 (gdbslet) step
16034 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16035 (gdbslet)
16036 @end smallexample
16037
16038 @node Sparclite
16039 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16040
16041 @table @code
16042
16043 @kindex target sparclite
16044 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16045 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16046 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16047 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16048 remote protocol.
16049
16050 @end table
16051
16052 @node Z8000
16053 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16054
16055 @cindex Z8000
16056 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16057 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16058
16059 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16060 a Z8000 simulator.
16061
16062 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16063 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16064 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16065 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16066
16067 @table @code
16068 @item target sim @var{args}
16069 @kindex sim
16070 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16071 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16072 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16073 @end table
16074
16075 @noindent
16076 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16077 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16078 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16079 to run your program, and so on.
16080
16081 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16082 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16083 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16084
16085 @table @code
16086
16087 @item cycles
16088 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16089
16090 @item insts
16091 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16092
16093 @item time
16094 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16095
16096 @end table
16097
16098 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16099 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16100 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16101 simulated clock ticks.
16102
16103 @node AVR
16104 @subsection Atmel AVR
16105 @cindex AVR
16106
16107 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16108 following AVR-specific commands:
16109
16110 @table @code
16111 @item info io_registers
16112 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16113 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16114 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16115 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16116 @end table
16117
16118 @node CRIS
16119 @subsection CRIS
16120 @cindex CRIS
16121
16122 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16123 following CRIS-specific commands:
16124
16125 @table @code
16126 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16127 @cindex CRIS version
16128 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16129 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16130 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16131
16132 @item show cris-version
16133 Show the current CRIS version.
16134
16135 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16136 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16137 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16138 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16139 @code{R59}.
16140
16141 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16142 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16143
16144 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16145 @cindex CRIS mode
16146 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16147 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16148 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16149
16150 @item show cris-mode
16151 Show the current CRIS mode.
16152 @end table
16153
16154 @node Super-H
16155 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16156 @cindex Super-H
16157
16158 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16159 commands:
16160
16161 @table @code
16162 @item regs
16163 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16164 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16165
16166 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16167 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16168 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16169 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16170 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16171 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16172 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16173 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16174 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16175 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16176 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16177 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16178
16179 @item show sh calling-convention
16180 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16181 Show the current calling convention setting.
16182
16183 @end table
16184
16185
16186 @node Architectures
16187 @section Architectures
16188
16189 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16190 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16191
16192 @menu
16193 * i386::
16194 * A29K::
16195 * Alpha::
16196 * MIPS::
16197 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16198 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16199 * PowerPC::
16200 @end menu
16201
16202 @node i386
16203 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16204
16205 @table @code
16206 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16207 @kindex set struct-convention
16208 @cindex struct return convention
16209 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
16210 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16211 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16212 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16213 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16214 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16215 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16216 be returned in a register.
16217
16218 @item show struct-convention
16219 @kindex show struct-convention
16220 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16221 from functions.
16222 @end table
16223
16224 @node A29K
16225 @subsection A29K
16226
16227 @table @code
16228
16229 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16230 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16231 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16232 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16233 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16234 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16235 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16236 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16237 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16238 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16239 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16240 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16241 hexadecimal.
16242
16243 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16244 @item show rstack_high_address
16245 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16246 processors.
16247
16248 @end table
16249
16250 @node Alpha
16251 @subsection Alpha
16252
16253 See the following section.
16254
16255 @node MIPS
16256 @subsection MIPS
16257
16258 @cindex stack on Alpha
16259 @cindex stack on MIPS
16260 @cindex Alpha stack
16261 @cindex MIPS stack
16262 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16263 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16264 find the beginning of a function.
16265
16266 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16267 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16268 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16269 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16270 commands:
16271
16272 @table @code
16273 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16274 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16275 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16276 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16277 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16278 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16279 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16280 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16281
16282 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16283 Display the current limit.
16284 @end table
16285
16286 @noindent
16287 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16288 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16289
16290 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16291 programs:
16292
16293 @table @code
16294 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16295 @kindex set mips abi
16296 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16297 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16298 values of @var{arg} are:
16299
16300 @table @samp
16301 @item auto
16302 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16303 default).
16304 @item o32
16305 @item o64
16306 @item n32
16307 @item n64
16308 @item eabi32
16309 @item eabi64
16310 @item auto
16311 @end table
16312
16313 @item show mips abi
16314 @kindex show mips abi
16315 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16316
16317 @item set mipsfpu
16318 @itemx show mipsfpu
16319 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16320
16321 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16322 @kindex set mips mask-address
16323 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16324 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16325 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16326 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16327 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16328
16329 @item show mips mask-address
16330 @kindex show mips mask-address
16331 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16332 not.
16333
16334 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16335 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16336 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16337 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16338 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16339 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16340
16341 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16342 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16343 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16344
16345 @item set debug mips
16346 @kindex set debug mips
16347 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16348 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16349
16350 @item show debug mips
16351 @kindex show debug mips
16352 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16353 @end table
16354
16355
16356 @node HPPA
16357 @subsection HPPA
16358 @cindex HPPA support
16359
16360 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16361 following special commands:
16362
16363 @table @code
16364 @item set debug hppa
16365 @kindex set debug hppa
16366 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16367 messages are to be displayed.
16368
16369 @item show debug hppa
16370 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16371
16372 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16373 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16374 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16375 given @var{address}.
16376
16377 @end table
16378
16379
16380 @node SPU
16381 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16382 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16383 @cindex SPU
16384
16385 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16386 it provides the following special commands:
16387
16388 @table @code
16389 @item info spu event
16390 @kindex info spu
16391 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16392 and pending event status.
16393
16394 @item info spu signal
16395 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16396 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16397 notification channels.
16398
16399 @item info spu mailbox
16400 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16401 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16402 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16403
16404 @item info spu dma
16405 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16406 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16407 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16408
16409 @item info spu proxydma
16410 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16411 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16412 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16413
16414 @end table
16415
16416 @node PowerPC
16417 @subsection PowerPC
16418 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16419
16420 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16421 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16422 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16423 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16424 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16425
16426 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16427 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16428 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16429
16430
16431 @node Controlling GDB
16432 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16433
16434 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16435 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16436 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16437 described here.
16438
16439 @menu
16440 * Prompt:: Prompt
16441 * Editing:: Command editing
16442 * Command History:: Command history
16443 * Screen Size:: Screen size
16444 * Numbers:: Numbers
16445 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16446 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16447 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16448 @end menu
16449
16450 @node Prompt
16451 @section Prompt
16452
16453 @cindex prompt
16454
16455 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16456 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16457 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16458 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16459 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16460 which one you are talking to.
16461
16462 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16463 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16464 or a prompt that does not.
16465
16466 @table @code
16467 @kindex set prompt
16468 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16469 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16470
16471 @kindex show prompt
16472 @item show prompt
16473 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16474 @end table
16475
16476 @node Editing
16477 @section Command Editing
16478 @cindex readline
16479 @cindex command line editing
16480
16481 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16482 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16483 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16484 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16485 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16486 debugging sessions.
16487
16488 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16489 command @code{set}.
16490
16491 @table @code
16492 @kindex set editing
16493 @cindex editing
16494 @item set editing
16495 @itemx set editing on
16496 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16497
16498 @item set editing off
16499 Disable command line editing.
16500
16501 @kindex show editing
16502 @item show editing
16503 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16504 @end table
16505
16506 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16507 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16508 encouraged to read that chapter.
16509
16510 @node Command History
16511 @section Command History
16512 @cindex command history
16513
16514 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16515 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16516 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16517 history facility.
16518
16519 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16520 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16521 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16522
16523 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16524 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16525 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16526 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16527 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16528 pressed on a line by itself.
16529
16530 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16531 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16532 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16533 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16534
16535 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16536 history.
16537
16538 @table @code
16539 @cindex history substitution
16540 @cindex history file
16541 @kindex set history filename
16542 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16543 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16544 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16545 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16546 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16547 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16548 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16549 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16550 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16551 is not set.
16552
16553 @cindex save command history
16554 @kindex set history save
16555 @item set history save
16556 @itemx set history save on
16557 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16558 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16559
16560 @item set history save off
16561 Stop recording command history in a file.
16562
16563 @cindex history size
16564 @kindex set history size
16565 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16566 @item set history size @var{size}
16567 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16568 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16569 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16570 @end table
16571
16572 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16573 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16574
16575 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16576 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16577 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16578 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16579 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16580 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16581 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16582 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16583
16584 The commands to control history expansion are:
16585
16586 @table @code
16587 @item set history expansion on
16588 @itemx set history expansion
16589 @kindex set history expansion
16590 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16591
16592 @item set history expansion off
16593 Disable history expansion.
16594
16595 @c @group
16596 @kindex show history
16597 @item show history
16598 @itemx show history filename
16599 @itemx show history save
16600 @itemx show history size
16601 @itemx show history expansion
16602 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16603 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16604 @c @end group
16605 @end table
16606
16607 @table @code
16608 @kindex show commands
16609 @cindex show last commands
16610 @cindex display command history
16611 @item show commands
16612 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16613
16614 @item show commands @var{n}
16615 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16616
16617 @item show commands +
16618 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16619 @end table
16620
16621 @node Screen Size
16622 @section Screen Size
16623 @cindex size of screen
16624 @cindex pauses in output
16625
16626 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16627 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16628 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16629 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16630 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16631 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16632 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16633 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16634
16635 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16636 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16637 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16638 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16639 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16640 width} commands:
16641
16642 @table @code
16643 @kindex set height
16644 @kindex set width
16645 @kindex show width
16646 @kindex show height
16647 @item set height @var{lpp}
16648 @itemx show height
16649 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16650 @itemx show width
16651 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16652 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16653 commands display the current settings.
16654
16655 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16656 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16657 file or to an editor buffer.
16658
16659 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16660 from wrapping its output.
16661
16662 @item set pagination on
16663 @itemx set pagination off
16664 @kindex set pagination
16665 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16666 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16667
16668 @item show pagination
16669 @kindex show pagination
16670 Show the current pagination mode.
16671 @end table
16672
16673 @node Numbers
16674 @section Numbers
16675 @cindex number representation
16676 @cindex entering numbers
16677
16678 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16679 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16680 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16681 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16682 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16683 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16684 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16685 both input and output with the commands described below.
16686
16687 @table @code
16688 @kindex set input-radix
16689 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16690 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16691 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16692 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16693 example, any of
16694
16695 @smallexample
16696 set input-radix 012
16697 set input-radix 10.
16698 set input-radix 0xa
16699 @end smallexample
16700
16701 @noindent
16702 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16703 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16704 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16705 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16706 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16707 change the radix.
16708
16709 @kindex set output-radix
16710 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16711 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16712 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16713 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16714
16715 @kindex show input-radix
16716 @item show input-radix
16717 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16718
16719 @kindex show output-radix
16720 @item show output-radix
16721 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16722
16723 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16724 @itemx show radix
16725 @kindex set radix
16726 @kindex show radix
16727 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16728 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16729 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16730 default value of 10.
16731
16732 @end table
16733
16734 @node ABI
16735 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16736
16737 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16738 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16739 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16740 current ABI.
16741
16742 @cindex OS ABI
16743 @kindex set osabi
16744 @kindex show osabi
16745
16746 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16747 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16748 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16749 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16750 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16751 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16752 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16753 platform provides.
16754
16755 @table @code
16756 @item show osabi
16757 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16758
16759 @item set osabi
16760 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16761
16762 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16763 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16764 @end table
16765
16766 @cindex float promotion
16767
16768 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16769 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16770 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16771 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16772 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16773 @code{double} and then passed.
16774
16775 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16776 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16777 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16778
16779 @table @code
16780 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16781 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16782 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16783 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16784 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16785
16786 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16787 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16788 functions.
16789
16790 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16791 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16792 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16793 @end table
16794
16795 @kindex set cp-abi
16796 @kindex show cp-abi
16797 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16798 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16799 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16800 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16801 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16802 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16803 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16804 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16805 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16806 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16807 ``auto''.
16808
16809 @table @code
16810 @item show cp-abi
16811 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16812
16813 @item set cp-abi
16814 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16815
16816 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16817 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16818 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16819 @end table
16820
16821 @node Messages/Warnings
16822 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16823
16824 @cindex verbose operation
16825 @cindex optional warnings
16826 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16827 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16828 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16829 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16830
16831 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16832 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16833 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16834
16835 @table @code
16836 @kindex set verbose
16837 @item set verbose on
16838 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16839
16840 @item set verbose off
16841 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16842
16843 @kindex show verbose
16844 @item show verbose
16845 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16846 @end table
16847
16848 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16849 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16850 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16851 Symbol Files}).
16852
16853 @table @code
16854
16855 @kindex set complaints
16856 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16857 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16858 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16859 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16860 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16861
16862 @kindex show complaints
16863 @item show complaints
16864 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16865
16866 @end table
16867
16868 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16869 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16870 you try to run a program which is already running:
16871
16872 @smallexample
16873 (@value{GDBP}) run
16874 The program being debugged has been started already.
16875 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16876 @end smallexample
16877
16878 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16879 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16880
16881 @table @code
16882
16883 @kindex set confirm
16884 @cindex flinching
16885 @cindex confirmation
16886 @cindex stupid questions
16887 @item set confirm off
16888 Disables confirmation requests.
16889
16890 @item set confirm on
16891 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16892
16893 @kindex show confirm
16894 @item show confirm
16895 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16896
16897 @end table
16898
16899 @cindex command tracing
16900 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16901 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16902 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16903 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16904
16905 @table @code
16906 @kindex set trace-commands
16907 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16908 @item set trace-commands on
16909 Enable command tracing.
16910 @item set trace-commands off
16911 Disable command tracing.
16912 @item show trace-commands
16913 Display the current state of command tracing.
16914 @end table
16915
16916 @node Debugging Output
16917 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16918 @cindex optional debugging messages
16919
16920 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16921 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16922 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16923 section documents those commands.
16924
16925 @table @code
16926 @kindex set exec-done-display
16927 @item set exec-done-display
16928 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16929 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16930 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16931 @kindex show exec-done-display
16932 @item show exec-done-display
16933 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16934 notification.
16935 @kindex set debug
16936 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16937 @cindex architecture debugging info
16938 @item set debug arch
16939 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16940 @kindex show debug
16941 @item show debug arch
16942 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16943 @item set debug aix-thread
16944 @cindex AIX threads
16945 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16946 module.
16947 @item show debug aix-thread
16948 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16949 @item set debug displaced
16950 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
16951 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
16952 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
16953 @item show debug displaced
16954 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
16955 related to displaced stepping.
16956 @item set debug event
16957 @cindex event debugging info
16958 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16959 default is off.
16960 @item show debug event
16961 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16962 info.
16963 @item set debug expression
16964 @cindex expression debugging info
16965 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16966 expression parsing. The default is off.
16967 @item show debug expression
16968 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16969 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16970 @item set debug frame
16971 @cindex frame debugging info
16972 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16973 default is off.
16974 @item show debug frame
16975 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16976 info.
16977 @item set debug infrun
16978 @cindex inferior debugging info
16979 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16980 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16981 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16982 @item show debug infrun
16983 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16984 @item set debug lin-lwp
16985 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16986 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16987 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16988 @item show debug lin-lwp
16989 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16990 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
16991 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16992 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16993 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16994 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
16995 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16996 @item set debug observer
16997 @cindex observer debugging info
16998 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16999 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17000 @item show debug observer
17001 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17002 @item set debug overload
17003 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17004 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17005 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17006 is off.
17007 @item show debug overload
17008 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17009 debugging info.
17010 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17011 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17012 @cindex debug remote protocol
17013 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17014 @cindex display remote packets
17015 @item set debug remote
17016 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17017 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17018 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17019 @item show debug remote
17020 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17021 @item set debug serial
17022 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17023 default is off.
17024 @item show debug serial
17025 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17026 info.
17027 @item set debug solib-frv
17028 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17029 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17030 @item show debug solib-frv
17031 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17032 messages.
17033 @item set debug target
17034 @cindex target debugging info
17035 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17036 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17037 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17038 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17039 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17040 @item show debug target
17041 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17042 info.
17043 @item set debug timestamp
17044 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17045 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17046 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17047 message.
17048 @item show debug timestamp
17049 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17050 debugging info.
17051 @item set debugvarobj
17052 @cindex variable object debugging info
17053 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17054 info. The default is off.
17055 @item show debugvarobj
17056 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17057 debugging info.
17058 @item set debug xml
17059 @cindex XML parser debugging
17060 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17061 @item show debug xml
17062 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17063 @end table
17064
17065 @node Extending GDB
17066 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17067 @cindex extending GDB
17068
17069 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17070 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17071 Python scripting language.
17072
17073 @menu
17074 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17075 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17076 @end menu
17077
17078 @node Sequences
17079 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17080
17081 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17082 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17083 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17084 files.
17085
17086 @menu
17087 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17088 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17089 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17090 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17091 @end menu
17092
17093 @node Define
17094 @subsection User-defined Commands
17095
17096 @cindex user-defined command
17097 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17098 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17099 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17100 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17101 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17102 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17103
17104 @smallexample
17105 define adder
17106 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17107 end
17108 @end smallexample
17109
17110 @noindent
17111 To execute the command use:
17112
17113 @smallexample
17114 adder 1 2 3
17115 @end smallexample
17116
17117 @noindent
17118 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17119 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17120 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17121 functions calls.
17122
17123 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17124 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17125 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17126 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17127
17128 @smallexample
17129 define adder
17130 if $argc == 2
17131 print $arg0 + $arg1
17132 end
17133 if $argc == 3
17134 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17135 end
17136 end
17137 @end smallexample
17138
17139 @table @code
17140
17141 @kindex define
17142 @item define @var{commandname}
17143 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17144 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17145
17146 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17147 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17148 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17149
17150 @kindex document
17151 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17152 @item document @var{commandname}
17153 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17154 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17155 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17156 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17157 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17158 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17159
17160 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17161 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17162 does not change the documentation.
17163
17164 @kindex dont-repeat
17165 @cindex don't repeat command
17166 @item dont-repeat
17167 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17168 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17169 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17170
17171 @kindex help user-defined
17172 @item help user-defined
17173 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17174 (if any) for each.
17175
17176 @kindex show user
17177 @item show user
17178 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
17179 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17180 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17181 definitions for all user-defined commands.
17182
17183 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17184 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
17185 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
17186 @item show max-user-call-depth
17187 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
17188 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17189 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17190 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17191 @end table
17192
17193 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17194 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17195
17196 When user-defined commands are executed, the
17197 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17198 stops execution of the user-defined command.
17199
17200 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17201 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17202 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17203 messages when used in a user-defined command.
17204
17205 @node Hooks
17206 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17207 @cindex command hooks
17208 @cindex hooks, for commands
17209 @cindex hooks, pre-command
17210
17211 @kindex hook
17212 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17213 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17214 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17215 before that command.
17216
17217 @cindex hooks, post-command
17218 @kindex hookpost
17219 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17220 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17221 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17222 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17223 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17224
17225 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17226 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17227
17228 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17229 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17230
17231 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17232 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17233 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17234 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17235 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17236
17237 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17238 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17239 you could define:
17240
17241 @smallexample
17242 define hook-stop
17243 handle SIGALRM nopass
17244 end
17245
17246 define hook-run
17247 handle SIGALRM pass
17248 end
17249
17250 define hook-continue
17251 handle SIGALRM pass
17252 end
17253 @end smallexample
17254
17255 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17256 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17257 you could define:
17258
17259 @smallexample
17260 define hook-echo
17261 echo <<<---
17262 end
17263
17264 define hookpost-echo
17265 echo --->>>\n
17266 end
17267
17268 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17269 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17270 (@value{GDBP})
17271
17272 @end smallexample
17273
17274 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17275 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17276 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17277 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17278 @c or not?
17279 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17280 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17281 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17282
17283 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17284 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17285
17286 @node Command Files
17287 @subsection Command Files
17288
17289 @cindex command files
17290 @cindex scripting commands
17291 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17292 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17293 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17294 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17295 terminal.
17296
17297 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17298 command:
17299
17300 @table @code
17301 @kindex source
17302 @cindex execute commands from a file
17303 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17304 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17305 @end table
17306
17307 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17308 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17309 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17310 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17311 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17312
17313 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17314 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17315
17316 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17317 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17318 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17319
17320 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17321 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17322 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17323 when called from command files.
17324
17325 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17326 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17327 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17328 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17329 the next command.
17330
17331 @smallexample
17332 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17333 @end smallexample
17334
17335 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17336 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17337 would be directed to @file{log}.
17338
17339 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17340 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17341 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17342 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17343 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17344 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17345 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17346 conditionally, etc.
17347
17348 @table @code
17349 @kindex if
17350 @kindex else
17351 @item if
17352 @itemx else
17353 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17354 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17355 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17356 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17357 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17358 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17359 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17360
17361 @kindex while
17362 @item while
17363 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17364 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17365 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17366 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17367 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17368 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17369
17370 @kindex loop_break
17371 @item loop_break
17372 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17373 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17374 line.
17375
17376 @kindex loop_continue
17377 @item loop_continue
17378 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17379 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17380 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17381 the controlling expression.
17382
17383 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17384 @item end
17385 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17386 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17387 @end table
17388
17389
17390 @node Output
17391 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
17392
17393 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17394 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17395 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17396 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17397 want.
17398
17399 @table @code
17400 @kindex echo
17401 @item echo @var{text}
17402 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17403 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17404 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17405 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17406 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17407 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17408 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17409 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17410 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17411 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17412 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17413
17414 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17415 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17416
17417 @smallexample
17418 echo This is some text\n\
17419 which is continued\n\
17420 onto several lines.\n
17421 @end smallexample
17422
17423 produces the same output as
17424
17425 @smallexample
17426 echo This is some text\n
17427 echo which is continued\n
17428 echo onto several lines.\n
17429 @end smallexample
17430
17431 @kindex output
17432 @item output @var{expression}
17433 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17434 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17435 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17436 on expressions.
17437
17438 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17439 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17440 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17441 Formats}, for more information.
17442
17443 @kindex printf
17444 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17445 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17446 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17447 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17448 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17449 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17450 executing the code below:
17451
17452 @smallexample
17453 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17454 @end smallexample
17455
17456 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17457 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17458 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17459 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17460 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17461 printed.
17462
17463 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17464
17465 @smallexample
17466 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17467 @end smallexample
17468
17469 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17470 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17471 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17472
17473 @itemize @bullet
17474 @item
17475 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17476
17477 @item
17478 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17479 width.
17480
17481 @item
17482 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17483 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17484
17485 @item
17486 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17487 supported.
17488
17489 @item
17490 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17491
17492 @item
17493 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17494 @end itemize
17495
17496 @noindent
17497 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17498 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17499 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17500 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17501
17502 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17503 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17504 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17505 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17506 supported.
17507
17508 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17509 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17510 together with a floating point specifier.
17511 letters:
17512
17513 @itemize @bullet
17514 @item
17515 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17516
17517 @item
17518 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17519
17520 @item
17521 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17522 @end itemize
17523
17524 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17525 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17526 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17527
17528 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17529 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17530
17531 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17532 @smallexample
17533 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17534 @end smallexample
17535
17536 @end table
17537
17538 @node Python
17539 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17540 @cindex python scripting
17541 @cindex scripting with python
17542
17543 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
17544 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
17545 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
17546
17547 @menu
17548 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
17549 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
17550 @end menu
17551
17552 @node Python Commands
17553 @subsection Python Commands
17554 @cindex python commands
17555 @cindex commands to access python
17556
17557 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
17558 and one related setting:
17559
17560 @table @code
17561 @kindex python
17562 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
17563 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
17564
17565 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
17566 argument as a Python command. For example:
17567
17568 @smallexample
17569 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
17570 23
17571 @end smallexample
17572
17573 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
17574 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
17575 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
17576 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
17577 containing @code{end}. For example:
17578
17579 @smallexample
17580 (@value{GDBP}) python
17581 Type python script
17582 End with a line saying just "end".
17583 >print 23
17584 >end
17585 23
17586 @end smallexample
17587
17588 @kindex maint set python print-stack
17589 @item maint set python print-stack
17590 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
17591 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
17592 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
17593 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
17594 disabled.
17595 @end table
17596
17597 @node Python API
17598 @subsection Python API
17599 @cindex python api
17600 @cindex programming in python
17601
17602 @cindex python stdout
17603 @cindex python pagination
17604 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
17605 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
17606 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
17607 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
17608 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
17609
17610 @menu
17611 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
17612 * Exception Handling::
17613 @end menu
17614
17615 @node Basic Python
17616 @subsubsection Basic Python
17617
17618 @cindex python functions
17619 @cindex python module
17620 @cindex gdb module
17621 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
17622 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
17623 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
17624 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
17625
17626 @findex gdb.execute
17627 @defun execute command
17628 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17629 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
17630 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
17631 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
17632 @end defun
17633
17634 @findex gdb.get_parameter
17635 @defun get_parameter parameter
17636 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
17637 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
17638 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
17639 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
17640
17641 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
17642 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
17643 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
17644 @end defun
17645
17646 @findex gdb.write
17647 @defun write string
17648 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
17649 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
17650 call this function.
17651 @end defun
17652
17653 @findex gdb.flush
17654 @defun flush
17655 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
17656 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
17657 function.
17658 @end defun
17659
17660 @node Exception Handling
17661 @subsubsection Exception Handling
17662 @cindex python exceptions
17663 @cindex exceptions, python
17664
17665 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
17666 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
17667 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
17668 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
17669 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
17670 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
17671 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
17672
17673 @smallexample
17674 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
17675 Traceback (most recent call last):
17676 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
17677 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
17678 @end smallexample
17679
17680 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
17681 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
17682 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
17683 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
17684 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
17685 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
17686 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
17687 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
17688 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
17689 traceback.
17690
17691 @node Interpreters
17692 @chapter Command Interpreters
17693 @cindex command interpreters
17694
17695 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17696 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17697 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17698
17699 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17700 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17701 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17702 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17703
17704 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17705 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17706 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17707 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17708
17709 @table @code
17710 @item console
17711 @cindex console interpreter
17712 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17713 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17714 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17715
17716 @item mi
17717 @cindex mi interpreter
17718 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17719 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17720 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17721 Interface}.
17722
17723 @item mi2
17724 @cindex mi2 interpreter
17725 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17726
17727 @item mi1
17728 @cindex mi1 interpreter
17729 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17730
17731 @end table
17732
17733 @cindex invoke another interpreter
17734 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17735 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17736 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17737 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17738 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17739 the IDE inoperable!
17740
17741 @kindex interpreter-exec
17742 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17743 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17744 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17745 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
17746
17747 @smallexample
17748 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17749 @end smallexample
17750
17751 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17752 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17753
17754 @node TUI
17755 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17756 @cindex TUI
17757 @cindex Text User Interface
17758
17759 @menu
17760 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17761 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17762 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17763 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17764 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17765 @end menu
17766
17767 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17768 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17769 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17770 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17771 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17772 is available.
17773
17774 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17775 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17776 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17777 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17778 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17779 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17780
17781 @node TUI Overview
17782 @section TUI Overview
17783
17784 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17785
17786 @table @emph
17787 @item command
17788 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17789 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17790 managed using readline.
17791
17792 @item source
17793 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17794 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17795
17796 @item assembly
17797 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17798
17799 @item register
17800 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17801 when their values change.
17802 @end table
17803
17804 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17805 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17806 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17807 indicates the breakpoint type:
17808
17809 @table @code
17810 @item B
17811 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17812
17813 @item b
17814 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17815
17816 @item H
17817 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17818
17819 @item h
17820 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17821 @end table
17822
17823 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17824
17825 @table @code
17826 @item +
17827 Breakpoint is enabled.
17828
17829 @item -
17830 Breakpoint is disabled.
17831 @end table
17832
17833 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17834 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17835 changes.
17836
17837 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17838 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17839 layouts:
17840
17841 @itemize @bullet
17842 @item
17843 source only,
17844
17845 @item
17846 assembly only,
17847
17848 @item
17849 source and assembly,
17850
17851 @item
17852 source and registers, or
17853
17854 @item
17855 assembly and registers.
17856 @end itemize
17857
17858 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17859
17860 @table @emph
17861 @item target
17862 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17863 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17864
17865 @item process
17866 Gives the current process or thread number.
17867 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17868
17869 @item function
17870 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17871 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17872 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17873 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17874
17875 @item line
17876 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17877 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17878
17879 @item pc
17880 Indicates the current program counter address.
17881 @end table
17882
17883 @node TUI Keys
17884 @section TUI Key Bindings
17885 @cindex TUI key bindings
17886
17887 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17888 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17889 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17890
17891 @table @kbd
17892 @kindex C-x C-a
17893 @item C-x C-a
17894 @kindex C-x a
17895 @itemx C-x a
17896 @kindex C-x A
17897 @itemx C-x A
17898 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17899 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17900 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17901 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17902 The screen is then refreshed.
17903
17904 @kindex C-x 1
17905 @item C-x 1
17906 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17907 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17908 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17909
17910 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17911
17912 @kindex C-x 2
17913 @item C-x 2
17914 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17915 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17916 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17917 previous layout and the new one.
17918
17919 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17920
17921 @kindex C-x o
17922 @item C-x o
17923 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17924 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17925 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17926
17927 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17928
17929 @kindex C-x s
17930 @item C-x s
17931 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17932 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17933 @end table
17934
17935 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17936
17937 @table @asis
17938 @kindex PgUp
17939 @item @key{PgUp}
17940 Scroll the active window one page up.
17941
17942 @kindex PgDn
17943 @item @key{PgDn}
17944 Scroll the active window one page down.
17945
17946 @kindex Up
17947 @item @key{Up}
17948 Scroll the active window one line up.
17949
17950 @kindex Down
17951 @item @key{Down}
17952 Scroll the active window one line down.
17953
17954 @kindex Left
17955 @item @key{Left}
17956 Scroll the active window one column left.
17957
17958 @kindex Right
17959 @item @key{Right}
17960 Scroll the active window one column right.
17961
17962 @kindex C-L
17963 @item @kbd{C-L}
17964 Refresh the screen.
17965 @end table
17966
17967 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17968 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17969 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17970 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17971 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17972
17973 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17974 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17975 @cindex TUI single key mode
17976
17977 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17978 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17979 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17980
17981 @table @kbd
17982 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17983 @item c
17984 continue
17985
17986 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17987 @item d
17988 down
17989
17990 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17991 @item f
17992 finish
17993
17994 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17995 @item n
17996 next
17997
17998 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17999 @item q
18000 exit the SingleKey mode.
18001
18002 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18003 @item r
18004 run
18005
18006 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18007 @item s
18008 step
18009
18010 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18011 @item u
18012 up
18013
18014 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18015 @item v
18016 info locals
18017
18018 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18019 @item w
18020 where
18021 @end table
18022
18023 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
18024 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
18025 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
18026 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
18027 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
18028 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
18029
18030
18031 @node TUI Commands
18032 @section TUI-specific Commands
18033 @cindex TUI commands
18034
18035 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
18036 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
18037 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
18038 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
18039
18040 @table @code
18041 @item info win
18042 @kindex info win
18043 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
18044
18045 @item layout next
18046 @kindex layout
18047 Display the next layout.
18048
18049 @item layout prev
18050 Display the previous layout.
18051
18052 @item layout src
18053 Display the source window only.
18054
18055 @item layout asm
18056 Display the assembly window only.
18057
18058 @item layout split
18059 Display the source and assembly window.
18060
18061 @item layout regs
18062 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
18063
18064 @item focus next
18065 @kindex focus
18066 Make the next window active for scrolling.
18067
18068 @item focus prev
18069 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
18070
18071 @item focus src
18072 Make the source window active for scrolling.
18073
18074 @item focus asm
18075 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
18076
18077 @item focus regs
18078 Make the register window active for scrolling.
18079
18080 @item focus cmd
18081 Make the command window active for scrolling.
18082
18083 @item refresh
18084 @kindex refresh
18085 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
18086
18087 @item tui reg float
18088 @kindex tui reg
18089 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
18090
18091 @item tui reg general
18092 Show the general registers in the register window.
18093
18094 @item tui reg next
18095 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
18096 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
18097 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
18098 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
18099
18100 @item tui reg system
18101 Show the system registers in the register window.
18102
18103 @item update
18104 @kindex update
18105 Update the source window and the current execution point.
18106
18107 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
18108 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
18109 @kindex winheight
18110 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
18111 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
18112 decrease it.
18113
18114 @item tabset @var{nchars}
18115 @kindex tabset
18116 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
18117 @end table
18118
18119 @node TUI Configuration
18120 @section TUI Configuration Variables
18121 @cindex TUI configuration variables
18122
18123 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
18124
18125 @table @code
18126 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
18127 @kindex set tui border-kind
18128 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
18129 The possible values are the following:
18130 @table @code
18131 @item space
18132 Use a space character to draw the border.
18133
18134 @item ascii
18135 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
18136
18137 @item acs
18138 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
18139 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
18140 @end table
18141
18142 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
18143 @kindex set tui border-mode
18144 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
18145 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
18146 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
18147 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
18148 @table @code
18149 @item normal
18150 Use normal attributes to display the border.
18151
18152 @item standout
18153 Use standout mode.
18154
18155 @item reverse
18156 Use reverse video mode.
18157
18158 @item half
18159 Use half bright mode.
18160
18161 @item half-standout
18162 Use half bright and standout mode.
18163
18164 @item bold
18165 Use extra bright or bold mode.
18166
18167 @item bold-standout
18168 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
18169 @end table
18170 @end table
18171
18172 @node Emacs
18173 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
18174
18175 @cindex Emacs
18176 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
18177 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
18178 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
18179 @value{GDBN}.
18180
18181 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
18182 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
18183 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
18184 created Emacs buffer.
18185 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
18186
18187 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
18188 things:
18189
18190 @itemize @bullet
18191 @item
18192 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
18193 the GUD buffer.
18194
18195 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
18196 and output done by the program you are debugging.
18197
18198 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
18199 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
18200 in this way.
18201
18202 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
18203 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
18204 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
18205 stop.
18206
18207 @item
18208 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
18209
18210 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
18211 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
18212 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
18213 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
18214 and the source.
18215
18216 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
18217 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
18218 @end itemize
18219
18220 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
18221 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
18222 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
18223 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
18224
18225 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
18226 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
18227 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
18228 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
18229 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
18230 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
18231 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
18232 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
18233 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
18234
18235 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
18236 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
18237 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
18238 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
18239
18240 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
18241 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
18242 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
18243 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
18244 one you want.
18245
18246 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
18247 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
18248
18249 @table @kbd
18250 @item C-h m
18251 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
18252
18253 @item C-c C-s
18254 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
18255 update the display window to show the current file and location.
18256
18257 @item C-c C-n
18258 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
18259 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
18260 to show the current file and location.
18261
18262 @item C-c C-i
18263 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
18264 display window accordingly.
18265
18266 @item C-c C-f
18267 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
18268 @code{finish} command.
18269
18270 @item C-c C-r
18271 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
18272 command.
18273
18274 @item C-c <
18275 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
18276 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
18277 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
18278
18279 @item C-c >
18280 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
18281 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
18282 @end table
18283
18284 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
18285 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
18286
18287 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
18288 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
18289 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
18290 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
18291 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
18292 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
18293 speedbar displays watch expressions.
18294
18295 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
18296 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
18297 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
18298 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
18299 frame.
18300
18301 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
18302 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
18303 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
18304 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
18305 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
18306 to correspond properly with the code.
18307
18308 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
18309 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
18310 Emacs Manual}).
18311
18312 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
18313 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
18314 @ignore
18315 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
18316 @kindex Epoch
18317 @kindex inspect
18318
18319 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
18320 called the @code{epoch}
18321 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
18322 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
18323 each value is printed in its own window.
18324 @end ignore
18325
18326
18327 @node GDB/MI
18328 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
18329
18330 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
18331
18332 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
18333 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
18334 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
18335 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
18336 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
18337 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
18338
18339 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
18340 in the form of a reference manual.
18341
18342 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
18343 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
18344 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
18345
18346 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
18347
18348 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
18349 This chapter uses the following notation:
18350
18351 @itemize @bullet
18352 @item
18353 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
18354
18355 @item
18356 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
18357 it may or may not be given.
18358
18359 @item
18360 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18361 may repeat zero or more times.
18362
18363 @item
18364 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18365 may repeat one or more times.
18366
18367 @item
18368 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
18369 @end itemize
18370
18371 @ignore
18372 @heading Dependencies
18373 @end ignore
18374
18375 @menu
18376 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
18377 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
18378 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
18379 * GDB/MI Output Records::
18380 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
18381 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
18382 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
18383 * GDB/MI Program Context::
18384 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
18385 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
18386 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
18387 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
18388 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
18389 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
18390 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
18391 * GDB/MI File Commands::
18392 @ignore
18393 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
18394 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
18395 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
18396 @end ignore
18397 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
18398 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
18399 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
18400 @end menu
18401
18402 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18403 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
18404 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
18405
18406 @menu
18407 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
18408 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
18409 @end menu
18410
18411 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
18412 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
18413
18414 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
18415 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
18416 @table @code
18417 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
18418 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
18419
18420 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
18421 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
18422 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18423
18424 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
18425 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
18426 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
18427
18428 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18429 "any sequence of digits"
18430
18431 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
18432 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
18433
18434 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
18435 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
18436
18437 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
18438 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
18439
18440 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
18441 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
18442 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
18443
18444 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
18445 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
18446
18447 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18448 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18449 @end table
18450
18451 @noindent
18452 Notes:
18453
18454 @itemize @bullet
18455 @item
18456 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
18457 output is described below.
18458
18459 @item
18460 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
18461 finishes.
18462
18463 @item
18464 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
18465 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
18466 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
18467 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
18468 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
18469 @end itemize
18470
18471 Pragmatics:
18472
18473 @itemize @bullet
18474 @item
18475 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
18476
18477 @item
18478 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
18479 @end itemize
18480
18481 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
18482 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
18483
18484 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
18485 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
18486 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
18487 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
18488 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
18489 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
18490
18491 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
18492 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
18493 @var{token}.
18494
18495 @table @code
18496 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
18497 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
18498
18499 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
18500 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18501
18502 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
18503 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
18504
18505 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
18506 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
18507
18508 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
18509 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
18510
18511 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
18512 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
18513
18514 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
18515 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
18516
18517 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
18518 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18519
18520 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
18521 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
18522
18523 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
18524 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
18525 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
18526
18527 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
18528 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
18529
18530 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
18531 @code{ @var{string} }
18532
18533 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
18534 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
18535
18536 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
18537 @code{@var{c-string}}
18538
18539 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
18540 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
18541
18542 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
18543 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
18544 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
18545
18546 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
18547 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
18548
18549 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
18550 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
18551
18552 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
18553 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
18554
18555 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
18556 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
18557
18558 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18559 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18560
18561 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18562 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
18563 @end table
18564
18565 @noindent
18566 Notes:
18567
18568 @itemize @bullet
18569 @item
18570 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
18571
18572 @item
18573 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
18574 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
18575 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
18576 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
18577 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
18578 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
18579 prior command.
18580
18581 @item
18582 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18583 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
18584 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
18585 prefixed by @samp{+}.
18586
18587 @item
18588 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18589 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
18590 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
18591 @samp{*}.
18592
18593 @item
18594 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18595 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
18596 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
18597 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
18598
18599 @item
18600 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18601 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
18602 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
18603 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
18604
18605 @item
18606 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18607 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
18608 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
18609
18610 @item
18611 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18612 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
18613 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
18614 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
18615
18616 @item
18617 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18618 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
18619 @var{values}.
18620
18621
18622 @end itemize
18623
18624 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
18625 details about the various output records.
18626
18627 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18628 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18629 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18630
18631 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18632 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18633
18634 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18635 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18636 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18637 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18638 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18639 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18640
18641 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18642 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18643 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18644
18645 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18646 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18647 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18648 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18649
18650 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18651 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18652
18653 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18654 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18655 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18656 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18657 might change.
18658
18659 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18660 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18661 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18662 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18663
18664 @itemize @bullet
18665 @item
18666 New MI commands may be added.
18667
18668 @item
18669 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18670
18671 @item
18672 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18673 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18674
18675 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18676 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18677
18678 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18679 @c resolve inconsistencies.
18680 @end itemize
18681
18682 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18683 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18684 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18685 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18686 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18687
18688 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18689 @c version?
18690
18691 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18692 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18693 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18694 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18695 @cindex mailing lists
18696
18697 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18698 @node GDB/MI Output Records
18699 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18700
18701 @menu
18702 * GDB/MI Result Records::
18703 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
18704 * GDB/MI Async Records::
18705 @end menu
18706
18707 @node GDB/MI Result Records
18708 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18709
18710 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18711 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18712 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18713 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18714
18715 @table @code
18716 @findex ^done
18717 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18718 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18719 values.
18720
18721 @item "^running"
18722 @findex ^running
18723 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18724 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18725 running.
18726
18727 @item "^connected"
18728 @findex ^connected
18729 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18730
18731 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18732 @findex ^error
18733 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18734 error message.
18735
18736 @item "^exit"
18737 @findex ^exit
18738 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
18739
18740 @end table
18741
18742 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
18743 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18744
18745 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18746 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18747 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18748 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18749 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18750
18751 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18752 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18753 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18754 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18755 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18756
18757 @table @code
18758 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18759 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18760 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18761
18762 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18763 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18764 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18765 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18766
18767 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18768 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18769 internals.
18770 @end table
18771
18772 @node GDB/MI Async Records
18773 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
18774
18775 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18776 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
18777 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18778 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18779 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18780 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18781
18782 The following is the list of possible async records:
18783
18784 @table @code
18785
18786 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
18787 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
18788 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
18789 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
18790 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
18791 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
18792 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
18793 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
18794 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
18795 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
18796
18797 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18798 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
18799 following values:
18800
18801 @table @code
18802 @item breakpoint-hit
18803 A breakpoint was reached.
18804 @item watchpoint-trigger
18805 A watchpoint was triggered.
18806 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18807 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18808 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18809 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18810 @item function-finished
18811 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18812 @item location-reached
18813 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18814 @item watchpoint-scope
18815 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18816 @item end-stepping-range
18817 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18818 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18819 @item exited-signalled
18820 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18821 @item exited
18822 The inferior exited.
18823 @item exited-normally
18824 The inferior exited normally.
18825 @item signal-received
18826 A signal was received by the inferior.
18827 @end table
18828
18829 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}"
18830 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}"
18831 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
18832 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.
18833 @end table
18834
18835
18836
18837 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18838 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18839 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18840 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18841
18842 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18843 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18844 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18845 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18846
18847 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18848 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18849
18850 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18851
18852 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18853 information of the breakpoint.
18854
18855 @smallexample
18856 -> -break-insert main
18857 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18858 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18859 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18860 <- (gdb)
18861 @end smallexample
18862
18863 @subheading Program Execution
18864
18865 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18866 reason that execution stopped.
18867
18868 @smallexample
18869 -> -exec-run
18870 <- ^running
18871 <- (gdb)
18872 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18873 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18874 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18875 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18876 <- (gdb)
18877 -> -exec-continue
18878 <- ^running
18879 <- (gdb)
18880 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18881 <- (gdb)
18882 @end smallexample
18883
18884 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18885
18886 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18887
18888 @smallexample
18889 -> (gdb)
18890 <- -gdb-exit
18891 <- ^exit
18892 @end smallexample
18893
18894 @subheading A Bad Command
18895
18896 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18897
18898 @smallexample
18899 -> -rubbish
18900 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18901 <- (gdb)
18902 @end smallexample
18903
18904
18905 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18906 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18907 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18908
18909 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18910 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18911
18912 @subheading Motivation
18913
18914 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18915
18916 @subheading Introduction
18917
18918 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18919
18920 @subheading Commands
18921
18922 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18923
18924 @subsubheading Synopsis
18925
18926 @smallexample
18927 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18928 @end smallexample
18929
18930 @subsubheading Result
18931
18932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18933
18934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18935
18936 @subsubheading Example
18937
18938 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18939 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18940
18941
18942 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18943 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18944 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18945
18946 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18947 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18948 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18949 breakpoints.
18950
18951 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18952 @findex -break-after
18953
18954 @subsubheading Synopsis
18955
18956 @smallexample
18957 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18958 @end smallexample
18959
18960 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18961 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18962 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18963 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18964
18965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18966
18967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18968
18969 @subsubheading Example
18970
18971 @smallexample
18972 (gdb)
18973 -break-insert main
18974 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18975 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18976 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18977 (gdb)
18978 -break-after 1 3
18979 ~
18980 ^done
18981 (gdb)
18982 -break-list
18983 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18984 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18985 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18986 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18987 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18988 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18989 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18990 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18991 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18992 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18993 (gdb)
18994 @end smallexample
18995
18996 @ignore
18997 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18998 @findex -break-catch
18999
19000 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
19001 @findex -break-commands
19002 @end ignore
19003
19004
19005 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
19006 @findex -break-condition
19007
19008 @subsubheading Synopsis
19009
19010 @smallexample
19011 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
19012 @end smallexample
19013
19014 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
19015 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
19016 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
19017 command below).
19018
19019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19020
19021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
19022
19023 @subsubheading Example
19024
19025 @smallexample
19026 (gdb)
19027 -break-condition 1 1
19028 ^done
19029 (gdb)
19030 -break-list
19031 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19032 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19033 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19034 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19035 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19036 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19037 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19038 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19039 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19040 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19041 (gdb)
19042 @end smallexample
19043
19044 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
19045 @findex -break-delete
19046
19047 @subsubheading Synopsis
19048
19049 @smallexample
19050 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19051 @end smallexample
19052
19053 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
19054 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
19055
19056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19057
19058 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
19059
19060 @subsubheading Example
19061
19062 @smallexample
19063 (gdb)
19064 -break-delete 1
19065 ^done
19066 (gdb)
19067 -break-list
19068 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19069 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19070 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19071 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19072 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19073 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19074 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19075 body=[]@}
19076 (gdb)
19077 @end smallexample
19078
19079 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
19080 @findex -break-disable
19081
19082 @subsubheading Synopsis
19083
19084 @smallexample
19085 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19086 @end smallexample
19087
19088 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
19089 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
19090
19091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19092
19093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
19094
19095 @subsubheading Example
19096
19097 @smallexample
19098 (gdb)
19099 -break-disable 2
19100 ^done
19101 (gdb)
19102 -break-list
19103 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19104 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19105 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19106 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19107 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19108 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19109 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19110 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
19111 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19112 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19113 (gdb)
19114 @end smallexample
19115
19116 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
19117 @findex -break-enable
19118
19119 @subsubheading Synopsis
19120
19121 @smallexample
19122 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19123 @end smallexample
19124
19125 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
19126
19127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19128
19129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
19130
19131 @subsubheading Example
19132
19133 @smallexample
19134 (gdb)
19135 -break-enable 2
19136 ^done
19137 (gdb)
19138 -break-list
19139 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19140 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19141 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19142 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19143 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19144 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19145 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19146 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19147 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19148 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19149 (gdb)
19150 @end smallexample
19151
19152 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
19153 @findex -break-info
19154
19155 @subsubheading Synopsis
19156
19157 @smallexample
19158 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
19159 @end smallexample
19160
19161 @c REDUNDANT???
19162 Get information about a single breakpoint.
19163
19164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19165
19166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
19167
19168 @subsubheading Example
19169 N.A.
19170
19171 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
19172 @findex -break-insert
19173
19174 @subsubheading Synopsis
19175
19176 @smallexample
19177 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
19178 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
19179 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
19180 @end smallexample
19181
19182 @noindent
19183 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
19184
19185 @itemize @bullet
19186 @item function
19187 @c @item +offset
19188 @c @item -offset
19189 @c @item linenum
19190 @item filename:linenum
19191 @item filename:function
19192 @item *address
19193 @end itemize
19194
19195 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
19196
19197 @table @samp
19198 @item -t
19199 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
19200 @item -h
19201 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
19202 @item -c @var{condition}
19203 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
19204 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
19205 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
19206 @item -f
19207 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
19208 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
19209 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
19210 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
19211 cannot be parsed.
19212 @end table
19213
19214 @subsubheading Result
19215
19216 The result is in the form:
19217
19218 @smallexample
19219 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
19220 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
19221 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
19222 times="@var{times}"@}
19223 @end smallexample
19224
19225 @noindent
19226 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
19227 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
19228 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
19229 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
19230 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
19231 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
19232 which use the same output).
19233
19234 Note: this format is open to change.
19235 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
19236
19237 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19238
19239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
19240 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
19241
19242 @subsubheading Example
19243
19244 @smallexample
19245 (gdb)
19246 -break-insert main
19247 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
19248 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
19249 (gdb)
19250 -break-insert -t foo
19251 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
19252 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
19253 (gdb)
19254 -break-list
19255 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19256 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19257 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19258 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19259 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19260 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19261 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19262 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19263 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
19264 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
19265 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
19266 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
19267 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
19268 (gdb)
19269 -break-insert -r foo.*
19270 ~int foo(int, int);
19271 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
19272 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
19273 (gdb)
19274 @end smallexample
19275
19276 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
19277 @findex -break-list
19278
19279 @subsubheading Synopsis
19280
19281 @smallexample
19282 -break-list
19283 @end smallexample
19284
19285 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
19286
19287 @table @samp
19288 @item Number
19289 number of the breakpoint
19290 @item Type
19291 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
19292 @item Disposition
19293 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
19294 or @samp{nokeep}
19295 @item Enabled
19296 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
19297 @item Address
19298 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
19299 @item What
19300 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
19301 name, line number
19302 @item Times
19303 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
19304 @end table
19305
19306 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
19307 @code{body} field is an empty list.
19308
19309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19310
19311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
19312
19313 @subsubheading Example
19314
19315 @smallexample
19316 (gdb)
19317 -break-list
19318 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19319 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19320 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19321 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19322 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19323 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19324 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19325 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19326 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
19327 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19328 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19329 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
19330 (gdb)
19331 @end smallexample
19332
19333 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
19334
19335 @smallexample
19336 (gdb)
19337 -break-list
19338 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19339 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19340 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19341 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19342 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19343 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19344 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19345 body=[]@}
19346 (gdb)
19347 @end smallexample
19348
19349 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
19350 @findex -break-watch
19351
19352 @subsubheading Synopsis
19353
19354 @smallexample
19355 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
19356 @end smallexample
19357
19358 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
19359 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
19360 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
19361 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
19362 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
19363 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
19364 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
19365 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
19366
19367 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
19368 breakpoints inserted.
19369
19370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19371
19372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
19373 @samp{rwatch}.
19374
19375 @subsubheading Example
19376
19377 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
19378
19379 @smallexample
19380 (gdb)
19381 -break-watch x
19382 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
19383 (gdb)
19384 -exec-continue
19385 ^running
19386 (gdb)
19387 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
19388 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
19389 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19390 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
19391 (gdb)
19392 @end smallexample
19393
19394 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
19395 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
19396 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
19397
19398 @smallexample
19399 (gdb)
19400 -break-watch C
19401 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
19402 (gdb)
19403 -exec-continue
19404 ^running
19405 (gdb)
19406 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
19407 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19408 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19409 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19410 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19411 (gdb)
19412 -exec-continue
19413 ^running
19414 (gdb)
19415 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
19416 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19417 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19418 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19419 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19420 (gdb)
19421 @end smallexample
19422
19423 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
19424 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
19425 deleted.
19426
19427 @smallexample
19428 (gdb)
19429 -break-watch C
19430 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
19431 (gdb)
19432 -break-list
19433 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19434 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19435 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19436 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19437 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19438 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19439 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19440 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19441 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19442 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19443 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
19444 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19445 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
19446 (gdb)
19447 -exec-continue
19448 ^running
19449 (gdb)
19450 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
19451 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19452 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19453 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19454 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19455 (gdb)
19456 -break-list
19457 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19458 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19459 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19460 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19461 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19462 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19463 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19464 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19465 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19466 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19467 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
19468 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19469 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
19470 (gdb)
19471 -exec-continue
19472 ^running
19473 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
19474 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19475 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19476 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19477 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19478 (gdb)
19479 -break-list
19480 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19481 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19482 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19483 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19484 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19485 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19486 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19487 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19488 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19489 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19490 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
19491 times="1"@}]@}
19492 (gdb)
19493 @end smallexample
19494
19495 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19496 @node GDB/MI Program Context
19497 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
19498
19499 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
19500 @findex -exec-arguments
19501
19502
19503 @subsubheading Synopsis
19504
19505 @smallexample
19506 -exec-arguments @var{args}
19507 @end smallexample
19508
19509 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
19510 @samp{-exec-run}.
19511
19512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19513
19514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
19515
19516 @subsubheading Example
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 (gdb)
19520 -exec-arguments -v word
19521 ^done
19522 (gdb)
19523 @end smallexample
19524
19525
19526 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19527 @findex -exec-show-arguments
19528
19529 @subsubheading Synopsis
19530
19531 @smallexample
19532 -exec-show-arguments
19533 @end smallexample
19534
19535 Print the arguments of the program.
19536
19537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19538
19539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19540
19541 @subsubheading Example
19542 N.A.
19543
19544
19545 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
19546 @findex -environment-cd
19547
19548 @subsubheading Synopsis
19549
19550 @smallexample
19551 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
19552 @end smallexample
19553
19554 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
19555
19556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19557
19558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
19559
19560 @subsubheading Example
19561
19562 @smallexample
19563 (gdb)
19564 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19565 ^done
19566 (gdb)
19567 @end smallexample
19568
19569
19570 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
19571 @findex -environment-directory
19572
19573 @subsubheading Synopsis
19574
19575 @smallexample
19576 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19577 @end smallexample
19578
19579 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
19580 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
19581 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
19582 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19583 occurs as normal.
19584 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19585 multiple directories in a single command
19586 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19587 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19588 If blanks are needed as
19589 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19590 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19591 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19592 character must not be used
19593 in any directory name.
19594 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
19595
19596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19597
19598 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
19599
19600 @subsubheading Example
19601
19602 @smallexample
19603 (gdb)
19604 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19605 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19606 (gdb)
19607 -environment-directory ""
19608 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19609 (gdb)
19610 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
19611 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
19612 (gdb)
19613 -environment-directory -r
19614 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
19615 (gdb)
19616 @end smallexample
19617
19618
19619 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
19620 @findex -environment-path
19621
19622 @subsubheading Synopsis
19623
19624 @smallexample
19625 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19626 @end smallexample
19627
19628 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
19629 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
19630 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
19631 supplied in addition to the
19632 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19633 occurs as normal.
19634 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19635 multiple directories in a single command
19636 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19637 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19638 If blanks are needed as
19639 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19640 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19641 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19642 character must not be used
19643 in any directory name.
19644 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
19645
19646
19647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19648
19649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19650
19651 @subsubheading Example
19652
19653 @smallexample
19654 (gdb)
19655 -environment-path
19656 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
19657 (gdb)
19658 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19659 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19660 (gdb)
19661 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19662 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19663 (gdb)
19664 @end smallexample
19665
19666
19667 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19668 @findex -environment-pwd
19669
19670 @subsubheading Synopsis
19671
19672 @smallexample
19673 -environment-pwd
19674 @end smallexample
19675
19676 Show the current working directory.
19677
19678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19679
19680 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19681
19682 @subsubheading Example
19683
19684 @smallexample
19685 (gdb)
19686 -environment-pwd
19687 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19688 (gdb)
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19692 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19693 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19694
19695
19696 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19697 @findex -thread-info
19698
19699 @subsubheading Synopsis
19700
19701 @smallexample
19702 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19703 @end smallexample
19704
19705 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19706 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19707 threads. When printing information about all threads,
19708 also reports the current thread.
19709
19710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19711
19712 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19713 about all threads.
19714
19715 @subsubheading Example
19716
19717 @smallexample
19718 -thread-info
19719 ^done,threads=[
19720 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19721 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19722 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19723 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19724 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19725 current-thread-id="1"
19726 (gdb)
19727 @end smallexample
19728
19729 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19730 @findex -thread-list-ids
19731
19732 @subsubheading Synopsis
19733
19734 @smallexample
19735 -thread-list-ids
19736 @end smallexample
19737
19738 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19739 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19740
19741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19742
19743 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19744
19745 @subsubheading Example
19746
19747 No threads present, besides the main process:
19748
19749 @smallexample
19750 (gdb)
19751 -thread-list-ids
19752 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19753 (gdb)
19754 @end smallexample
19755
19756
19757 Several threads:
19758
19759 @smallexample
19760 (gdb)
19761 -thread-list-ids
19762 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19763 number-of-threads="3"
19764 (gdb)
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767
19768 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19769 @findex -thread-select
19770
19771 @subsubheading Synopsis
19772
19773 @smallexample
19774 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19775 @end smallexample
19776
19777 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19778 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19779
19780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19781
19782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19783
19784 @subsubheading Example
19785
19786 @smallexample
19787 (gdb)
19788 -exec-next
19789 ^running
19790 (gdb)
19791 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19792 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19793 (gdb)
19794 -thread-list-ids
19795 ^done,
19796 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19797 number-of-threads="3"
19798 (gdb)
19799 -thread-select 3
19800 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19801 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19802 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19803 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19804 (gdb)
19805 @end smallexample
19806
19807 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19808 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19809 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19810
19811 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19812 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19813 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19814 other cases.
19815
19816 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19817 @findex -exec-continue
19818
19819 @subsubheading Synopsis
19820
19821 @smallexample
19822 -exec-continue
19823 @end smallexample
19824
19825 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19826 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19827
19828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19829
19830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19831
19832 @subsubheading Example
19833
19834 @smallexample
19835 -exec-continue
19836 ^running
19837 (gdb)
19838 @@Hello world
19839 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19840 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19841 line="13"@}
19842 (gdb)
19843 @end smallexample
19844
19845
19846 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19847 @findex -exec-finish
19848
19849 @subsubheading Synopsis
19850
19851 @smallexample
19852 -exec-finish
19853 @end smallexample
19854
19855 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19856 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19857
19858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19859
19860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19861
19862 @subsubheading Example
19863
19864 Function returning @code{void}.
19865
19866 @smallexample
19867 -exec-finish
19868 ^running
19869 (gdb)
19870 @@hello from foo
19871 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19872 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19873 (gdb)
19874 @end smallexample
19875
19876 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19877 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19878 value itself.
19879
19880 @smallexample
19881 -exec-finish
19882 ^running
19883 (gdb)
19884 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19885 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19886 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19887 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19888 (gdb)
19889 @end smallexample
19890
19891
19892 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19893 @findex -exec-interrupt
19894
19895 @subsubheading Synopsis
19896
19897 @smallexample
19898 -exec-interrupt
19899 @end smallexample
19900
19901 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19902 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19903 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19904 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19905 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19906
19907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19908
19909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19910
19911 @subsubheading Example
19912
19913 @smallexample
19914 (gdb)
19915 111-exec-continue
19916 111^running
19917
19918 (gdb)
19919 222-exec-interrupt
19920 222^done
19921 (gdb)
19922 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19923 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19924 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19925 (gdb)
19926
19927 (gdb)
19928 -exec-interrupt
19929 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19930 (gdb)
19931 @end smallexample
19932
19933
19934 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19935 @findex -exec-next
19936
19937 @subsubheading Synopsis
19938
19939 @smallexample
19940 -exec-next
19941 @end smallexample
19942
19943 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19944 of the next source line is reached.
19945
19946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19947
19948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19949
19950 @subsubheading Example
19951
19952 @smallexample
19953 -exec-next
19954 ^running
19955 (gdb)
19956 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19957 (gdb)
19958 @end smallexample
19959
19960
19961 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19962 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19963
19964 @subsubheading Synopsis
19965
19966 @smallexample
19967 -exec-next-instruction
19968 @end smallexample
19969
19970 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19971 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19972 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19973 printed as well.
19974
19975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19976
19977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19978
19979 @subsubheading Example
19980
19981 @smallexample
19982 (gdb)
19983 -exec-next-instruction
19984 ^running
19985
19986 (gdb)
19987 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19988 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19989 (gdb)
19990 @end smallexample
19991
19992
19993 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19994 @findex -exec-return
19995
19996 @subsubheading Synopsis
19997
19998 @smallexample
19999 -exec-return
20000 @end smallexample
20001
20002 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
20003 Displays the new current frame.
20004
20005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20006
20007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
20008
20009 @subsubheading Example
20010
20011 @smallexample
20012 (gdb)
20013 200-break-insert callee4
20014 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
20015 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20016 (gdb)
20017 000-exec-run
20018 000^running
20019 (gdb)
20020 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20021 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20022 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20023 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20024 (gdb)
20025 205-break-delete
20026 205^done
20027 (gdb)
20028 111-exec-return
20029 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
20030 args=[@{name="strarg",
20031 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20032 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20033 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20034 (gdb)
20035 @end smallexample
20036
20037
20038 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
20039 @findex -exec-run
20040
20041 @subsubheading Synopsis
20042
20043 @smallexample
20044 -exec-run
20045 @end smallexample
20046
20047 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
20048 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
20049 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
20050 the program has exited exceptionally.
20051
20052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20053
20054 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
20055
20056 @subsubheading Examples
20057
20058 @smallexample
20059 (gdb)
20060 -break-insert main
20061 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20062 (gdb)
20063 -exec-run
20064 ^running
20065 (gdb)
20066 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20067 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20068 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20069 (gdb)
20070 @end smallexample
20071
20072 @noindent
20073 Program exited normally:
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 (gdb)
20077 -exec-run
20078 ^running
20079 (gdb)
20080 x = 55
20081 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20082 (gdb)
20083 @end smallexample
20084
20085 @noindent
20086 Program exited exceptionally:
20087
20088 @smallexample
20089 (gdb)
20090 -exec-run
20091 ^running
20092 (gdb)
20093 x = 55
20094 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
20095 (gdb)
20096 @end smallexample
20097
20098 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
20099 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
20100
20101 @smallexample
20102 (gdb)
20103 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
20104 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
20105 @end smallexample
20106
20107
20108 @c @subheading -exec-signal
20109
20110
20111 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
20112 @findex -exec-step
20113
20114 @subsubheading Synopsis
20115
20116 @smallexample
20117 -exec-step
20118 @end smallexample
20119
20120 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20121 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
20122 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
20123 function.
20124
20125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20126
20127 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
20128
20129 @subsubheading Example
20130
20131 Stepping into a function:
20132
20133 @smallexample
20134 -exec-step
20135 ^running
20136 (gdb)
20137 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20138 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
20139 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
20140 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
20141 (gdb)
20142 @end smallexample
20143
20144 Regular stepping:
20145
20146 @smallexample
20147 -exec-step
20148 ^running
20149 (gdb)
20150 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
20151 (gdb)
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154
20155 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
20156 @findex -exec-step-instruction
20157
20158 @subsubheading Synopsis
20159
20160 @smallexample
20161 -exec-step-instruction
20162 @end smallexample
20163
20164 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
20165 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
20166 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
20167 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
20168 well.
20169
20170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20171
20172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
20173
20174 @subsubheading Example
20175
20176 @smallexample
20177 (gdb)
20178 -exec-step-instruction
20179 ^running
20180
20181 (gdb)
20182 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20183 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20184 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20185 (gdb)
20186 -exec-step-instruction
20187 ^running
20188
20189 (gdb)
20190 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20191 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20192 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20193 (gdb)
20194 @end smallexample
20195
20196
20197 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
20198 @findex -exec-until
20199
20200 @subsubheading Synopsis
20201
20202 @smallexample
20203 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
20204 @end smallexample
20205
20206 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
20207 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
20208 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
20209 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
20210
20211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20212
20213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
20214
20215 @subsubheading Example
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 (gdb)
20219 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
20220 ^running
20221 (gdb)
20222 x = 55
20223 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20224 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
20225 (gdb)
20226 @end smallexample
20227
20228 @ignore
20229 @subheading -file-clear
20230 Is this going away????
20231 @end ignore
20232
20233 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20234 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
20235 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
20236
20237
20238 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
20239 @findex -stack-info-frame
20240
20241 @subsubheading Synopsis
20242
20243 @smallexample
20244 -stack-info-frame
20245 @end smallexample
20246
20247 Get info on the selected frame.
20248
20249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20250
20251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
20252 (without arguments).
20253
20254 @subsubheading Example
20255
20256 @smallexample
20257 (gdb)
20258 -stack-info-frame
20259 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
20260 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20261 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
20262 (gdb)
20263 @end smallexample
20264
20265 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
20266 @findex -stack-info-depth
20267
20268 @subsubheading Synopsis
20269
20270 @smallexample
20271 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
20272 @end smallexample
20273
20274 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
20275 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
20276
20277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20278
20279 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20280
20281 @subsubheading Example
20282
20283 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
20284
20285 @smallexample
20286 (gdb)
20287 -stack-info-depth
20288 ^done,depth="12"
20289 (gdb)
20290 -stack-info-depth 4
20291 ^done,depth="4"
20292 (gdb)
20293 -stack-info-depth 12
20294 ^done,depth="12"
20295 (gdb)
20296 -stack-info-depth 11
20297 ^done,depth="11"
20298 (gdb)
20299 -stack-info-depth 13
20300 ^done,depth="12"
20301 (gdb)
20302 @end smallexample
20303
20304 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
20305 @findex -stack-list-arguments
20306
20307 @subsubheading Synopsis
20308
20309 @smallexample
20310 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
20311 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20312 @end smallexample
20313
20314 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
20315 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
20316 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
20317 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
20318 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
20319 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
20320 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
20321 which case only existing frames will be returned.
20322
20323 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
20324 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
20325 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
20326
20327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20328
20329 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
20330 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
20331 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
20332
20333 @subsubheading Example
20334
20335 @smallexample
20336 (gdb)
20337 -stack-list-frames
20338 ^done,
20339 stack=[
20340 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20341 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20342 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
20343 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
20344 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20345 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
20346 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
20347 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20348 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
20349 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
20350 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20351 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
20352 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
20353 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20354 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
20355 (gdb)
20356 -stack-list-arguments 0
20357 ^done,
20358 stack-args=[
20359 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
20360 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
20361 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
20362 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
20363 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
20364 (gdb)
20365 -stack-list-arguments 1
20366 ^done,
20367 stack-args=[
20368 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
20369 frame=@{level="1",
20370 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
20371 frame=@{level="2",args=[
20372 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20373 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
20374 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
20375 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20376 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
20377 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
20378 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
20379 (gdb)
20380 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
20381 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
20382 (gdb)
20383 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
20384 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
20385 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20386 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
20387 (gdb)
20388 @end smallexample
20389
20390 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
20391
20392
20393 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
20394 @findex -stack-list-frames
20395
20396 @subsubheading Synopsis
20397
20398 @smallexample
20399 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20400 @end smallexample
20401
20402 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
20403 following info:
20404
20405 @table @samp
20406 @item @var{level}
20407 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
20408 @item @var{addr}
20409 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
20410 @item @var{func}
20411 Function name.
20412 @item @var{file}
20413 File name of the source file where the function lives.
20414 @item @var{line}
20415 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
20416 @end table
20417
20418 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
20419 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
20420 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
20421 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
20422 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
20423 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
20424 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
20425
20426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20427
20428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
20429
20430 @subsubheading Example
20431
20432 Full stack backtrace:
20433
20434 @smallexample
20435 (gdb)
20436 -stack-list-frames
20437 ^done,stack=
20438 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
20439 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
20440 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20441 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20442 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20443 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20444 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20445 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20446 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20447 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20448 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20449 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20450 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20451 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20452 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20454 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20455 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20456 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20457 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20458 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20460 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
20461 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
20462 (gdb)
20463 @end smallexample
20464
20465 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
20466
20467 @smallexample
20468 (gdb)
20469 -stack-list-frames 3 5
20470 ^done,stack=
20471 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20472 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20473 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20474 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20475 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20476 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20477 (gdb)
20478 @end smallexample
20479
20480 Show a single frame:
20481
20482 @smallexample
20483 (gdb)
20484 -stack-list-frames 3 3
20485 ^done,stack=
20486 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20487 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20488 (gdb)
20489 @end smallexample
20490
20491
20492 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
20493 @findex -stack-list-locals
20494
20495 @subsubheading Synopsis
20496
20497 @smallexample
20498 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
20499 @end smallexample
20500
20501 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
20502 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
20503 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
20504 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
20505 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
20506 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
20507 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
20508 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
20509 more detail.
20510
20511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20512
20513 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
20514
20515 @subsubheading Example
20516
20517 @smallexample
20518 (gdb)
20519 -stack-list-locals 0
20520 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
20521 (gdb)
20522 -stack-list-locals --all-values
20523 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
20524 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
20525 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
20526 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
20527 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20528 (gdb)
20529 @end smallexample
20530
20531
20532 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20533 @findex -stack-select-frame
20534
20535 @subsubheading Synopsis
20536
20537 @smallexample
20538 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20539 @end smallexample
20540
20541 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20542 the stack.
20543
20544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20545
20546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20547 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20548
20549 @subsubheading Example
20550
20551 @smallexample
20552 (gdb)
20553 -stack-select-frame 2
20554 ^done
20555 (gdb)
20556 @end smallexample
20557
20558 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20559 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20560 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20561
20562 @ignore
20563
20564 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20565
20566 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20567 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20568 used by @code{Insight}.
20569
20570 The two main reasons for that are:
20571
20572 @enumerate 1
20573 @item
20574 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20575
20576 @item
20577 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20578 now).
20579 @end enumerate
20580
20581 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20582 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20583 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20584 hints about their use.
20585
20586 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20587 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20588 least, the following operations:
20589
20590 @itemize @bullet
20591 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20592 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20593 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20594 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20595 @end itemize
20596
20597 @end ignore
20598
20599 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
20600
20601 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20602
20603 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
20604 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
20605 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
20606 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
20607 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
20608 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
20609 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
20610 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
20611 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
20612 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
20613 object, or to change display format.
20614
20615 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
20616 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
20617 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
20618 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
20619 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
20620 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
20621 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
20622 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
20623 child will be created.
20624
20625 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
20626 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
20627 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
20628 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
20629 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
20630
20631 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
20632 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
20633 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
20634 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
20635 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
20636 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
20637 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
20638 variables that frontend has created.
20639
20640 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
20641 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
20642 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
20643 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
20644 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
20645 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
20646 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
20647 implicitly updated.
20648
20649 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20650 access this functionality:
20651
20652 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20653 @item @strong{Operation}
20654 @tab @strong{Description}
20655
20656 @item @code{-var-create}
20657 @tab create a variable object
20658 @item @code{-var-delete}
20659 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20660 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20661 @tab set the display format of this variable
20662 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20663 @tab show the display format of this variable
20664 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20665 @tab tells how many children this object has
20666 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20667 @tab return a list of the object's children
20668 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20669 @tab show the type of this variable object
20670 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20671 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20672 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20673 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20674 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20675 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20676 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20677 @tab get the value of this variable
20678 @item @code{-var-assign}
20679 @tab set the value of this variable
20680 @item @code{-var-update}
20681 @tab update the variable and its children
20682 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20683 @tab set frozeness attribute
20684 @end multitable
20685
20686 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20687 how it can be used.
20688
20689 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20690
20691 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20692 @findex -var-create
20693
20694 @subsubheading Synopsis
20695
20696 @smallexample
20697 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20698 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20699 @end smallexample
20700
20701 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20702 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20703 register.
20704
20705 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20706 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20707 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20708 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20709 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20710
20711 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20712 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20713 frame should be used.
20714
20715 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20716 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20717
20718 @itemize @bullet
20719 @item
20720 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20721
20722 @item
20723 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20724
20725 @item
20726 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20727 @end itemize
20728
20729 @subsubheading Result
20730
20731 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20732 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20733 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20734
20735 @smallexample
20736 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20737 @end smallexample
20738
20739
20740 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20741 @findex -var-delete
20742
20743 @subsubheading Synopsis
20744
20745 @smallexample
20746 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20747 @end smallexample
20748
20749 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20750 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20751
20752 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20753
20754
20755 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20756 @findex -var-set-format
20757
20758 @subsubheading Synopsis
20759
20760 @smallexample
20761 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20762 @end smallexample
20763
20764 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20765 @var{format-spec}.
20766
20767 @anchor{-var-set-format}
20768 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20769
20770 @smallexample
20771 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20772 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20773 @end smallexample
20774
20775 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20776 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20777 for pointers, etc.).
20778
20779 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20780 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20781
20782 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20783 @findex -var-show-format
20784
20785 @subsubheading Synopsis
20786
20787 @smallexample
20788 -var-show-format @var{name}
20789 @end smallexample
20790
20791 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20792
20793 @smallexample
20794 @var{format} @expansion{}
20795 @var{format-spec}
20796 @end smallexample
20797
20798
20799 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20800 @findex -var-info-num-children
20801
20802 @subsubheading Synopsis
20803
20804 @smallexample
20805 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20806 @end smallexample
20807
20808 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20809
20810 @smallexample
20811 numchild=@var{n}
20812 @end smallexample
20813
20814
20815 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20816 @findex -var-list-children
20817
20818 @subsubheading Synopsis
20819
20820 @smallexample
20821 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20822 @end smallexample
20823 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20824
20825 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20826 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20827 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20828 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20829 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20830 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20831 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20832 and unions.
20833
20834 @subsubheading Example
20835
20836 @smallexample
20837 (gdb)
20838 -var-list-children n
20839 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20840 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20841 (gdb)
20842 -var-list-children --all-values n
20843 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20844 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20845 @end smallexample
20846
20847
20848 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20849 @findex -var-info-type
20850
20851 @subsubheading Synopsis
20852
20853 @smallexample
20854 -var-info-type @var{name}
20855 @end smallexample
20856
20857 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20858 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20859 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20860
20861 @smallexample
20862 type=@var{typename}
20863 @end smallexample
20864
20865
20866 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20867 @findex -var-info-expression
20868
20869 @subsubheading Synopsis
20870
20871 @smallexample
20872 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20873 @end smallexample
20874
20875 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20876 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20877 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20878
20879 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20880 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20881
20882 @smallexample
20883 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20884 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20885 @end smallexample
20886
20887 @noindent
20888 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20889
20890 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20891 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20892 is of limited use.
20893
20894 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20895 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20896
20897 @subsubheading Synopsis
20898
20899 @smallexample
20900 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20904 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20905 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20906 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20907 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20908 watchpoint from a variable object.
20909
20910 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20911 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20912 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20913 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20914 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20915 @smallexample
20916 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20917 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20918 @end smallexample
20919
20920 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20921 @findex -var-show-attributes
20922
20923 @subsubheading Synopsis
20924
20925 @smallexample
20926 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20927 @end smallexample
20928
20929 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20930
20931 @smallexample
20932 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20933 @end smallexample
20934
20935 @noindent
20936 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20937
20938 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20939 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20940
20941 @subsubheading Synopsis
20942
20943 @smallexample
20944 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20945 @end smallexample
20946
20947 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20948 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20949 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20950 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20951 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20952 the current display format will be used. The current display format
20953 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20954
20955 @smallexample
20956 value=@var{value}
20957 @end smallexample
20958
20959 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20960 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20961
20962 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20963 @findex -var-assign
20964
20965 @subsubheading Synopsis
20966
20967 @smallexample
20968 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20969 @end smallexample
20970
20971 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20972 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20973 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20974 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20975
20976 @subsubheading Example
20977
20978 @smallexample
20979 (gdb)
20980 -var-assign var1 3
20981 ^done,value="3"
20982 (gdb)
20983 -var-update *
20984 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20985 (gdb)
20986 @end smallexample
20987
20988 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20989 @findex -var-update
20990
20991 @subsubheading Synopsis
20992
20993 @smallexample
20994 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20995 @end smallexample
20996
20997 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20998 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20999 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
21000 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
21001 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
21002 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
21003 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
21004 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
21005 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
21006 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
21007 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
21008 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
21009 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
21010
21011
21012 @subsubheading Example
21013
21014 @smallexample
21015 (gdb)
21016 -var-assign var1 3
21017 ^done,value="3"
21018 (gdb)
21019 -var-update --all-values var1
21020 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
21021 type_changed="false"@}]
21022 (gdb)
21023 @end smallexample
21024
21025 @anchor{-var-update}
21026 The field in_scope may take three values:
21027
21028 @table @code
21029 @item "true"
21030 The variable object's current value is valid.
21031
21032 @item "false"
21033 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
21034 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
21035 scope.
21036
21037 @item "invalid"
21038 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
21039 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
21040 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
21041 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
21042 objects.
21043 @end table
21044
21045 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
21046 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
21047
21048 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
21049 @findex -var-set-frozen
21050 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
21051
21052 @subsubheading Synopsis
21053
21054 @smallexample
21055 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
21056 @end smallexample
21057
21058 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
21059 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
21060 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
21061 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
21062 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
21063 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
21064 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
21065 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
21066 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
21067 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
21068 @code{-var-update} does.
21069
21070 @subsubheading Example
21071
21072 @smallexample
21073 (gdb)
21074 -var-set-frozen V 1
21075 ^done
21076 (gdb)
21077 @end smallexample
21078
21079
21080 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21081 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
21082 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
21083
21084 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
21085 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
21086 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
21087 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
21088
21089 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
21090 @c @subheading -data-assign
21091 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
21092 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
21093 @c set variable
21094 @c @subsubheading Example
21095 @c N.A.
21096
21097 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
21098 @findex -data-disassemble
21099
21100 @subsubheading Synopsis
21101
21102 @smallexample
21103 -data-disassemble
21104 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
21105 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
21106 -- @var{mode}
21107 @end smallexample
21108
21109 @noindent
21110 Where:
21111
21112 @table @samp
21113 @item @var{start-addr}
21114 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
21115 @item @var{end-addr}
21116 is the end address
21117 @item @var{filename}
21118 is the name of the file to disassemble
21119 @item @var{linenum}
21120 is the line number to disassemble around
21121 @item @var{lines}
21122 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
21123 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
21124 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
21125 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
21126 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
21127 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
21128 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
21129 are displayed.
21130 @item @var{mode}
21131 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
21132 disassembly).
21133 @end table
21134
21135 @subsubheading Result
21136
21137 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
21138
21139 @itemize @bullet
21140 @item Address
21141 @item Func-name
21142 @item Offset
21143 @item Instruction
21144 @end itemize
21145
21146 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
21147 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
21148
21149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21150
21151 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
21152
21153 @subsubheading Example
21154
21155 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
21156
21157 @smallexample
21158 (gdb)
21159 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
21160 ^done,
21161 asm_insns=[
21162 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21163 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21164 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21165 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21166 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
21167 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
21168 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
21169 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21170 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
21171 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
21172 (gdb)
21173 @end smallexample
21174
21175 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
21176 @code{main}.
21177
21178 @smallexample
21179 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
21180 ^done,asm_insns=[
21181 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21182 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21183 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21184 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21185 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21186 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21187 [@dots{}]
21188 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
21189 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
21190 (gdb)
21191 @end smallexample
21192
21193 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 (gdb)
21197 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
21198 ^done,asm_insns=[
21199 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21200 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21201 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21202 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21203 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21204 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
21205 (gdb)
21206 @end smallexample
21207
21208 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
21209
21210 @smallexample
21211 (gdb)
21212 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
21213 ^done,asm_insns=[
21214 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
21215 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
21216 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
21217 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21218 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
21219 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
21220 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
21221 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
21222 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21223 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21224 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21225 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
21226 (gdb)
21227 @end smallexample
21228
21229
21230 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
21231 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
21232
21233 @subsubheading Synopsis
21234
21235 @smallexample
21236 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
21237 @end smallexample
21238
21239 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
21240 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
21241 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
21242
21243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21244
21245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
21246 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
21247 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
21248
21249 @subsubheading Example
21250
21251 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
21252 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
21253 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
21254 output.
21255
21256 @smallexample
21257 211-data-evaluate-expression A
21258 211^done,value="1"
21259 (gdb)
21260 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
21261 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
21262 (gdb)
21263 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
21264 411^done,value="4"
21265 (gdb)
21266 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
21267 511^done,value="4"
21268 (gdb)
21269 @end smallexample
21270
21271
21272 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
21273 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
21274
21275 @subsubheading Synopsis
21276
21277 @smallexample
21278 -data-list-changed-registers
21279 @end smallexample
21280
21281 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
21282
21283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21284
21285 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
21286 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
21287
21288 @subsubheading Example
21289
21290 On a PPC MBX board:
21291
21292 @smallexample
21293 (gdb)
21294 -exec-continue
21295 ^running
21296
21297 (gdb)
21298 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
21299 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
21300 line="5"@}
21301 (gdb)
21302 -data-list-changed-registers
21303 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
21304 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
21305 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
21306 (gdb)
21307 @end smallexample
21308
21309
21310 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
21311 @findex -data-list-register-names
21312
21313 @subsubheading Synopsis
21314
21315 @smallexample
21316 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
21317 @end smallexample
21318
21319 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
21320 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
21321 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
21322 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
21323 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
21324 include empty register names.
21325
21326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21327
21328 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
21329 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
21330 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
21331
21332 @subsubheading Example
21333
21334 For the PPC MBX board:
21335 @smallexample
21336 (gdb)
21337 -data-list-register-names
21338 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
21339 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
21340 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
21341 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
21342 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
21343 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
21344 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
21345 (gdb)
21346 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
21347 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
21348 (gdb)
21349 @end smallexample
21350
21351 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
21352 @findex -data-list-register-values
21353
21354 @subsubheading Synopsis
21355
21356 @smallexample
21357 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
21358 @end smallexample
21359
21360 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
21361 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
21362 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
21363 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
21364
21365 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
21366
21367 @table @code
21368 @item x
21369 Hexadecimal
21370 @item o
21371 Octal
21372 @item t
21373 Binary
21374 @item d
21375 Decimal
21376 @item r
21377 Raw
21378 @item N
21379 Natural
21380 @end table
21381
21382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21383
21384 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
21385 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
21386
21387 @subsubheading Example
21388
21389 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
21390 don't appear in the actual output):
21391
21392 @smallexample
21393 (gdb)
21394 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
21395 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21396 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
21397 (gdb)
21398 -data-list-register-values x
21399 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
21400 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21401 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
21402 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
21403 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
21404 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
21405 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
21406 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
21407 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
21408 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21409 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
21410 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
21411 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
21412 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
21413 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
21414 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
21415 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
21416 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
21417 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
21418 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
21419 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
21420 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
21421 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
21422 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
21423 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
21424 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
21425 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
21426 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
21427 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
21428 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
21429 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
21430 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
21431 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21432 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
21433 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
21434 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
21435 (gdb)
21436 @end smallexample
21437
21438
21439 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
21440 @findex -data-read-memory
21441
21442 @subsubheading Synopsis
21443
21444 @smallexample
21445 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
21446 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
21447 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
21448 @end smallexample
21449
21450 @noindent
21451 where:
21452
21453 @table @samp
21454 @item @var{address}
21455 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
21456 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
21457 quoted using the C convention.
21458
21459 @item @var{word-format}
21460 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
21461 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
21462 ,Output Formats}).
21463
21464 @item @var{word-size}
21465 The size of each memory word in bytes.
21466
21467 @item @var{nr-rows}
21468 The number of rows in the output table.
21469
21470 @item @var{nr-cols}
21471 The number of columns in the output table.
21472
21473 @item @var{aschar}
21474 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
21475 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
21476 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
21477 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
21478
21479 @item @var{byte-offset}
21480 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
21481 @end table
21482
21483 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
21484 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
21485 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
21486 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
21487 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
21488 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
21489 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
21490 @samp{addr}.
21491
21492 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
21493 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
21494 @samp{prev-page}.
21495
21496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21497
21498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
21499 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
21500
21501 @subsubheading Example
21502
21503 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
21504 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
21505 word. Display each word in hex.
21506
21507 @smallexample
21508 (gdb)
21509 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
21510 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
21511 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
21512 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
21513 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
21514 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
21515 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
21516 (gdb)
21517 @end smallexample
21518
21519 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
21520 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
21521
21522 @smallexample
21523 (gdb)
21524 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
21525 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
21526 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
21527 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
21528 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
21529 (gdb)
21530 @end smallexample
21531
21532 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
21533 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
21534 used as the non-printable character.
21535
21536 @smallexample
21537 (gdb)
21538 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
21539 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
21540 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
21541 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
21542 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21543 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21544 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21545 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21546 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
21547 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
21548 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
21549 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
21550 (gdb)
21551 @end smallexample
21552
21553 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21554 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
21555 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
21556
21557 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
21558
21559 @c @subheading -trace-actions
21560
21561 @c @subheading -trace-delete
21562
21563 @c @subheading -trace-disable
21564
21565 @c @subheading -trace-dump
21566
21567 @c @subheading -trace-enable
21568
21569 @c @subheading -trace-exists
21570
21571 @c @subheading -trace-find
21572
21573 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
21574
21575 @c @subheading -trace-info
21576
21577 @c @subheading -trace-insert
21578
21579 @c @subheading -trace-list
21580
21581 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
21582
21583 @c @subheading -trace-save
21584
21585 @c @subheading -trace-start
21586
21587 @c @subheading -trace-stop
21588
21589
21590 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21591 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
21592 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
21593
21594
21595 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
21596 @findex -symbol-info-address
21597
21598 @subsubheading Synopsis
21599
21600 @smallexample
21601 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
21602 @end smallexample
21603
21604 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
21605
21606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21607
21608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
21609
21610 @subsubheading Example
21611 N.A.
21612
21613
21614 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
21615 @findex -symbol-info-file
21616
21617 @subsubheading Synopsis
21618
21619 @smallexample
21620 -symbol-info-file
21621 @end smallexample
21622
21623 Show the file for the symbol.
21624
21625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21626
21627 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
21628 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
21629
21630 @subsubheading Example
21631 N.A.
21632
21633
21634 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
21635 @findex -symbol-info-function
21636
21637 @subsubheading Synopsis
21638
21639 @smallexample
21640 -symbol-info-function
21641 @end smallexample
21642
21643 Show which function the symbol lives in.
21644
21645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21646
21647 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
21648
21649 @subsubheading Example
21650 N.A.
21651
21652
21653 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21654 @findex -symbol-info-line
21655
21656 @subsubheading Synopsis
21657
21658 @smallexample
21659 -symbol-info-line
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21663
21664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21665
21666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21667 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21668
21669 @subsubheading Example
21670 N.A.
21671
21672
21673 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21674 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
21675
21676 @subsubheading Synopsis
21677
21678 @smallexample
21679 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21680 @end smallexample
21681
21682 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21683
21684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21685
21686 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21687
21688 @subsubheading Example
21689 N.A.
21690
21691
21692 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21693 @findex -symbol-list-functions
21694
21695 @subsubheading Synopsis
21696
21697 @smallexample
21698 -symbol-list-functions
21699 @end smallexample
21700
21701 List the functions in the executable.
21702
21703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21704
21705 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21706 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21707
21708 @subsubheading Example
21709 N.A.
21710
21711
21712 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21713 @findex -symbol-list-lines
21714
21715 @subsubheading Synopsis
21716
21717 @smallexample
21718 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21719 @end smallexample
21720
21721 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21722 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21723 ascending PC order.
21724
21725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21726
21727 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21728
21729 @subsubheading Example
21730 @smallexample
21731 (gdb)
21732 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
21733 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21734 (gdb)
21735 @end smallexample
21736
21737
21738 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21739 @findex -symbol-list-types
21740
21741 @subsubheading Synopsis
21742
21743 @smallexample
21744 -symbol-list-types
21745 @end smallexample
21746
21747 List all the type names.
21748
21749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21750
21751 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21752 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21753
21754 @subsubheading Example
21755 N.A.
21756
21757
21758 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21759 @findex -symbol-list-variables
21760
21761 @subsubheading Synopsis
21762
21763 @smallexample
21764 -symbol-list-variables
21765 @end smallexample
21766
21767 List all the global and static variable names.
21768
21769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21770
21771 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21772
21773 @subsubheading Example
21774 N.A.
21775
21776
21777 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21778 @findex -symbol-locate
21779
21780 @subsubheading Synopsis
21781
21782 @smallexample
21783 -symbol-locate
21784 @end smallexample
21785
21786 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21787
21788 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21789
21790 @subsubheading Example
21791 N.A.
21792
21793
21794 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21795 @findex -symbol-type
21796
21797 @subsubheading Synopsis
21798
21799 @smallexample
21800 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21801 @end smallexample
21802
21803 Show type of @var{variable}.
21804
21805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21806
21807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21808 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21809
21810 @subsubheading Example
21811 N.A.
21812
21813
21814 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21815 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21816 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21817
21818 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21819 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21820
21821 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21822 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21823
21824 @subsubheading Synopsis
21825
21826 @smallexample
21827 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21828 @end smallexample
21829
21830 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21831 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21832 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21833 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21834 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21835 notification.
21836
21837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21838
21839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21840
21841 @subsubheading Example
21842
21843 @smallexample
21844 (gdb)
21845 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21846 ^done
21847 (gdb)
21848 @end smallexample
21849
21850
21851 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21852 @findex -file-exec-file
21853
21854 @subsubheading Synopsis
21855
21856 @smallexample
21857 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21858 @end smallexample
21859
21860 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21861 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21862 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21863 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21864 notification.
21865
21866 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21867
21868 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21869
21870 @subsubheading Example
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 (gdb)
21874 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21875 ^done
21876 (gdb)
21877 @end smallexample
21878
21879
21880 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21881 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21882
21883 @subsubheading Synopsis
21884
21885 @smallexample
21886 -file-list-exec-sections
21887 @end smallexample
21888
21889 List the sections of the current executable file.
21890
21891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21892
21893 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21894 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21895 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21896
21897 @subsubheading Example
21898 N.A.
21899
21900
21901 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21902 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21903
21904 @subsubheading Synopsis
21905
21906 @smallexample
21907 -file-list-exec-source-file
21908 @end smallexample
21909
21910 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21911 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21912 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21913 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21914
21915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21916
21917 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21918
21919 @subsubheading Example
21920
21921 @smallexample
21922 (gdb)
21923 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21924 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21925 (gdb)
21926 @end smallexample
21927
21928
21929 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21930 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21931
21932 @subsubheading Synopsis
21933
21934 @smallexample
21935 -file-list-exec-source-files
21936 @end smallexample
21937
21938 List the source files for the current executable.
21939
21940 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21941 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21942
21943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21944
21945 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21946 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21947
21948 @subsubheading Example
21949 @smallexample
21950 (gdb)
21951 -file-list-exec-source-files
21952 ^done,files=[
21953 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21954 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21955 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21956 (gdb)
21957 @end smallexample
21958
21959 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21960 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21961
21962 @subsubheading Synopsis
21963
21964 @smallexample
21965 -file-list-shared-libraries
21966 @end smallexample
21967
21968 List the shared libraries in the program.
21969
21970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21971
21972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21973
21974 @subsubheading Example
21975 N.A.
21976
21977
21978 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21979 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21980
21981 @subsubheading Synopsis
21982
21983 @smallexample
21984 -file-list-symbol-files
21985 @end smallexample
21986
21987 List symbol files.
21988
21989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21990
21991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21992
21993 @subsubheading Example
21994 N.A.
21995
21996
21997 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21998 @findex -file-symbol-file
21999
22000 @subsubheading Synopsis
22001
22002 @smallexample
22003 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
22004 @end smallexample
22005
22006 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
22007 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
22008 produced, except for a completion notification.
22009
22010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22011
22012 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
22013
22014 @subsubheading Example
22015
22016 @smallexample
22017 (gdb)
22018 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22019 ^done
22020 (gdb)
22021 @end smallexample
22022
22023 @ignore
22024 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22025 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
22026 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
22027
22028 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
22029
22030 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
22031
22032 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
22033
22034 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
22035
22036 @c @subheading -overlay-map
22037
22038 @c @subheading -overlay-off
22039
22040 @c @subheading -overlay-on
22041
22042 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
22043
22044 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22045 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
22046 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
22047
22048 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
22049
22050 @c @subheading -signal-handle
22051
22052 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
22053
22054 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
22055 @end ignore
22056
22057
22058 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22059 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
22060 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
22061
22062
22063 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
22064 @findex -target-attach
22065
22066 @subsubheading Synopsis
22067
22068 @smallexample
22069 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
22073
22074 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22075
22076 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
22077
22078 @subsubheading Example
22079 @smallexample
22080 (gdb)
22081 -target-attach 34
22082 =thread-created,id="1"
22083 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
22084 ^done
22085 (gdb)
22086 @end smallexample
22087
22088 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
22089 @findex -target-compare-sections
22090
22091 @subsubheading Synopsis
22092
22093 @smallexample
22094 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
22095 @end smallexample
22096
22097 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
22098 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
22099
22100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22101
22102 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
22103
22104 @subsubheading Example
22105 N.A.
22106
22107
22108 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
22109 @findex -target-detach
22110
22111 @subsubheading Synopsis
22112
22113 @smallexample
22114 -target-detach
22115 @end smallexample
22116
22117 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
22118 There's no output.
22119
22120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22121
22122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
22123
22124 @subsubheading Example
22125
22126 @smallexample
22127 (gdb)
22128 -target-detach
22129 ^done
22130 (gdb)
22131 @end smallexample
22132
22133
22134 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
22135 @findex -target-disconnect
22136
22137 @subsubheading Synopsis
22138
22139 @smallexample
22140 -target-disconnect
22141 @end smallexample
22142
22143 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
22144 generally not resumed.
22145
22146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22147
22148 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
22149
22150 @subsubheading Example
22151
22152 @smallexample
22153 (gdb)
22154 -target-disconnect
22155 ^done
22156 (gdb)
22157 @end smallexample
22158
22159
22160 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
22161 @findex -target-download
22162
22163 @subsubheading Synopsis
22164
22165 @smallexample
22166 -target-download
22167 @end smallexample
22168
22169 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
22170 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
22171
22172 @table @samp
22173 @item section
22174 The name of the section.
22175 @item section-sent
22176 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
22177 @item section-size
22178 The size of the section.
22179 @item total-sent
22180 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
22181 @item total-size
22182 The size of the overall executable to download.
22183 @end table
22184
22185 @noindent
22186 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
22187 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
22188
22189 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
22190 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
22191
22192 @table @samp
22193 @item section
22194 The name of the section.
22195 @item section-size
22196 The size of the section.
22197 @item total-size
22198 The size of the overall executable to download.
22199 @end table
22200
22201 @noindent
22202 At the end, a summary is printed.
22203
22204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22205
22206 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
22207
22208 @subsubheading Example
22209
22210 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
22211 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
22212
22213 @smallexample
22214 (gdb)
22215 -target-download
22216 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
22217 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
22218 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
22219 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
22220 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
22221 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
22222 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
22223 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
22224 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
22225 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
22226 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
22227 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
22228 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
22229 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
22230 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
22231 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
22232 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
22233 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
22234 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
22235 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
22236 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
22237 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
22238 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
22239 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
22240 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
22241 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
22242 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
22243 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
22244 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
22245 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
22246 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
22247 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
22248 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
22249 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
22250 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
22251 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
22252 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
22253 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
22254 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
22255 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
22256 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
22257 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
22258 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
22259 write-rate="429"
22260 (gdb)
22261 @end smallexample
22262
22263
22264 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
22265 @findex -target-exec-status
22266
22267 @subsubheading Synopsis
22268
22269 @smallexample
22270 -target-exec-status
22271 @end smallexample
22272
22273 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
22274 not, for instance).
22275
22276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22277
22278 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
22279
22280 @subsubheading Example
22281 N.A.
22282
22283
22284 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
22285 @findex -target-list-available-targets
22286
22287 @subsubheading Synopsis
22288
22289 @smallexample
22290 -target-list-available-targets
22291 @end smallexample
22292
22293 List the possible targets to connect to.
22294
22295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22296
22297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
22298
22299 @subsubheading Example
22300 N.A.
22301
22302
22303 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
22304 @findex -target-list-current-targets
22305
22306 @subsubheading Synopsis
22307
22308 @smallexample
22309 -target-list-current-targets
22310 @end smallexample
22311
22312 Describe the current target.
22313
22314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22315
22316 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
22317 other things).
22318
22319 @subsubheading Example
22320 N.A.
22321
22322
22323 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
22324 @findex -target-list-parameters
22325
22326 @subsubheading Synopsis
22327
22328 @smallexample
22329 -target-list-parameters
22330 @end smallexample
22331
22332 @c ????
22333
22334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22335
22336 No equivalent.
22337
22338 @subsubheading Example
22339 N.A.
22340
22341
22342 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
22343 @findex -target-select
22344
22345 @subsubheading Synopsis
22346
22347 @smallexample
22348 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
22349 @end smallexample
22350
22351 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
22352
22353 @table @samp
22354 @item @var{type}
22355 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
22356 @item @var{parameters}
22357 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
22358 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
22359 @end table
22360
22361 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
22362 which the target program is, in the following form:
22363
22364 @smallexample
22365 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
22366 args=[@var{arg list}]
22367 @end smallexample
22368
22369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22370
22371 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
22372
22373 @subsubheading Example
22374
22375 @smallexample
22376 (gdb)
22377 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
22378 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
22379 (gdb)
22380 @end smallexample
22381
22382 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22383 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
22384 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
22385
22386
22387 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
22388 @findex -target-file-put
22389
22390 @subsubheading Synopsis
22391
22392 @smallexample
22393 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
22394 @end smallexample
22395
22396 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
22397 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
22398
22399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22400
22401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
22402
22403 @subsubheading Example
22404
22405 @smallexample
22406 (gdb)
22407 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
22408 ^done
22409 (gdb)
22410 @end smallexample
22411
22412
22413 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
22414 @findex -target-file-get
22415
22416 @subsubheading Synopsis
22417
22418 @smallexample
22419 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
22420 @end smallexample
22421
22422 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
22423 on the host system.
22424
22425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22426
22427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
22428
22429 @subsubheading Example
22430
22431 @smallexample
22432 (gdb)
22433 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
22434 ^done
22435 (gdb)
22436 @end smallexample
22437
22438
22439 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
22440 @findex -target-file-delete
22441
22442 @subsubheading Synopsis
22443
22444 @smallexample
22445 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
22446 @end smallexample
22447
22448 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
22449
22450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22451
22452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
22453
22454 @subsubheading Example
22455
22456 @smallexample
22457 (gdb)
22458 -target-file-delete remotefile
22459 ^done
22460 (gdb)
22461 @end smallexample
22462
22463
22464 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22465 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
22466 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
22467
22468 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
22469
22470 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
22471 @findex -gdb-exit
22472
22473 @subsubheading Synopsis
22474
22475 @smallexample
22476 -gdb-exit
22477 @end smallexample
22478
22479 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
22480
22481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22482
22483 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
22484
22485 @subsubheading Example
22486
22487 @smallexample
22488 (gdb)
22489 -gdb-exit
22490 ^exit
22491 @end smallexample
22492
22493
22494 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
22495 @findex -exec-abort
22496
22497 @subsubheading Synopsis
22498
22499 @smallexample
22500 -exec-abort
22501 @end smallexample
22502
22503 Kill the inferior running program.
22504
22505 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22506
22507 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
22508
22509 @subsubheading Example
22510 N.A.
22511
22512
22513 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
22514 @findex -gdb-set
22515
22516 @subsubheading Synopsis
22517
22518 @smallexample
22519 -gdb-set
22520 @end smallexample
22521
22522 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
22523 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
22524
22525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22526
22527 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
22528
22529 @subsubheading Example
22530
22531 @smallexample
22532 (gdb)
22533 -gdb-set $foo=3
22534 ^done
22535 (gdb)
22536 @end smallexample
22537
22538
22539 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
22540 @findex -gdb-show
22541
22542 @subsubheading Synopsis
22543
22544 @smallexample
22545 -gdb-show
22546 @end smallexample
22547
22548 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
22549
22550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22551
22552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
22553
22554 @subsubheading Example
22555
22556 @smallexample
22557 (gdb)
22558 -gdb-show annotate
22559 ^done,value="0"
22560 (gdb)
22561 @end smallexample
22562
22563 @c @subheading -gdb-source
22564
22565
22566 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
22567 @findex -gdb-version
22568
22569 @subsubheading Synopsis
22570
22571 @smallexample
22572 -gdb-version
22573 @end smallexample
22574
22575 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
22576
22577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22578
22579 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
22580 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
22581
22582 @subsubheading Example
22583
22584 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
22585 @c box in TeX.
22586 @smallexample
22587 (gdb)
22588 -gdb-version
22589 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
22590 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22591 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
22592 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
22593 ~ certain conditions.
22594 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22595 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
22596 ~ details.
22597 ~This GDB was configured as
22598 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
22599 ^done
22600 (gdb)
22601 @end smallexample
22602
22603 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
22604 @findex -list-features
22605
22606 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
22607 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
22608 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
22609 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
22610 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
22611 startup.
22612
22613 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
22614 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
22615 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
22616 is given below.
22617
22618 Example output:
22619
22620 @smallexample
22621 (gdb) -list-features
22622 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
22623 @end smallexample
22624
22625 The current list of features is:
22626
22627 @itemize @minus
22628 @item
22629 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
22630 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
22631 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
22632 @item
22633 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
22634 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
22635 @item
22636 @samp{thread-info}---indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
22637
22638 @end itemize
22639
22640 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
22641 @findex -interpreter-exec
22642
22643 @subheading Synopsis
22644
22645 @smallexample
22646 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
22647 @end smallexample
22648 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
22649
22650 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
22651
22652 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22653
22654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
22655
22656 @subheading Example
22657
22658 @smallexample
22659 (gdb)
22660 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
22661 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22662 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22663 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22664 ^done
22665 (gdb)
22666 @end smallexample
22667
22668 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22669 @findex -inferior-tty-set
22670
22671 @subheading Synopsis
22672
22673 @smallexample
22674 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22675 @end smallexample
22676
22677 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22678
22679 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22680
22681 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22682
22683 @subheading Example
22684
22685 @smallexample
22686 (gdb)
22687 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22688 ^done
22689 (gdb)
22690 @end smallexample
22691
22692 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22693 @findex -inferior-tty-show
22694
22695 @subheading Synopsis
22696
22697 @smallexample
22698 -inferior-tty-show
22699 @end smallexample
22700
22701 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22702
22703 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22704
22705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22706
22707 @subheading Example
22708
22709 @smallexample
22710 (gdb)
22711 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22712 ^done
22713 (gdb)
22714 -inferior-tty-show
22715 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22716 (gdb)
22717 @end smallexample
22718
22719 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22720 @findex -enable-timings
22721
22722 @subheading Synopsis
22723
22724 @smallexample
22725 -enable-timings [yes | no]
22726 @end smallexample
22727
22728 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22729 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22730 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22731 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22732
22733 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22734
22735 No equivalent.
22736
22737 @subheading Example
22738
22739 @smallexample
22740 (gdb)
22741 -enable-timings
22742 ^done
22743 (gdb)
22744 -break-insert main
22745 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22746 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22747 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22748 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22749 (gdb)
22750 -enable-timings no
22751 ^done
22752 (gdb)
22753 -exec-run
22754 ^running
22755 (gdb)
22756 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22757 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22758 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22759 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22760 (gdb)
22761 @end smallexample
22762
22763 @node Annotations
22764 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22765
22766 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22767 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22768 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22769 relatively high level.
22770
22771 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22772 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22773
22774 @ignore
22775 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22776 @end ignore
22777
22778 @menu
22779 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22780 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22781 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22782 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22783 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22784 * Annotations for Running::
22785 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22786 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22787 @end menu
22788
22789 @node Annotations Overview
22790 @section What is an Annotation?
22791 @cindex annotations
22792
22793 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22794 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22795 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22796 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22797 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22798 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22799 cannot contain newline characters.
22800
22801 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22802 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22803 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22804 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22805 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22806 means those three characters as output.
22807
22808 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22809 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22810 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22811 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22812 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22813 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22814 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22815 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22816 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22817
22818 @table @code
22819 @kindex set annotate
22820 @item set annotate @var{level}
22821 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22822 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22823
22824 @item show annotate
22825 @kindex show annotate
22826 Show the current annotation level.
22827 @end table
22828
22829 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22830
22831 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22832
22833 @smallexample
22834 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22835 GNU gdb 6.0
22836 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22837 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22838 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22839 under certain conditions.
22840 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22841 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22842 for details.
22843 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22844
22845 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22846 (@value{GDBP})
22847 ^Z^Zprompt
22848 @kbd{quit}
22849
22850 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22851 $
22852 @end smallexample
22853
22854 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22855 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22856 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22857 output from @value{GDBN}.
22858
22859 @node Server Prefix
22860 @section The Server Prefix
22861 @cindex server prefix
22862
22863 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22864 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22865 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22866 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22867 a transparent manner.
22868
22869 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22870 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22871 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22872
22873 @node Prompting
22874 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22875
22876 @cindex annotations for prompts
22877 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22878 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22879 over, etc.
22880
22881 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22882 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22883 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22884 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22885 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22886 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22887 features the following annotations:
22888
22889 @smallexample
22890 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22891 ^Z^Zprompt
22892 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22893 @end smallexample
22894
22895 The input types are
22896
22897 @table @code
22898 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22899 @findex prompt annotation
22900 @findex post-prompt annotation
22901 @item prompt
22902 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22903
22904 @findex pre-commands annotation
22905 @findex commands annotation
22906 @findex post-commands annotation
22907 @item commands
22908 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22909 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22910
22911 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22912 @findex overload-choice annotation
22913 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22914 @item overload-choice
22915 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22916
22917 @findex pre-query annotation
22918 @findex query annotation
22919 @findex post-query annotation
22920 @item query
22921 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22922
22923 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22924 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22925 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22926 @item prompt-for-continue
22927 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22928 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22929 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22930 presence of annotations.
22931 @end table
22932
22933 @node Errors
22934 @section Errors
22935 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22936
22937 @findex quit annotation
22938 @smallexample
22939 ^Z^Zquit
22940 @end smallexample
22941
22942 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22943
22944 @findex error annotation
22945 @smallexample
22946 ^Z^Zerror
22947 @end smallexample
22948
22949 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22950
22951 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22952 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22953 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22954 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22955 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22956 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22957 to the top level.
22958
22959 @findex error-begin annotation
22960 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22961
22962 @smallexample
22963 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22964 @end smallexample
22965
22966 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22967 message.
22968
22969 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22970 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22971 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22972
22973 @node Invalidation
22974 @section Invalidation Notices
22975
22976 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22977 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22978 changed.
22979
22980 @table @code
22981 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22982 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22983
22984 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22985 have changed.
22986
22987 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22988 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22989
22990 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22991 deleted a breakpoint.
22992 @end table
22993
22994 @node Annotations for Running
22995 @section Running the Program
22996 @cindex annotations for running programs
22997
22998 @findex starting annotation
22999 @findex stopping annotation
23000 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
23001 @code{step} or @code{continue},
23002
23003 @smallexample
23004 ^Z^Zstarting
23005 @end smallexample
23006
23007 is output. When the program stops,
23008
23009 @smallexample
23010 ^Z^Zstopped
23011 @end smallexample
23012
23013 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
23014 annotations describe how the program stopped.
23015
23016 @table @code
23017 @findex exited annotation
23018 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
23019 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
23020 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
23021
23022 @findex signalled annotation
23023 @findex signal-name annotation
23024 @findex signal-name-end annotation
23025 @findex signal-string annotation
23026 @findex signal-string-end annotation
23027 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
23028 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
23029 annotation continues:
23030
23031 @smallexample
23032 @var{intro-text}
23033 ^Z^Zsignal-name
23034 @var{name}
23035 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
23036 @var{middle-text}
23037 ^Z^Zsignal-string
23038 @var{string}
23039 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
23040 @var{end-text}
23041 @end smallexample
23042
23043 @noindent
23044 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
23045 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
23046 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
23047 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
23048 user's benefit and have no particular format.
23049
23050 @findex signal annotation
23051 @item ^Z^Zsignal
23052 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
23053 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
23054 terminated with it.
23055
23056 @findex breakpoint annotation
23057 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
23058 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
23059
23060 @findex watchpoint annotation
23061 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
23062 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
23063 @end table
23064
23065 @node Source Annotations
23066 @section Displaying Source
23067 @cindex annotations for source display
23068
23069 @findex source annotation
23070 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
23071
23072 @smallexample
23073 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
23074 @end smallexample
23075
23076 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
23077 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
23078 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
23079 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
23080 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
23081 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
23082 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
23083 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
23084 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
23085 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
23086 depend on the language).
23087
23088 @node GDB Bugs
23089 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
23090 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
23091 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
23092
23093 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
23094
23095 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
23096 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
23097 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
23098 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
23099
23100 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
23101 information that enables us to fix the bug.
23102
23103 @menu
23104 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
23105 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
23106 @end menu
23107
23108 @node Bug Criteria
23109 @section Have You Found a Bug?
23110 @cindex bug criteria
23111
23112 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
23113
23114 @itemize @bullet
23115 @cindex fatal signal
23116 @cindex debugger crash
23117 @cindex crash of debugger
23118 @item
23119 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
23120 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
23121
23122 @cindex error on valid input
23123 @item
23124 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
23125 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
23126 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
23127
23128 @cindex invalid input
23129 @item
23130 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
23131 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
23132 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
23133 for traditional practice''.
23134
23135 @item
23136 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
23137 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
23138 @end itemize
23139
23140 @node Bug Reporting
23141 @section How to Report Bugs
23142 @cindex bug reports
23143 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
23144
23145 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
23146 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
23147 contact that organization first.
23148
23149 You can find contact information for many support companies and
23150 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
23151 distribution.
23152 @c should add a web page ref...
23153
23154 @ifset BUGURL
23155 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
23156 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
23157 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
23158 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
23159 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
23160 be used.
23161
23162 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
23163 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
23164 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
23165 @samp{bug-gdb}.
23166
23167 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
23168 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
23169 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
23170 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
23171 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
23172 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
23173 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
23174 bug reports to the mailing list.
23175 @end ifset
23176 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
23177 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
23178 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
23179 @end ifclear
23180 @end ifset
23181
23182 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
23183 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
23184 fact or leave it out, state it!
23185
23186 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
23187 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
23188 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
23189 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
23190 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
23191 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
23192 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
23193 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
23194 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
23195
23196 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
23197 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
23198 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
23199 self-contained.
23200
23201 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
23202 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
23203 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
23204 bugs properly.
23205
23206 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
23207
23208 @itemize @bullet
23209 @item
23210 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
23211 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
23212 version}.
23213
23214 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
23215 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
23216
23217 @item
23218 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
23219 version number.
23220
23221 @item
23222 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
23223 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
23224
23225 @item
23226 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
23227 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
23228 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
23229 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
23230 those compilers.
23231
23232 @item
23233 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
23234 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
23235 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
23236 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
23237
23238 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
23239 and then we might not encounter the bug.
23240
23241 @item
23242 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
23243 reproduce the bug.
23244
23245 @item
23246 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
23247 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
23248
23249 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
23250 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
23251 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
23252 a chance to make a mistake.
23253
23254 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
23255 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
23256 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
23257 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
23258 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
23259 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
23260 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
23261 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
23262
23263 @pindex script
23264 @cindex recording a session script
23265 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
23266 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
23267 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
23268 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
23269
23270 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
23271 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
23272
23273 @item
23274 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
23275 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
23276 it by context, not by line number.
23277
23278 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
23279 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
23280
23281 @end itemize
23282
23283 Here are some things that are not necessary:
23284
23285 @itemize @bullet
23286 @item
23287 A description of the envelope of the bug.
23288
23289 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
23290 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
23291 changes will not affect it.
23292
23293 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
23294 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
23295 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
23296 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
23297
23298 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
23299 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
23300 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
23301 less time, and so on.
23302
23303 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
23304 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
23305
23306 @item
23307 A patch for the bug.
23308
23309 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
23310 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
23311 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
23312 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
23313
23314 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
23315 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
23316 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
23317 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
23318
23319 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
23320 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
23321 help us to understand.
23322
23323 @item
23324 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
23325
23326 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
23327 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
23328 @end itemize
23329
23330 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
23331 @c and consists of the two following files:
23332 @c rluser.texinfo
23333 @c inc-hist.texinfo
23334 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
23335 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
23336 @include rluser.texi
23337 @include inc-hist.texinfo
23338
23339
23340 @node Formatting Documentation
23341 @appendix Formatting Documentation
23342
23343 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
23344 @cindex reference card
23345 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
23346 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
23347 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
23348 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
23349 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
23350 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
23351
23352 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
23353 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
23354
23355 @smallexample
23356 make refcard.dvi
23357 @end smallexample
23358
23359 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
23360 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
23361 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
23362 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
23363 your @sc{dvi} output program.
23364
23365 @cindex documentation
23366
23367 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
23368 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
23369 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
23370 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
23371 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
23372 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
23373
23374 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
23375 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
23376 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
23377 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
23378 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
23379 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
23380 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
23381 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
23382
23383 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
23384 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
23385 @code{makeinfo}.
23386
23387 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
23388 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
23389 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
23390
23391 @smallexample
23392 cd gdb
23393 make gdb.info
23394 @end smallexample
23395
23396 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
23397 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
23398 Texinfo definitions file.
23399
23400 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
23401 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
23402 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
23403 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
23404 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
23405 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
23406 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
23407
23408 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
23409 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
23410 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
23411 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
23412 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
23413 directory.
23414
23415 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
23416 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
23417 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
23418 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
23419
23420 @smallexample
23421 make gdb.dvi
23422 @end smallexample
23423
23424 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
23425
23426 @node Installing GDB
23427 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
23428 @cindex installation
23429
23430 @menu
23431 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
23432 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
23433 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
23434 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
23435 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
23436 @end menu
23437
23438 @node Requirements
23439 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
23440 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
23441
23442 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
23443 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
23444
23445 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
23446 @table @asis
23447 @item ISO C90 compiler
23448 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
23449 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
23450
23451 @end table
23452
23453 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
23454 @table @asis
23455 @item Expat
23456 @anchor{Expat}
23457 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
23458 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
23459 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
23460 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
23461 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
23462 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
23463
23464 Expat is used for:
23465
23466 @itemize @bullet
23467 @item
23468 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
23469 @item
23470 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
23471 @item
23472 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
23473 @item
23474 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
23475 @end itemize
23476
23477 @item zlib
23478 @cindex compressed debug sections
23479 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
23480 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
23481 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
23482 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
23483 information in such binaries.
23484
23485 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
23486 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
23487 @url{http://zlib.net}.
23488
23489 @end table
23490
23491 @node Running Configure
23492 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
23493 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
23494 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
23495 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
23496 build the @code{gdb} program.
23497 @iftex
23498 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
23499 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
23500 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
23501 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
23502 @end iftex
23503
23504 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
23505 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
23506 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
23507
23508 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
23509 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
23510
23511 @table @code
23512 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
23513 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
23514
23515 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
23516 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
23517
23518 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
23519 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
23520
23521 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
23522 @sc{gnu} include files
23523
23524 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
23525 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
23526
23527 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
23528 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
23529
23530 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
23531 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
23532
23533 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
23534 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
23535
23536 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
23537 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
23538 @end table
23539
23540 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
23541 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
23542 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
23543
23544 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
23545 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
23546 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
23547 argument.
23548
23549 For example:
23550
23551 @smallexample
23552 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23553 ./configure @var{host}
23554 make
23555 @end smallexample
23556
23557 @noindent
23558 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
23559 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
23560 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
23561 correct value by examining your system.)
23562
23563 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
23564 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
23565 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
23566 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
23567
23568 @need 750
23569 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
23570 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
23571 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
23572
23573 @smallexample
23574 sh configure @var{host}
23575 @end smallexample
23576
23577 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
23578 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
23579 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
23580 @file{configure}
23581 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
23582 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
23583
23584 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
23585 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
23586 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
23587 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
23588 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
23589 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
23590 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
23591 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
23592 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23593
23594 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
23595 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
23596 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
23597 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
23598 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
23599
23600 @node Separate Objdir
23601 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
23602
23603 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
23604 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
23605 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
23606 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
23607 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
23608 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
23609 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
23610 program specified there.
23611
23612 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
23613 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
23614 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
23615 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
23616 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
23617 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
23618
23619 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
23620 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
23621
23622 @smallexample
23623 @group
23624 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23625 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
23626 cd ../gdb-sun4
23627 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
23628 make
23629 @end group
23630 @end smallexample
23631
23632 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
23633 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
23634 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
23635 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
23636 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
23637 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
23638
23639 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
23640 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
23641 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
23642 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
23643 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23644
23645 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
23646 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
23647 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
23648 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
23649 You specify a cross-debugging target by
23650 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
23651
23652 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
23653 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
23654 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
23655
23656 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
23657 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
23658 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
23659 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
23660 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
23661
23662 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
23663 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23664 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23665 with each other.
23666
23667 @node Config Names
23668 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23669
23670 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23671 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23672 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23673 of information in the following pattern:
23674
23675 @smallexample
23676 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23677 @end smallexample
23678
23679 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23680 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23681 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23682
23683 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23684 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23685 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23686 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23687 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23688 abbreviations---for example:
23689
23690 @smallexample
23691 % sh config.sub i386-linux
23692 i386-pc-linux-gnu
23693 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
23694 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23695 % sh config.sub hp9k700
23696 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23697 % sh config.sub sun4
23698 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23699 % sh config.sub sun3
23700 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23701 % sh config.sub i986v
23702 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23703 @end smallexample
23704
23705 @noindent
23706 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23707 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23708
23709 @node Configure Options
23710 @section @file{configure} Options
23711
23712 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23713 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23714 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23715 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23716
23717 @smallexample
23718 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23719 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23720 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23721 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23722 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23723 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23724 @var{host}
23725 @end smallexample
23726
23727 @noindent
23728 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23729 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23730 @samp{--}.
23731
23732 @table @code
23733 @item --help
23734 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23735
23736 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
23737 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23738 @file{@var{dir}}.
23739
23740 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23741 Configure the source to install programs under directory
23742 @file{@var{dir}}.
23743
23744 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23745 @need 2000
23746 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23747 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23748 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23749 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23750 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23751 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23752 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23753 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23754 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23755 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23756 @var{dirname}.
23757
23758 @item --norecursion
23759 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23760 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23761
23762 @item --target=@var{target}
23763 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23764 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23765 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23766
23767 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23768
23769 @item @var{host} @dots{}
23770 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23771
23772 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23773 @end table
23774
23775 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23776 needed for special purposes only.
23777
23778 @node Maintenance Commands
23779 @appendix Maintenance Commands
23780 @cindex maintenance commands
23781 @cindex internal commands
23782
23783 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23784 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23785 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23786 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23787 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23788
23789 @table @code
23790 @kindex maint agent
23791 @item maint agent @var{expression}
23792 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23793 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23794 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23795
23796 @kindex maint info breakpoints
23797 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23798 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23799 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23800 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23801 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23802 is shown:
23803
23804 @table @code
23805 @item breakpoint
23806 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23807
23808 @item watchpoint
23809 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23810
23811 @item longjmp
23812 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23813 @code{longjmp} calls.
23814
23815 @item longjmp resume
23816 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23817
23818 @item until
23819 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23820
23821 @item finish
23822 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23823
23824 @item shlib events
23825 Shared library events.
23826
23827 @end table
23828
23829 @kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23830 @kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23831 @cindex displaced stepping support
23832 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23833 @item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23834 @itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23835 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
23836 if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
23837 a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
23838 inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
23839 originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
23840 out-of-line single-stepping.
23841
23842 @kindex maint check-symtabs
23843 @item maint check-symtabs
23844 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23845
23846 @kindex maint cplus first_component
23847 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23848 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23849
23850 @kindex maint cplus namespace
23851 @item maint cplus namespace
23852 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23853
23854 @kindex maint demangle
23855 @item maint demangle @var{name}
23856 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23857
23858 @kindex maint deprecate
23859 @kindex maint undeprecate
23860 @cindex deprecated commands
23861 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23862 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23863 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23864 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23865 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23866 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23867 the replacement as part of the warning.
23868
23869 @kindex maint dump-me
23870 @item maint dump-me
23871 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23872 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23873 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23874 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23875
23876 @kindex maint internal-error
23877 @kindex maint internal-warning
23878 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23879 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23880 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23881 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23882 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23883 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23884 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23885 @value{GDBN} session.
23886
23887 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23888 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23889
23890 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23891
23892 @smallexample
23893 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23894 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23895 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23896 debugging may prove unreliable.
23897 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23898 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23899 (@value{GDBP})
23900 @end smallexample
23901
23902 @kindex maint packet
23903 @item maint packet @var{text}
23904 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23905 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23906 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23907 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23908 checksum.
23909
23910 @kindex maint print architecture
23911 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23912 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23913 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23914
23915 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23916 @item maint print c-tdesc
23917 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23918 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23919 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23920
23921 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23922 @item maint print dummy-frames
23923 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23924
23925 @smallexample
23926 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23927 @dots{}
23928 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23929 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23930 58 return (a + b);
23931 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23932 @dots{}
23933 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23934 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23935 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23936 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23937 (@value{GDBP})
23938 @end smallexample
23939
23940 Takes an optional file parameter.
23941
23942 @kindex maint print registers
23943 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23944 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23945 @kindex maint print register-groups
23946 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23947 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23948 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23949 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23950 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23951
23952 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23953 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23954 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23955 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23956 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23957 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23958
23959 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23960 write the information.
23961
23962 @kindex maint print reggroups
23963 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23964 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23965 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23966 information.
23967
23968 The register groups info looks like this:
23969
23970 @smallexample
23971 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23972 Group Type
23973 general user
23974 float user
23975 all user
23976 vector user
23977 system user
23978 save internal
23979 restore internal
23980 @end smallexample
23981
23982 @kindex flushregs
23983 @item flushregs
23984 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23985
23986 @kindex maint print objfiles
23987 @cindex info for known object files
23988 @item maint print objfiles
23989 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23990 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23991 and symtabs.
23992
23993 @kindex maint print statistics
23994 @cindex bcache statistics
23995 @item maint print statistics
23996 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23997 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23998 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23999 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
24000 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
24001 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
24002 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
24003 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
24004 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
24005 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
24006 lengths.
24007
24008 @kindex maint print target-stack
24009 @cindex target stack description
24010 @item maint print target-stack
24011 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
24012 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
24013 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
24014 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
24015 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
24016 address.
24017
24018 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
24019 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
24020
24021 @kindex maint print type
24022 @cindex type chain of a data type
24023 @item maint print type @var{expr}
24024 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
24025 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
24026 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
24027 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
24028 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
24029
24030 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24031 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24032 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24033 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24034 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
24035
24036 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
24037 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
24038 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
24039 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
24040 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
24041 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
24042 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
24043 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
24044 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
24045
24046 @kindex maint set profile
24047 @kindex maint show profile
24048 @cindex profiling GDB
24049 @item maint set profile
24050 @itemx maint show profile
24051 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
24052
24053 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
24054 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
24055 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
24056 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
24057 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
24058 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
24059 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
24060
24061 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
24062 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
24063
24064 @kindex maint set linux-async
24065 @kindex maint show linux-async
24066 @cindex asynchronous support
24067 @item maint set linux-async
24068 @itemx maint show linux-async
24069 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support
24070 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24071
24072 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24073 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
24074
24075 @kindex maint set remote-async
24076 @kindex maint show remote-async
24077 @cindex asynchronous support
24078 @item maint set remote-async
24079 @itemx maint show remote-async
24080 Control the remote asynchronous support
24081 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24082
24083 Remote asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24084 the @samp{maint set remote-async} command to enable it.
24085
24086 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
24087 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
24088 @item maint show-debug-regs
24089 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
24090 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
24091 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
24092 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
24093 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
24094
24095 @kindex maint space
24096 @cindex memory used by commands
24097 @item maint space
24098 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
24099 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
24100 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
24101 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
24102 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24103
24104 @kindex maint time
24105 @cindex time of command execution
24106 @item maint time
24107 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
24108 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
24109 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
24110 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
24111 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
24112 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
24113 it's not possibly currently
24114 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
24115 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24116
24117 @kindex maint translate-address
24118 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
24119 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
24120 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
24121 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
24122 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
24123 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
24124 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
24125
24126 @end table
24127
24128 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
24129 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
24130
24131 @table @code
24132 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
24133 @kindex set watchdog
24134 @cindex watchdog timer
24135 @cindex timeout for commands
24136 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
24137 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
24138 reports and error and the command is aborted.
24139
24140 @item show watchdog
24141 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
24142 @end table
24143
24144 @node Remote Protocol
24145 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
24146
24147 @menu
24148 * Overview::
24149 * Packets::
24150 * Stop Reply Packets::
24151 * General Query Packets::
24152 * Register Packet Format::
24153 * Tracepoint Packets::
24154 * Host I/O Packets::
24155 * Interrupts::
24156 * Packet Acknowledgment::
24157 * Examples::
24158 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
24159 * Library List Format::
24160 * Memory Map Format::
24161 @end menu
24162
24163 @node Overview
24164 @section Overview
24165
24166 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
24167 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
24168 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
24169 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
24170
24171 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
24172 transmitted and received data, respectively.
24173
24174 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
24175 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
24176 @cindex remote serial protocol
24177 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
24178 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
24179 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
24180 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
24181
24182 @smallexample
24183 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24184 @end smallexample
24185 @noindent
24186
24187 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
24188 @noindent
24189 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
24190 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
24191 eight bit unsigned checksum).
24192
24193 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
24194 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
24195
24196 @smallexample
24197 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24198 @end smallexample
24199
24200 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
24201 @noindent
24202 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
24203 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
24204 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
24205
24206 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
24207 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
24208 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
24209 retransmission):
24210
24211 @smallexample
24212 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24213 <- @code{+}
24214 @end smallexample
24215 @noindent
24216
24217 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
24218 once a connection is established.
24219 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
24220
24221 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
24222 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
24223 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
24224 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
24225
24226 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
24227 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
24228 exceptions).
24229
24230 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
24231 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
24232 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
24233 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
24234
24235 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
24236 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
24237 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
24238
24239 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
24240 @anchor{Binary Data}
24241 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
24242 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
24243 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
24244 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
24245 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
24246 binary data.
24247
24248 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
24249 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
24250 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
24251 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
24252 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
24253 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
24254 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
24255 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
24256 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
24257 (described next).
24258
24259 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
24260 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
24261 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
24262 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
24263 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
24264 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
24265 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
24266 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
24267 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
24268 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
24269 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
24270 3}} more times.
24271
24272 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
24273 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
24274 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
24275 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
24276 @samp{0*"00}.
24277
24278 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
24279 error number. That number is not well defined.
24280
24281 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
24282 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
24283 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
24284 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
24285 on that response.
24286
24287 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
24288 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
24289 optional.
24290
24291 @node Packets
24292 @section Packets
24293
24294 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
24295 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
24296 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
24297 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
24298
24299 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
24300 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
24301 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
24302 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
24303 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
24304 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
24305 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
24306 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
24307 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
24308 @var{baz}.
24309
24310 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
24311 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
24312
24313 Here are the packet descriptions.
24314
24315 @table @samp
24316
24317 @item !
24318 @cindex @samp{!} packet
24319 @anchor{extended mode}
24320 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
24321 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
24322 debugged.
24323
24324 Reply:
24325 @table @samp
24326 @item OK
24327 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
24328 @end table
24329
24330 @item ?
24331 @cindex @samp{?} packet
24332 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
24333 step and continue.
24334
24335 Reply:
24336 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24337
24338 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
24339 @cindex @samp{A} packet
24340 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
24341 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
24342 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
24343
24344 Reply:
24345 @table @samp
24346 @item OK
24347 The arguments were set.
24348 @item E @var{NN}
24349 An error occurred.
24350 @end table
24351
24352 @item b @var{baud}
24353 @cindex @samp{b} packet
24354 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
24355 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
24356
24357 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
24358 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
24359 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
24360
24361 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
24362 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
24363 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
24364 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
24365 of view, nothing actually happened.}
24366
24367 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
24368 @cindex @samp{B} packet
24369 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
24370 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
24371
24372 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
24373 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
24374
24375 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24376 @cindex @samp{c} packet
24377 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
24378 resume at current address.
24379
24380 Reply:
24381 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24382
24383 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24384 @cindex @samp{C} packet
24385 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
24386 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
24387
24388 Reply:
24389 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24390
24391 @item d
24392 @cindex @samp{d} packet
24393 Toggle debug flag.
24394
24395 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
24396 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
24397
24398 @item D
24399 @cindex @samp{D} packet
24400 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
24401 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
24402
24403 Reply:
24404 @table @samp
24405 @item OK
24406 for success
24407 @item E @var{NN}
24408 for an error
24409 @end table
24410
24411 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
24412 @cindex @samp{F} packet
24413 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
24414 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
24415 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
24416
24417 @item g
24418 @anchor{read registers packet}
24419 @cindex @samp{g} packet
24420 Read general registers.
24421
24422 Reply:
24423 @table @samp
24424 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24425 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
24426 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
24427 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
24428 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
24429 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
24430 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
24431 @item E @var{NN}
24432 for an error.
24433 @end table
24434
24435 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
24436 @cindex @samp{G} packet
24437 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
24438 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
24439
24440 Reply:
24441 @table @samp
24442 @item OK
24443 for success
24444 @item E @var{NN}
24445 for an error
24446 @end table
24447
24448 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
24449 @cindex @samp{H} packet
24450 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
24451 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
24452 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
24453 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
24454 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
24455
24456 Reply:
24457 @table @samp
24458 @item OK
24459 for success
24460 @item E @var{NN}
24461 for an error
24462 @end table
24463
24464 @c FIXME: JTC:
24465 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
24466 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
24467 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
24468 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
24469 @c described. For example:
24470 @c
24471 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24472 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
24473 @c otherwise returns current registers.
24474 @c
24475 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24476 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
24477 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
24478
24479 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
24480 @anchor{cycle step packet}
24481 @cindex @samp{i} packet
24482 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
24483 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
24484 step starting at that address.
24485
24486 @item I
24487 @cindex @samp{I} packet
24488 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
24489 step packet}.
24490
24491 @item k
24492 @cindex @samp{k} packet
24493 Kill request.
24494
24495 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
24496 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
24497 thread?)}.
24498
24499 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
24500 @cindex @samp{m} packet
24501 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24502 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
24503
24504 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
24505 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
24506 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
24507 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
24508 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
24509 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
24510 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
24511 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
24512
24513 Reply:
24514 @table @samp
24515 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24516 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
24517 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
24518 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
24519 @item E @var{NN}
24520 @var{NN} is errno
24521 @end table
24522
24523 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24524 @cindex @samp{M} packet
24525 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24526 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
24527 hexadecimal number.
24528
24529 Reply:
24530 @table @samp
24531 @item OK
24532 for success
24533 @item E @var{NN}
24534 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
24535 written).
24536 @end table
24537
24538 @item p @var{n}
24539 @cindex @samp{p} packet
24540 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
24541 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
24542 register value is encoded.
24543
24544 Reply:
24545 @table @samp
24546 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24547 the register's value
24548 @item E @var{NN}
24549 for an error
24550 @item
24551 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
24552 @end table
24553
24554 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
24555 @anchor{write register packet}
24556 @cindex @samp{P} packet
24557 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
24558 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
24559 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
24560
24561 Reply:
24562 @table @samp
24563 @item OK
24564 for success
24565 @item E @var{NN}
24566 for an error
24567 @end table
24568
24569 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24570 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24571 @cindex @samp{q} packet
24572 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
24573 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
24574 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
24575
24576 @item r
24577 @cindex @samp{r} packet
24578 Reset the entire system.
24579
24580 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
24581
24582 @item R @var{XX}
24583 @cindex @samp{R} packet
24584 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
24585 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24586
24587 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
24588
24589 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24590 @cindex @samp{s} packet
24591 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
24592 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
24593
24594 Reply:
24595 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24596
24597 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24598 @anchor{step with signal packet}
24599 @cindex @samp{S} packet
24600 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
24601 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
24602
24603 Reply:
24604 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24605
24606 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
24607 @cindex @samp{t} packet
24608 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
24609 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
24610 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
24611
24612 @item T @var{XX}
24613 @cindex @samp{T} packet
24614 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
24615
24616 Reply:
24617 @table @samp
24618 @item OK
24619 thread is still alive
24620 @item E @var{NN}
24621 thread is dead
24622 @end table
24623
24624 @item v
24625 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
24626 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
24627
24628 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
24629 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
24630 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24631 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. The attached process is
24632 stopped.
24633
24634 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24635
24636 Reply:
24637 @table @samp
24638 @item E @var{nn}
24639 for an error
24640 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24641 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24642 @end table
24643
24644 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
24645 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
24646 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
24647 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
24648 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
24649 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
24650 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
24651 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
24652
24653 @table @samp
24654 @item c
24655 Continue.
24656 @item C @var{sig}
24657 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24658 @item s
24659 Step.
24660 @item S @var{sig}
24661 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24662 @end table
24663
24664 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
24665 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
24666
24667 Reply:
24668 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24669
24670 @item vCont?
24671 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
24672 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
24673
24674 Reply:
24675 @table @samp
24676 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
24677 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
24678 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
24679 @item
24680 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
24681 @end table
24682
24683 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24684 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24685 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24686 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24687
24688 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24689 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24690 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24691 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24692 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24693 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24694 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24695 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24696 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24697 packet is received.
24698
24699 Reply:
24700 @table @samp
24701 @item OK
24702 for success
24703 @item E @var{NN}
24704 for an error
24705 @end table
24706
24707 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24708 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24709 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24710 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24711 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24712 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24713 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24714 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24715 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24716 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24717 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24718 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24719
24720
24721 Reply:
24722 @table @samp
24723 @item OK
24724 for success
24725 @item E.memtype
24726 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24727 @item E @var{NN}
24728 for an error
24729 @end table
24730
24731 @item vFlashDone
24732 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24733 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24734 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24735 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24736 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24737 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24738 request is completed.
24739
24740 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24741 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24742 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24743 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24744 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24745 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24746 state.
24747
24748 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24749
24750 Reply:
24751 @table @samp
24752 @item E @var{nn}
24753 for an error
24754 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24755 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24756 @end table
24757
24758 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24759 @anchor{X packet}
24760 @cindex @samp{X} packet
24761 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24762 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24763 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24764
24765 Reply:
24766 @table @samp
24767 @item OK
24768 for success
24769 @item E @var{NN}
24770 for an error
24771 @end table
24772
24773 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24774 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24775 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24776 @cindex @samp{z} packet
24777 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
24778 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24779 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24780 @var{length} bytes.
24781
24782 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24783 separately.
24784
24785 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24786 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24787 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24788 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24789 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24790 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24791
24792 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24793 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24794 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
24795 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24796 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24797 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24798
24799 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24800 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24801 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24802 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24803 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24804
24805 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24806 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24807 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24808 target, is not defined.}
24809
24810 Reply:
24811 @table @samp
24812 @item OK
24813 success
24814 @item
24815 not supported
24816 @item E @var{NN}
24817 for an error
24818 @end table
24819
24820 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24821 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24822 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
24823 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24824 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24825 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24826
24827 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24828 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24829
24830 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24831 movement.}
24832
24833 Reply:
24834 @table @samp
24835 @item OK
24836 success
24837 @item
24838 not supported
24839 @item E @var{NN}
24840 for an error
24841 @end table
24842
24843 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24844 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24845 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
24846 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24847 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24848
24849 Reply:
24850 @table @samp
24851 @item OK
24852 success
24853 @item
24854 not supported
24855 @item E @var{NN}
24856 for an error
24857 @end table
24858
24859 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24860 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24861 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
24862 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24863 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24864
24865 Reply:
24866 @table @samp
24867 @item OK
24868 success
24869 @item
24870 not supported
24871 @item E @var{NN}
24872 for an error
24873 @end table
24874
24875 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24876 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24877 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
24878 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24879 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24880
24881 Reply:
24882 @table @samp
24883 @item OK
24884 success
24885 @item
24886 not supported
24887 @item E @var{NN}
24888 for an error
24889 @end table
24890
24891 @end table
24892
24893 @node Stop Reply Packets
24894 @section Stop Reply Packets
24895 @cindex stop reply packets
24896
24897 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24898 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24899 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24900 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24901 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24902 @value{GDBN} source code.
24903
24904 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24905 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24906 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24907 components.
24908
24909 @table @samp
24910
24911 @item S @var{AA}
24912 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24913 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24914 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24915
24916 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24917 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24918 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24919 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24920 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24921 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24922 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24923 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24924
24925 @itemize @bullet
24926 @item
24927 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24928 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24929 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24930 two-digit hex number.
24931
24932 @item
24933 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24934 hex.
24935
24936 @item
24937 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24938 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24939 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24940 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24941
24942 @item
24943 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24944 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24945 future.
24946 @end itemize
24947
24948 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24949
24950 @table @samp
24951 @item watch
24952 @itemx rwatch
24953 @itemx awatch
24954 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24955 hex.
24956
24957 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24958 @item library
24959 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24960 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24961 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24962 @end table
24963
24964 @item W @var{AA}
24965 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24966 applicable to certain targets.
24967
24968 @item X @var{AA}
24969 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24970
24971 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24972 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24973 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24974 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24975 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24976
24977 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24978 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24979 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24980 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24981 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24982 system calls.
24983
24984 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24985 this very system call.
24986
24987 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24988 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24989 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24990 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24991 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24992 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24993
24994 @end table
24995
24996 @node General Query Packets
24997 @section General Query Packets
24998 @cindex remote query requests
24999
25000 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
25001 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
25002 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
25003 sending information to and from the stub.
25004
25005 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
25006 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
25007 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
25008 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
25009 conventions:
25010
25011 @itemize @bullet
25012 @item
25013 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
25014 @item
25015 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
25016 letter.
25017 @item
25018 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
25019 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
25020 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
25021 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
25022 @end itemize
25023
25024 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
25025 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
25026 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
25027 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
25028 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
25029 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
25030 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
25031 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
25032 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
25033 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
25034 packet.}.
25035
25036 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
25037 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
25038 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
25039 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
25040 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
25041
25042 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
25043
25044 @table @samp
25045
25046 @item qC
25047 @cindex current thread, remote request
25048 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
25049 Return the current thread id.
25050
25051 Reply:
25052 @table @samp
25053 @item QC @var{pid}
25054 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
25055 @item @r{(anything else)}
25056 Any other reply implies the old pid.
25057 @end table
25058
25059 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
25060 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
25061 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
25062 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
25063 Reply:
25064 @table @samp
25065 @item E @var{NN}
25066 An error (such as memory fault)
25067 @item C @var{crc32}
25068 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
25069 @end table
25070
25071 @item qfThreadInfo
25072 @itemx qsThreadInfo
25073 @cindex list active threads, remote request
25074 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
25075 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
25076 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
25077 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
25078 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
25079 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
25080 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
25081 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
25082
25083 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
25084
25085 Reply:
25086 @table @samp
25087 @item m @var{id}
25088 A single thread id
25089 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
25090 a comma-separated list of thread ids
25091 @item l
25092 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
25093 @end table
25094
25095 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
25096 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
25097 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
25098 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
25099 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
25100
25101 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
25102 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
25103 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
25104 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
25105 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
25106
25107 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
25108 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
25109
25110 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
25111 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
25112 information associated with the variable.)
25113
25114 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
25115 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
25116 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
25117 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
25118 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
25119 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
25120
25121 Reply:
25122 @table @samp
25123 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
25124 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
25125 local storage requested.
25126
25127 @item E @var{nn}
25128 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
25129
25130 @item
25131 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
25132 @end table
25133
25134 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
25135 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
25136 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
25137 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
25138 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
25139 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
25140 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
25141
25142 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
25143
25144 Reply:
25145 @table @samp
25146 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
25147 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
25148 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
25149 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
25150 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
25151 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
25152 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
25153 @end table
25154
25155 @item qOffsets
25156 @cindex section offsets, remote request
25157 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
25158 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
25159 image.
25160
25161 Reply:
25162 @table @samp
25163 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
25164 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
25165 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
25166 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
25167 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
25168 segments by the supplied offsets.
25169
25170 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
25171 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
25172 to the @code{Bss} section.}
25173
25174 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
25175 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
25176 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
25177 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
25178 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
25179 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
25180 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
25181 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
25182 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
25183 @end table
25184
25185 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
25186 @cindex thread information, remote request
25187 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
25188 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
25189 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
25190
25191 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
25192 (see below).
25193
25194 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
25195
25196 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
25197 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
25198 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25199 @anchor{QPassSignals}
25200 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
25201 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
25202 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
25203 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
25204 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
25205 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
25206 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
25207 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
25208 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
25209
25210 Reply:
25211 @table @samp
25212 @item OK
25213 The request succeeded.
25214
25215 @item E @var{nn}
25216 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
25217
25218 @item
25219 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
25220 the stub.
25221 @end table
25222
25223 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
25224 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
25225 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25226 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25227
25228 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
25229 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
25230 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
25231 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
25232 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
25233 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
25234 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
25235 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
25236 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
25237
25238 Reply:
25239 @table @samp
25240 @item OK
25241 A command response with no output.
25242 @item @var{OUTPUT}
25243 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
25244 @item E @var{NN}
25245 Indicate a badly formed request.
25246 @item
25247 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
25248 @end table
25249
25250 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
25251 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25252 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25253 packets.)
25254
25255 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
25256 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
25257 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
25258 @anchor{qSearch memory}
25259 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
25260 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
25261 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
25262
25263 Reply:
25264 @table @samp
25265 @item 0
25266 The pattern was not found.
25267 @item 1,address
25268 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
25269 @item E @var{NN}
25270 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
25271 @item
25272 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
25273 @end table
25274
25275 @item QStartNoAckMode
25276 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
25277 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
25278 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
25279 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
25280
25281 Reply:
25282 @table @samp
25283 @item OK
25284 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
25285 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
25286 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
25287 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
25288 @item
25289 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
25290 @end table
25291
25292 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
25293 @cindex supported packets, remote query
25294 @cindex features of the remote protocol
25295 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
25296 @anchor{qSupported}
25297 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
25298 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
25299 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
25300 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
25301 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
25302 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
25303 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
25304 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
25305 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
25306 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
25307 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
25308 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
25309 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
25310 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
25311
25312 Reply:
25313 @table @samp
25314 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
25315 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
25316 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
25317 possible forms).
25318 @item
25319 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
25320 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
25321 @end table
25322
25323 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
25324 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
25325 are:
25326
25327 @table @samp
25328 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
25329 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
25330 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
25331 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
25332 @item @var{name}+
25333 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
25334 need an associated value.
25335 @item @var{name}-
25336 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
25337 @item @var{name}?
25338 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
25339 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
25340 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
25341 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
25342 @end table
25343
25344 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
25345 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
25346 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
25347 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
25348 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
25349
25350 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
25351 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
25352 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
25353 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
25354 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
25355 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
25356 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
25357 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
25358 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
25359 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
25360 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
25361 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
25362 all the features it supports.
25363
25364 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
25365 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
25366
25367 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
25368 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
25369 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
25370 form response.
25371
25372 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
25373 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
25374 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
25375 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
25376
25377 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
25378 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
25379 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
25380 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
25381 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
25382
25383 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
25384
25385 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
25386 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
25387 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
25388 @item Feature Name
25389 @tab Value Required
25390 @tab Default
25391 @tab Probe Allowed
25392
25393 @item @samp{PacketSize}
25394 @tab Yes
25395 @tab @samp{-}
25396 @tab No
25397
25398 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
25399 @tab No
25400 @tab @samp{-}
25401 @tab Yes
25402
25403 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
25404 @tab No
25405 @tab @samp{-}
25406 @tab Yes
25407
25408 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25409 @tab No
25410 @tab @samp{-}
25411 @tab Yes
25412
25413 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25414 @tab No
25415 @tab @samp{-}
25416 @tab Yes
25417
25418 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
25419 @tab No
25420 @tab @samp{-}
25421 @tab Yes
25422
25423 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
25424 @tab No
25425 @tab @samp{-}
25426 @tab Yes
25427
25428 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
25429 @tab No
25430 @tab @samp{-}
25431 @tab Yes
25432
25433 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
25434 @tab No
25435 @tab @samp{-}
25436 @tab Yes
25437
25438 @end multitable
25439
25440 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
25441
25442 @table @samp
25443 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
25444 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
25445 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
25446 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
25447 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
25448 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
25449 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
25450 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
25451 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
25452 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
25453
25454 @item qXfer:auxv:read
25455 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
25456 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
25457
25458 @item qXfer:features:read
25459 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
25460 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
25461
25462 @item qXfer:libraries:read
25463 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
25464 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
25465
25466 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
25467 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
25468 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
25469
25470 @item qXfer:spu:read
25471 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
25472 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
25473
25474 @item qXfer:spu:write
25475 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
25476 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
25477
25478 @item QPassSignals
25479 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25480 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
25481
25482 @item QStartNoAckMode
25483 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
25484 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
25485
25486 @end table
25487
25488 @item qSymbol::
25489 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
25490 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
25491 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
25492 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
25493
25494 Reply:
25495 @table @samp
25496 @item OK
25497 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25498 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25499 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
25500 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
25501 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
25502 below.
25503 @end table
25504
25505 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
25506 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
25507
25508 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
25509 target has previously requested.
25510
25511 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
25512 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
25513 will be empty.
25514
25515 Reply:
25516 @table @samp
25517 @item OK
25518 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25519 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25520 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
25521 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
25522 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
25523 @end table
25524
25525 @item QTDP
25526 @itemx QTFrame
25527 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25528
25529 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
25530 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
25531 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
25532 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
25533 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
25534 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
25535 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
25536 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
25537 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
25538 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
25539
25540 Reply:
25541 @table @samp
25542 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
25543 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
25544 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
25545 the thread's attributes.
25546 @end table
25547
25548 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
25549 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25550 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25551 packets.)
25552
25553 @item QTStart
25554 @itemx QTStop
25555 @itemx QTinit
25556 @itemx QTro
25557 @itemx qTStatus
25558 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25559
25560 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25561 @cindex read special object, remote request
25562 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
25563 @anchor{qXfer read}
25564 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
25565 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
25566 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
25567 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
25568 additional details about what data to access.
25569
25570 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25571 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25572 formats, listed below.
25573
25574 @table @samp
25575 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25576 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
25577 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
25578 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
25579
25580 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25581 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25582
25583 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25584 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
25585 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
25586 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
25587 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
25588
25589 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25590 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25591
25592 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25593 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
25594 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
25595 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25596 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25597
25598 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
25599 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
25600 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
25601
25602 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25603 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25604
25605 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25606 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
25607 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
25608 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25609 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25610
25611 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25612 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25613
25614 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25615 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
25616 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25617 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
25618 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25619 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25620 in that context to be accessed.
25621
25622 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25623 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25624 @end table
25625
25626 Reply:
25627 @table @samp
25628 @item m @var{data}
25629 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
25630 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
25631 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
25632 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
25633 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
25634 request.
25635
25636 @item l @var{data}
25637 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
25638 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
25639 than the @var{length} in the request.
25640
25641 @item l
25642 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
25643 There is no more data to be read.
25644
25645 @item E00
25646 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25647
25648 @item E @var{nn}
25649 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
25650 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25651
25652 @item
25653 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
25654 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
25655 @end table
25656
25657 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25658 @cindex write data into object, remote request
25659 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
25660 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
25661 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
25662 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
25663 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
25664 to access.
25665
25666 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25667 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25668 formats, listed below.
25669
25670 @table @samp
25671 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25672 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
25673 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25674 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
25675 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25676 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25677 in that context to be accessed.
25678
25679 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25680 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25681 @end table
25682
25683 Reply:
25684 @table @samp
25685 @item @var{nn}
25686 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
25687 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
25688
25689 @item E00
25690 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25691
25692 @item E @var{nn}
25693 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
25694 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25695
25696 @item
25697 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
25698 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
25699 @end table
25700
25701 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
25702 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
25703 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
25704 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
25705 must respond with an empty packet.
25706
25707 @end table
25708
25709 @node Register Packet Format
25710 @section Register Packet Format
25711
25712 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
25713 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
25714 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
25715 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
25716 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
25717 most-significant - least-significant.
25718
25719 @table @r
25720
25721 @item MIPS32
25722
25723 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
25724 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
25725 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
25726
25727 @item MIPS64
25728
25729 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25730 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25731 as @code{MIPS32}.
25732
25733 @end table
25734
25735 @node Tracepoint Packets
25736 @section Tracepoint Packets
25737 @cindex tracepoint packets
25738 @cindex packets, tracepoint
25739
25740 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
25741 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
25742
25743 @table @samp
25744
25745 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
25746 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
25747 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
25748 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
25749 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
25750 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
25751 tracepoint's actions.
25752
25753 Replies:
25754 @table @samp
25755 @item OK
25756 The packet was understood and carried out.
25757 @item
25758 The packet was not recognized.
25759 @end table
25760
25761 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
25762 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
25763 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
25764 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
25765 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
25766 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
25767 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
25768
25769 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
25770 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
25771 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
25772 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
25773 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
25774 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
25775 tracepoint actions.
25776
25777 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
25778 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
25779 following forms:
25780
25781 @table @samp
25782
25783 @item R @var{mask}
25784 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
25785 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
25786 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
25787 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
25788 not fit in a 32-bit word.
25789
25790 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
25791 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
25792 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
25793 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
25794 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
25795 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
25796 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
25797
25798 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
25799 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
25800 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
25801 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
25802 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
25803 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
25804 packet).
25805
25806 @end table
25807
25808 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
25809 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
25810 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25811 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25812 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25813 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25814 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25815 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25816
25817 Replies:
25818 @table @samp
25819 @item OK
25820 The packet was understood and carried out.
25821 @item
25822 The packet was not recognized.
25823 @end table
25824
25825 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
25826 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25827 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25828 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25829
25830 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25831 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25832 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25833 one of the following forms:
25834
25835 @table @samp
25836 @item F @var{f}
25837 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25838 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25839 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25840
25841 @item T @var{t}
25842 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25843 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25844
25845 @end table
25846
25847 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25848 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25849 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25850 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25851
25852 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25853 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25854 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25855 is a hexadecimal number.
25856
25857 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25858 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25859 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25860 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25861 numbers.
25862
25863 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25864 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25865 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25866
25867 @item QTStart
25868 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25869 hits in the trace frame buffer.
25870
25871 @item QTStop
25872 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25873
25874 @item QTinit
25875 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25876
25877 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25878 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25879 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25880 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25881
25882 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25883 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25884 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25885 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25886
25887 @item qTStatus
25888 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25889
25890 Replies:
25891 @table @samp
25892 @item T0
25893 There is no trace experiment running.
25894 @item T1
25895 There is a trace experiment running.
25896 @end table
25897
25898 @end table
25899
25900
25901 @node Host I/O Packets
25902 @section Host I/O Packets
25903 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25904 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25905
25906 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25907 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25908 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25909 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25910 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25911 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25912 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25913 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25914 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25915 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25916
25917 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25918 its arguments. They have this format:
25919
25920 @table @samp
25921
25922 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25923 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25924 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25925 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25926 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25927 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25928 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25929 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25930 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25931
25932 @end table
25933
25934 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25935
25936 @table @samp
25937
25938 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25939 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25940 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25941 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25942 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25943 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25944 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25945 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25946 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25947 @var{attachment}.
25948
25949 @item
25950 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25951
25952 @end table
25953
25954 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25955
25956 @table @samp
25957 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25958 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25959 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25960 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25961 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25962 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25963 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25964
25965 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25966 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25967 -1 if an error occurs.
25968
25969 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25970 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25971 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25972 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25973 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25974 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25975 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25976 @var{count} was zero.
25977
25978 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25979 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25980 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25981 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25982 some characters were escaped.
25983
25984 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25985 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25986 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25987 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25988 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25989 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25990 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25991 error occurred.
25992
25993 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25994 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25995 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25996
25997 @end table
25998
25999 @node Interrupts
26000 @section Interrupts
26001 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
26002
26003 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
26004 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
26005 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
26006 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
26007
26008 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
26009 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
26010 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
26011 interfaces.
26012
26013 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
26014 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
26015 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
26016 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
26017 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
26018 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
26019 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
26020 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
26021
26022 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
26023 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
26024 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
26025 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
26026 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
26027 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
26028 program is stopped will be discarded.
26029
26030 @node Packet Acknowledgment
26031 @section Packet Acknowledgment
26032
26033 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
26034 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
26035 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
26036 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
26037 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
26038 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
26039 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
26040
26041 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
26042 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
26043 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
26044 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
26045 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
26046
26047 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
26048 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
26049 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
26050 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
26051
26052 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
26053 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
26054 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
26055 @pxref{qSupported}.
26056 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
26057 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
26058 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
26059 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
26060 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
26061 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
26062 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
26063
26064 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
26065 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
26066 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
26067 connection.
26068 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
26069 new connection is established,
26070 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
26071 for the current connection, once disabled.
26072
26073
26074 @node Examples
26075 @section Examples
26076
26077 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
26078 does not get any direct output:
26079
26080 @smallexample
26081 -> @code{R00}
26082 <- @code{+}
26083 @emph{target restarts}
26084 -> @code{?}
26085 <- @code{+}
26086 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
26087 -> @code{+}
26088 @end smallexample
26089
26090 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
26091
26092 @smallexample
26093 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
26094 <- @code{+}
26095 -> @code{s}
26096 <- @code{+}
26097 @emph{time passes}
26098 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
26099 -> @code{+}
26100 -> @code{g}
26101 <- @code{+}
26102 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
26103 -> @code{+}
26104 @end smallexample
26105
26106 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
26107 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
26108 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
26109
26110 @menu
26111 * File-I/O Overview::
26112 * Protocol Basics::
26113 * The F Request Packet::
26114 * The F Reply Packet::
26115 * The Ctrl-C Message::
26116 * Console I/O::
26117 * List of Supported Calls::
26118 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
26119 * Constants::
26120 * File-I/O Examples::
26121 @end menu
26122
26123 @node File-I/O Overview
26124 @subsection File-I/O Overview
26125 @cindex file-i/o overview
26126
26127 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
26128 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
26129 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
26130 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
26131 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
26132 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
26133
26134 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
26135 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
26136 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
26137 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
26138 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
26139
26140 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
26141 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26142 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
26143 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
26144 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
26145 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
26146 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
26147
26148 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
26149 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
26150 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
26151 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
26152 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
26153
26154 @smallexample
26155 (@value{GDBP}) continue
26156 <- target requests 'system call X'
26157 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
26158 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
26159 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
26160 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
26161 @end smallexample
26162
26163 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
26164 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
26165 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
26166 system are not supported by this protocol.
26167
26168 @node Protocol Basics
26169 @subsection Protocol Basics
26170 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
26171
26172 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
26173 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
26174 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
26175 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
26176 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
26177 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
26178 to call the appropriate host system call:
26179
26180 @itemize @bullet
26181 @item
26182 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
26183
26184 @item
26185 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
26186 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
26187 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
26188 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
26189
26190 @end itemize
26191
26192 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
26193
26194 @itemize @bullet
26195 @item
26196 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
26197 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
26198 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
26199 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
26200 packet.
26201
26202 @item
26203 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
26204 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
26205
26206 @item
26207 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
26208
26209 @item
26210 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
26211
26212 @item
26213 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
26214 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
26215 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
26216 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
26217 packet.
26218
26219 @end itemize
26220
26221 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
26222 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
26223
26224 @itemize @bullet
26225 @item
26226 Return value.
26227
26228 @item
26229 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
26230
26231 @item
26232 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
26233
26234 @end itemize
26235
26236 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
26237 the latest continue or step action.
26238
26239 @node The F Request Packet
26240 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
26241 @cindex file-i/o request packet
26242 @cindex @code{F} request packet
26243
26244 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
26245
26246 @table @samp
26247 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
26248
26249 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
26250 This is just the name of the function.
26251
26252 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
26253 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
26254 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
26255 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
26256 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
26257 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
26258 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
26259
26260 @end table
26261
26262
26263
26264 @node The F Reply Packet
26265 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
26266 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
26267 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
26268
26269 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
26270
26271 @table @samp
26272
26273 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
26274
26275 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
26276
26277 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
26278 representation.
26279 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
26280
26281 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
26282 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
26283 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
26284
26285 @smallexample
26286 F0,0,C
26287 @end smallexample
26288
26289 @noindent
26290 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
26291
26292 @smallexample
26293 F-1,4,C
26294 @end smallexample
26295
26296 @noindent
26297 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
26298
26299 @end table
26300
26301
26302 @node The Ctrl-C Message
26303 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
26304 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
26305
26306 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
26307 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
26308 the target should behave as if it had
26309 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
26310 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
26311 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
26312 packet.
26313
26314 It's important for the target to know in which
26315 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
26316
26317 @itemize @bullet
26318 @item
26319 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
26320
26321 @item
26322 The system call on the host has been finished.
26323
26324 @end itemize
26325
26326 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
26327 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
26328 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
26329 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
26330 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
26331 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
26332
26333 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
26334 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
26335 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
26336 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
26337 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
26338 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
26339 or the full action has been completed.
26340
26341 @node Console I/O
26342 @subsection Console I/O
26343 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
26344
26345 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
26346 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
26347 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
26348 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
26349 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
26350 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
26351 conditions is met:
26352
26353 @itemize @bullet
26354 @item
26355 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
26356 @code{read}
26357 system call is treated as finished.
26358
26359 @item
26360 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
26361 newline.
26362
26363 @item
26364 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
26365 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
26366
26367 @end itemize
26368
26369 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
26370 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
26371 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
26372 is stopped at the user's request.
26373
26374
26375 @node List of Supported Calls
26376 @subsection List of Supported Calls
26377 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
26378
26379 @menu
26380 * open::
26381 * close::
26382 * read::
26383 * write::
26384 * lseek::
26385 * rename::
26386 * unlink::
26387 * stat/fstat::
26388 * gettimeofday::
26389 * isatty::
26390 * system::
26391 @end menu
26392
26393 @node open
26394 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
26395 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
26396
26397 @table @asis
26398 @item Synopsis:
26399 @smallexample
26400 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
26401 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
26402 @end smallexample
26403
26404 @item Request:
26405 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
26406
26407 @noindent
26408 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
26409
26410 @table @code
26411 @item O_CREAT
26412 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
26413 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
26414 are concerned.
26415
26416 @item O_EXCL
26417 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
26418 an error and open() fails.
26419
26420 @item O_TRUNC
26421 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
26422 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
26423 truncated to zero length.
26424
26425 @item O_APPEND
26426 The file is opened in append mode.
26427
26428 @item O_RDONLY
26429 The file is opened for reading only.
26430
26431 @item O_WRONLY
26432 The file is opened for writing only.
26433
26434 @item O_RDWR
26435 The file is opened for reading and writing.
26436 @end table
26437
26438 @noindent
26439 Other bits are silently ignored.
26440
26441
26442 @noindent
26443 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
26444
26445 @table @code
26446 @item S_IRUSR
26447 User has read permission.
26448
26449 @item S_IWUSR
26450 User has write permission.
26451
26452 @item S_IRGRP
26453 Group has read permission.
26454
26455 @item S_IWGRP
26456 Group has write permission.
26457
26458 @item S_IROTH
26459 Others have read permission.
26460
26461 @item S_IWOTH
26462 Others have write permission.
26463 @end table
26464
26465 @noindent
26466 Other bits are silently ignored.
26467
26468
26469 @item Return value:
26470 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
26471 occurred.
26472
26473 @item Errors:
26474
26475 @table @code
26476 @item EEXIST
26477 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
26478
26479 @item EISDIR
26480 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
26481
26482 @item EACCES
26483 The requested access is not allowed.
26484
26485 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26486 @var{pathname} was too long.
26487
26488 @item ENOENT
26489 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26490
26491 @item ENODEV
26492 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
26493
26494 @item EROFS
26495 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
26496 write access was requested.
26497
26498 @item EFAULT
26499 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
26500
26501 @item ENOSPC
26502 No space on device to create the file.
26503
26504 @item EMFILE
26505 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
26506
26507 @item ENFILE
26508 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
26509 has been reached.
26510
26511 @item EINTR
26512 The call was interrupted by the user.
26513 @end table
26514
26515 @end table
26516
26517 @node close
26518 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
26519 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
26520
26521 @table @asis
26522 @item Synopsis:
26523 @smallexample
26524 int close(int fd);
26525 @end smallexample
26526
26527 @item Request:
26528 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
26529
26530 @item Return value:
26531 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
26532
26533 @item Errors:
26534
26535 @table @code
26536 @item EBADF
26537 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
26538
26539 @item EINTR
26540 The call was interrupted by the user.
26541 @end table
26542
26543 @end table
26544
26545 @node read
26546 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
26547 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
26548
26549 @table @asis
26550 @item Synopsis:
26551 @smallexample
26552 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
26553 @end smallexample
26554
26555 @item Request:
26556 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26557
26558 @item Return value:
26559 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
26560 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
26561 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
26562
26563 @item Errors:
26564
26565 @table @code
26566 @item EBADF
26567 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26568 reading.
26569
26570 @item EFAULT
26571 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26572
26573 @item EINTR
26574 The call was interrupted by the user.
26575 @end table
26576
26577 @end table
26578
26579 @node write
26580 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
26581 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
26582
26583 @table @asis
26584 @item Synopsis:
26585 @smallexample
26586 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
26587 @end smallexample
26588
26589 @item Request:
26590 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26591
26592 @item Return value:
26593 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
26594 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
26595 is returned.
26596
26597 @item Errors:
26598
26599 @table @code
26600 @item EBADF
26601 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26602 writing.
26603
26604 @item EFAULT
26605 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26606
26607 @item EFBIG
26608 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
26609 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
26610
26611 @item ENOSPC
26612 No space on device to write the data.
26613
26614 @item EINTR
26615 The call was interrupted by the user.
26616 @end table
26617
26618 @end table
26619
26620 @node lseek
26621 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
26622 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
26623
26624 @table @asis
26625 @item Synopsis:
26626 @smallexample
26627 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
26628 @end smallexample
26629
26630 @item Request:
26631 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
26632
26633 @var{flag} is one of:
26634
26635 @table @code
26636 @item SEEK_SET
26637 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
26638
26639 @item SEEK_CUR
26640 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
26641 bytes.
26642
26643 @item SEEK_END
26644 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
26645 bytes.
26646 @end table
26647
26648 @item Return value:
26649 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
26650 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
26651 value of -1 is returned.
26652
26653 @item Errors:
26654
26655 @table @code
26656 @item EBADF
26657 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
26658
26659 @item ESPIPE
26660 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
26661
26662 @item EINVAL
26663 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
26664
26665 @item EINTR
26666 The call was interrupted by the user.
26667 @end table
26668
26669 @end table
26670
26671 @node rename
26672 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
26673 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
26674
26675 @table @asis
26676 @item Synopsis:
26677 @smallexample
26678 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
26679 @end smallexample
26680
26681 @item Request:
26682 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
26683
26684 @item Return value:
26685 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26686
26687 @item Errors:
26688
26689 @table @code
26690 @item EISDIR
26691 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
26692 directory.
26693
26694 @item EEXIST
26695 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
26696
26697 @item EBUSY
26698 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
26699 process.
26700
26701 @item EINVAL
26702 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
26703 of itself.
26704
26705 @item ENOTDIR
26706 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
26707 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
26708 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
26709
26710 @item EFAULT
26711 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
26712
26713 @item EACCES
26714 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26715
26716 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26717
26718 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
26719
26720 @item ENOENT
26721 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
26722
26723 @item EROFS
26724 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26725
26726 @item ENOSPC
26727 The device containing the file has no room for the new
26728 directory entry.
26729
26730 @item EINTR
26731 The call was interrupted by the user.
26732 @end table
26733
26734 @end table
26735
26736 @node unlink
26737 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
26738 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
26739
26740 @table @asis
26741 @item Synopsis:
26742 @smallexample
26743 int unlink(const char *pathname);
26744 @end smallexample
26745
26746 @item Request:
26747 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
26748
26749 @item Return value:
26750 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26751
26752 @item Errors:
26753
26754 @table @code
26755 @item EACCES
26756 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26757
26758 @item EPERM
26759 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
26760
26761 @item EBUSY
26762 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
26763 being used by another process.
26764
26765 @item EFAULT
26766 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26767
26768 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26769 @var{pathname} was too long.
26770
26771 @item ENOENT
26772 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26773
26774 @item ENOTDIR
26775 A component of the path is not a directory.
26776
26777 @item EROFS
26778 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26779
26780 @item EINTR
26781 The call was interrupted by the user.
26782 @end table
26783
26784 @end table
26785
26786 @node stat/fstat
26787 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
26788 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
26789 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
26790
26791 @table @asis
26792 @item Synopsis:
26793 @smallexample
26794 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
26795 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
26796 @end smallexample
26797
26798 @item Request:
26799 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
26800 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
26801
26802 @item Return value:
26803 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26804
26805 @item Errors:
26806
26807 @table @code
26808 @item EBADF
26809 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
26810
26811 @item ENOENT
26812 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
26813 path is an empty string.
26814
26815 @item ENOTDIR
26816 A component of the path is not a directory.
26817
26818 @item EFAULT
26819 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26820
26821 @item EACCES
26822 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26823
26824 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26825 @var{pathname} was too long.
26826
26827 @item EINTR
26828 The call was interrupted by the user.
26829 @end table
26830
26831 @end table
26832
26833 @node gettimeofday
26834 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
26835 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
26836
26837 @table @asis
26838 @item Synopsis:
26839 @smallexample
26840 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
26841 @end smallexample
26842
26843 @item Request:
26844 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
26845
26846 @item Return value:
26847 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
26848
26849 @item Errors:
26850
26851 @table @code
26852 @item EINVAL
26853 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
26854
26855 @item EFAULT
26856 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26857 @end table
26858
26859 @end table
26860
26861 @node isatty
26862 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26863 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26864
26865 @table @asis
26866 @item Synopsis:
26867 @smallexample
26868 int isatty(int fd);
26869 @end smallexample
26870
26871 @item Request:
26872 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26873
26874 @item Return value:
26875 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26876
26877 @item Errors:
26878
26879 @table @code
26880 @item EINTR
26881 The call was interrupted by the user.
26882 @end table
26883
26884 @end table
26885
26886 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
26887 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26888 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26889 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26890 needed.
26891
26892
26893 @node system
26894 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
26895 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
26896
26897 @table @asis
26898 @item Synopsis:
26899 @smallexample
26900 int system(const char *command);
26901 @end smallexample
26902
26903 @item Request:
26904 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26905
26906 @item Return value:
26907 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26908 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26909 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26910 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26911 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26912 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26913 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26914
26915 @item Errors:
26916
26917 @table @code
26918 @item EINTR
26919 The call was interrupted by the user.
26920 @end table
26921
26922 @end table
26923
26924 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26925 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26926 the host is simplified before it's returned
26927 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26928 is discarded, and the return value consists
26929 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26930
26931 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26932 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26933 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26934
26935 @table @code
26936 @item set remote system-call-allowed
26937 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26938 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26939 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26940
26941 @item show remote system-call-allowed
26942 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26943 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26944 protocol.
26945 @end table
26946
26947 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26948 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26949 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26950
26951 @menu
26952 * Integral Datatypes::
26953 * Pointer Values::
26954 * Memory Transfer::
26955 * struct stat::
26956 * struct timeval::
26957 @end menu
26958
26959 @node Integral Datatypes
26960 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26961 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26962
26963 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26964 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26965 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26966
26967 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26968 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26969
26970 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26971
26972 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
26973 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
26974
26975 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
26976
26977 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
26978 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
26979 byte order.
26980
26981 @node Pointer Values
26982 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
26983 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
26984
26985 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
26986 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
26987 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
26988 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
26989
26990 @smallexample
26991 @code{1aaf/12}
26992 @end smallexample
26993
26994 @noindent
26995 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26996 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26997 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26998 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26999
27000 @smallexample
27001 @code{123456/d}
27002 @end smallexample
27003
27004 @node Memory Transfer
27005 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
27006 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
27007
27008 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
27009 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
27010 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
27011 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
27012 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
27013 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
27014 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
27015
27016
27017 @node struct stat
27018 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
27019 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
27020
27021 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
27022 is defined as follows:
27023
27024 @smallexample
27025 struct stat @{
27026 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
27027 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
27028 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
27029 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
27030 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
27031 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
27032 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
27033 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
27034 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
27035 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
27036 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
27037 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
27038 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
27039 @};
27040 @end smallexample
27041
27042 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
27043 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
27044 structure is of size 64 bytes.
27045
27046 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
27047 range of values.
27048
27049 @table @code
27050
27051 @item st_dev
27052 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
27053
27054 @item st_ino
27055 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
27056
27057 @item st_mode
27058 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
27059 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
27060
27061 @item st_uid
27062 @itemx st_gid
27063 @itemx st_rdev
27064 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
27065
27066 @item st_atime
27067 @itemx st_mtime
27068 @itemx st_ctime
27069 These values have a host and file system dependent
27070 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
27071 support exact timing values.
27072 @end table
27073
27074 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
27075 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
27076 continuing.
27077
27078 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
27079 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
27080 get truncated on the target.
27081
27082 @node struct timeval
27083 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
27084 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
27085
27086 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
27087 is defined as follows:
27088
27089 @smallexample
27090 struct timeval @{
27091 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
27092 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
27093 @};
27094 @end smallexample
27095
27096 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
27097 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
27098 structure is of size 8 bytes.
27099
27100 @node Constants
27101 @subsection Constants
27102 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
27103
27104 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
27105 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
27106 values before and after the call as needed.
27107
27108 @menu
27109 * Open Flags::
27110 * mode_t Values::
27111 * Errno Values::
27112 * Lseek Flags::
27113 * Limits::
27114 @end menu
27115
27116 @node Open Flags
27117 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
27118 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
27119
27120 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
27121
27122 @smallexample
27123 O_RDONLY 0x0
27124 O_WRONLY 0x1
27125 O_RDWR 0x2
27126 O_APPEND 0x8
27127 O_CREAT 0x200
27128 O_TRUNC 0x400
27129 O_EXCL 0x800
27130 @end smallexample
27131
27132 @node mode_t Values
27133 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
27134 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
27135
27136 All values are given in octal representation.
27137
27138 @smallexample
27139 S_IFREG 0100000
27140 S_IFDIR 040000
27141 S_IRUSR 0400
27142 S_IWUSR 0200
27143 S_IXUSR 0100
27144 S_IRGRP 040
27145 S_IWGRP 020
27146 S_IXGRP 010
27147 S_IROTH 04
27148 S_IWOTH 02
27149 S_IXOTH 01
27150 @end smallexample
27151
27152 @node Errno Values
27153 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
27154 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
27155
27156 All values are given in decimal representation.
27157
27158 @smallexample
27159 EPERM 1
27160 ENOENT 2
27161 EINTR 4
27162 EBADF 9
27163 EACCES 13
27164 EFAULT 14
27165 EBUSY 16
27166 EEXIST 17
27167 ENODEV 19
27168 ENOTDIR 20
27169 EISDIR 21
27170 EINVAL 22
27171 ENFILE 23
27172 EMFILE 24
27173 EFBIG 27
27174 ENOSPC 28
27175 ESPIPE 29
27176 EROFS 30
27177 ENAMETOOLONG 91
27178 EUNKNOWN 9999
27179 @end smallexample
27180
27181 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
27182 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
27183
27184 @node Lseek Flags
27185 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
27186 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
27187
27188 @smallexample
27189 SEEK_SET 0
27190 SEEK_CUR 1
27191 SEEK_END 2
27192 @end smallexample
27193
27194 @node Limits
27195 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
27196 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
27197
27198 All values are given in decimal representation.
27199
27200 @smallexample
27201 INT_MIN -2147483648
27202 INT_MAX 2147483647
27203 UINT_MAX 4294967295
27204 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
27205 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
27206 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
27207 @end smallexample
27208
27209 @node File-I/O Examples
27210 @subsection File-I/O Examples
27211 @cindex file-i/o examples
27212
27213 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
27214 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
27215
27216 @smallexample
27217 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
27218 @emph{request memory read from target}
27219 -> @code{m1234,6}
27220 <- XXXXXX
27221 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
27222 -> @code{F6}
27223 @end smallexample
27224
27225 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
27226 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
27227
27228 @smallexample
27229 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27230 @emph{request memory write to target}
27231 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
27232 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
27233 -> @code{F6}
27234 @end smallexample
27235
27236 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
27237 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
27238
27239 @smallexample
27240 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27241 -> @code{F-1,9}
27242 @end smallexample
27243
27244 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
27245 host is called:
27246
27247 @smallexample
27248 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27249 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
27250 <- @code{T02}
27251 @end smallexample
27252
27253 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
27254 host is called:
27255
27256 @smallexample
27257 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27258 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
27259 <- @code{T02}
27260 @end smallexample
27261
27262 @node Library List Format
27263 @section Library List Format
27264 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
27265
27266 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
27267 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
27268 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
27269 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
27270 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
27271 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
27272 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
27273 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
27274 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
27275 are loaded.
27276
27277 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
27278 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
27279 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
27280 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
27281
27282 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
27283 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
27284 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
27285 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
27286 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
27287 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
27288
27289 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27290 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
27291
27292 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
27293 offset, looks like this:
27294
27295 @smallexample
27296 <library-list>
27297 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
27298 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
27299 </library>
27300 </library-list>
27301 @end smallexample
27302
27303 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
27304 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
27305
27306 @smallexample
27307 <library-list>
27308 <library name="sharedlib.o">
27309 <section address="0x10000000"/>
27310 <section address="0x20000000"/>
27311 <section address="0x30000000"/>
27312 </library>
27313 </library-list>
27314 @end smallexample
27315
27316 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
27317
27318 @smallexample
27319 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
27320 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
27321 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
27322 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
27323 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
27324 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
27325 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
27326 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
27327 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
27328 @end smallexample
27329
27330 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
27331 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
27332 section for each library.
27333
27334 @node Memory Map Format
27335 @section Memory Map Format
27336 @cindex memory map format
27337
27338 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
27339 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
27340 memory map.
27341
27342 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27343 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
27344 lists memory regions.
27345
27346 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27347 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
27348
27349 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
27350
27351 @smallexample
27352 <?xml version="1.0"?>
27353 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
27354 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
27355 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
27356 <memory-map>
27357 region...
27358 </memory-map>
27359 @end smallexample
27360
27361 Each region can be either:
27362
27363 @itemize
27364
27365 @item
27366 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
27367 bytes from there:
27368
27369 @smallexample
27370 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
27371 @end smallexample
27372
27373
27374 @item
27375 A region of read-only memory:
27376
27377 @smallexample
27378 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
27379 @end smallexample
27380
27381
27382 @item
27383 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
27384 bytes in length:
27385
27386 @smallexample
27387 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
27388 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
27389 </memory>
27390 @end smallexample
27391
27392 @end itemize
27393
27394 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
27395 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
27396 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
27397
27398 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
27399
27400 @smallexample
27401 <!-- ................................................... -->
27402 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
27403 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
27404 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
27405 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
27406 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
27407 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
27408 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
27409 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
27410 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
27411 and its type, or device. -->
27412 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
27413 start CDATA #REQUIRED
27414 length CDATA #REQUIRED
27415 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
27416 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
27417 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
27418 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421 @include agentexpr.texi
27422
27423 @node Target Descriptions
27424 @appendix Target Descriptions
27425 @cindex target descriptions
27426
27427 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
27428 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
27429 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
27430
27431 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
27432 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
27433 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
27434 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
27435 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
27436 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
27437 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
27438
27439 @itemize @bullet
27440 @item
27441 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
27442 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
27443 @item
27444 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
27445 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
27446 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
27447 @item
27448 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
27449 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
27450 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
27451 @end itemize
27452
27453 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
27454 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
27455 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
27456 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
27457 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
27458
27459 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27460 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
27461
27462 @menu
27463 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
27464 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
27465 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
27466 descriptions.
27467 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
27468 @end menu
27469
27470 @node Retrieving Descriptions
27471 @section Retrieving Descriptions
27472
27473 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
27474 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
27475 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
27476 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
27477 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
27478 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
27479 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
27480 Format}.
27481
27482 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
27483 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
27484 specify a file are:
27485
27486 @table @code
27487 @cindex set tdesc filename
27488 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
27489 Read the target description from @var{path}.
27490
27491 @cindex unset tdesc filename
27492 @item unset tdesc filename
27493 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
27494 will use the description supplied by the current target.
27495
27496 @cindex show tdesc filename
27497 @item show tdesc filename
27498 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
27499 @end table
27500
27501
27502 @node Target Description Format
27503 @section Target Description Format
27504 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
27505
27506 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
27507 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
27508 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
27509 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
27510 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
27511 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
27512 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
27513
27514 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
27515 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
27516 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
27517 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
27518
27519 Here is a simple target description:
27520
27521 @smallexample
27522 <target version="1.0">
27523 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
27524 </target>
27525 @end smallexample
27526
27527 @noindent
27528 This minimal description only says that the target uses
27529 the x86-64 architecture.
27530
27531 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
27532 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
27533 are explained further below.
27534
27535 @smallexample
27536 <?xml version="1.0"?>
27537 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
27538 <target version="1.0">
27539 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
27540 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
27541 </target>
27542 @end smallexample
27543
27544 @noindent
27545 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
27546 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
27547 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
27548 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
27549 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
27550 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
27551 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
27552 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
27553 the version mismatch.
27554
27555 @subsection Inclusion
27556 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
27557 @cindex XInclude
27558 @ifnotinfo
27559 @cindex <xi:include>
27560 @end ifnotinfo
27561
27562 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
27563 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
27564 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
27565 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
27566 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
27567
27568 @smallexample
27569 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
27570 @end smallexample
27571
27572 @noindent
27573 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
27574 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
27575 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
27576 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
27577 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
27578 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
27579 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
27580 original description.
27581
27582 @subsection Architecture
27583 @cindex <architecture>
27584
27585 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
27586
27587 @smallexample
27588 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
27589 @end smallexample
27590
27591 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
27592 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
27593 Debugging Target}).
27594
27595 @subsection Features
27596 @cindex <feature>
27597
27598 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
27599 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
27600 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
27601 has this form:
27602
27603 @smallexample
27604 <feature name="@var{name}">
27605 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
27606 @var{reg}@dots{}
27607 </feature>
27608 @end smallexample
27609
27610 @noindent
27611 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
27612 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
27613 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
27614 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
27615
27616 @subsection Types
27617
27618 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
27619 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
27620 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
27621 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
27622 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
27623
27624 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
27625 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
27626 Types must be defined before they are used.
27627
27628 @cindex <vector>
27629 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
27630 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
27631 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
27632 @var{count}:
27633
27634 @smallexample
27635 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
27636 @end smallexample
27637
27638 @cindex <union>
27639 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
27640 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
27641 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
27642 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
27643
27644 @smallexample
27645 <union id="@var{id}">
27646 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
27647 @dots{}
27648 </union>
27649 @end smallexample
27650
27651 @subsection Registers
27652 @cindex <reg>
27653
27654 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
27655
27656 @smallexample
27657 <reg name="@var{name}"
27658 bitsize="@var{size}"
27659 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
27660 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
27661 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
27662 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
27663 @end smallexample
27664
27665 @noindent
27666 The components are as follows:
27667
27668 @table @var
27669
27670 @item name
27671 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
27672
27673 @item bitsize
27674 The register's size, in bits.
27675
27676 @item regnum
27677 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
27678 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
27679 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
27680 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
27681 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
27682 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
27683 in order of increasing register number.
27684
27685 @item save-restore
27686 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
27687 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
27688 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
27689 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
27690 ABI.
27691
27692 @item type
27693 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
27694 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
27695 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
27696 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
27697 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
27698 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
27699
27700 @item group
27701 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
27702 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
27703 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
27704 in @code{info registers}.
27705
27706 @end table
27707
27708 @node Predefined Target Types
27709 @section Predefined Target Types
27710 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
27711
27712 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
27713 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
27714 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
27715 types. The currently supported types are:
27716
27717 @table @code
27718
27719 @item int8
27720 @itemx int16
27721 @itemx int32
27722 @itemx int64
27723 @itemx int128
27724 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27725
27726 @item uint8
27727 @itemx uint16
27728 @itemx uint32
27729 @itemx uint64
27730 @itemx uint128
27731 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27732
27733 @item code_ptr
27734 @itemx data_ptr
27735 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
27736 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
27737 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
27738 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
27739 may be marked as data pointers.
27740
27741 @item ieee_single
27742 Single precision IEEE floating point.
27743
27744 @item ieee_double
27745 Double precision IEEE floating point.
27746
27747 @item arm_fpa_ext
27748 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
27749
27750 @end table
27751
27752 @node Standard Target Features
27753 @section Standard Target Features
27754 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
27755
27756 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
27757 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
27758 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
27759 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
27760 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
27761 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
27762 can recognize them.
27763
27764 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
27765 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
27766 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
27767 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
27768 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
27769 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
27770 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
27771 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
27772
27773 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
27774 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
27775 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
27776
27777 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
27778 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
27779 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
27780 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
27781
27782 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
27783 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
27784 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
27785
27786 @menu
27787 * ARM Features::
27788 * MIPS Features::
27789 * M68K Features::
27790 * PowerPC Features::
27791 @end menu
27792
27793
27794 @node ARM Features
27795 @subsection ARM Features
27796 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
27797
27798 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
27799 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
27800 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
27801
27802 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
27803 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
27804
27805 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
27806 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
27807 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
27808 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
27809
27810 @node MIPS Features
27811 @subsection MIPS Features
27812 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
27813
27814 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
27815 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
27816 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
27817 on the target.
27818
27819 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
27820 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
27821 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27822
27823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
27824 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
27825 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
27826 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27827
27828 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
27829 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
27830 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
27831
27832 @node M68K Features
27833 @subsection M68K Features
27834 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
27835
27836 @table @code
27837 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
27838 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
27839 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
27840 One of those features must be always present.
27841 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
27842 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
27843 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
27844 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
27845
27846 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
27847 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
27848 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
27849 @samp{fpiaddr}.
27850 @end table
27851
27852 @node PowerPC Features
27853 @subsection PowerPC Features
27854 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27855
27856 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27857 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27858 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27859 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27860
27861 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27862 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27863
27864 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27865 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27866 and @samp{vrsave}.
27867
27868 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27869 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27870 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27871 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27872 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27873 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27874 user.
27875
27876 @include gpl.texi
27877
27878 @raisesections
27879 @include fdl.texi
27880 @lowersections
27881
27882 @node Index
27883 @unnumbered Index
27884
27885 @printindex cp
27886
27887 @tex
27888 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27889 % meantime:
27890 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27891 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27892 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27893 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27894 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27895 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27896 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27897 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27898 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27899 \page\colophon
27900 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27901 @end tex
27902
27903 @bye
This page took 0.671306 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.